Table of Contents
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
☒ Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
For fiscal year ended December 31, 2020
or
☐ Transition Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
For the transition period from ____ to ____
Commission file number: 000-50644
CUTERA, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
77-0492262
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
3240 Bayshore Blvd., Brisbane, California 94005
(Address of principal executive offices)
(415) 657-5500
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
Trading Symbol(s)
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Stock ($0.001 par value)
CUTR
The NASDAQ Stock Market, LLC
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ☐ No ☒
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ☐ No ☒
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such
filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ☒ No ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule
405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit
such files). Yes ☒ No ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, smaller reporting company, or
an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth
company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer ☐ Accelerated filer ☒ Non-
accelerated filer ☐ Smaller reporting company ☐
Emerging growth company ☐
Table of Contents
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any
new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal
control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that
prepared or issued its audit report. Yes ☒ No ☐
Indicate by check mark whether registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes ☐ No ☒
The aggregate market value of the registrant’s common stock, held by non-affiliates of the registrant as of June 30, 2020 (which is the last business
day of registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter) based upon the closing price of such stock on the NASDAQ Global Select Market on
June 30, 2020, was approximately $143 million. For purposes of this disclosure, shares of common stock held by entities and individuals who own 5%
or more of the outstanding common stock and shares of common stock held by each officer and director have been excluded in that such persons may be
deemed to be “affiliates” as that term is defined under the Rules and Regulations of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. This determination of affiliate
status is not necessarily conclusive.
The number of shares of Registrant’s common stock issued and outstanding as of March 10, 2021 was 17,782,872.
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Part III incorporates by reference certain information from the registrant’s definitive proxy statement for the 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders,
which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after December 31, 2020.
Table of Contents
PART I
Item 1.
Item 1A.
Item 1B.
Item 2.
Item 3.
Item 4.
PART II
Item 5.
Item 6.
Item 7.
Item 7A.
Item 8.
Item 9.
Item 9A.
Item 9B.
PART III
Item 10.
Item 11.
Item 12.
Item 13.
Item 14.
PART IV
Item 15.
Item 16.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Business
Risk Factors
Unresolved Staff Comments
Properties
Legal Proceedings
Mine Safety Disclosures
Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
Selected Financial Data
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
Controls and Procedures
Other Information
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
Executive Compensation
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
Principal Accounting Fees and Services
Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
Form 10K Summary
3
Page
4
17
46
47
47
47
48
50
51
64
65
99
99
100
100
100
100
100
100
101
103
Table of Contents
FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains “forward-looking statements” that involve risks and uncertainties. The Company’s actual results could differ
materially from those discussed in the forward-looking statements. The statements contained in this report that are not purely historical are forward-
looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the
Exchange Act. Forward-looking statements are often identified by the use of words such as, but not limited to, “anticipate,” “believe,” “can,”
“continue,” “could,” “estimate,” “might,” “expect,” “intend,” “may,” “plan,” “project,” “seek,” “should,” “strategy,” “target,” “will,” “would” or
variations of these terms and similar expressions, or the negative of these terms or similar expressions intended to identify forward-looking statements.
Forward-looking statements are necessarily based on estimates and assumptions that, while considered reasonable by the Company and its management
based on their knowledge and understanding of the business and industry, are inherently uncertain. Forward-looking statements are subject to risks,
uncertainties and other important factors that could cause actual results and the timing of certain events to differ materially from future results expressed
or implied by such forward-looking statements. Factors that could cause or contribute to such differences include, but are not limited to, those identified
below and those discussed in the section titled “Risk Factors” included under Part I, Item 1A below. Furthermore, such forward-looking statements
speak only as of the date of this report. Except as required by law, the Company undertakes no obligation to update any forward-looking statements to
reflect events or circumstances after the date of such statements.
The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with and are qualified in their entirety by reference to the discussions included in
Item 1A - Risk Factors, Item 7 - Management’s Discussion & Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, and elsewhere in this Annual
Report on Form 10-K.
In this Annual Report on Form 10-K, unless the context otherwise requires, references to the “Company,” “Cutera,” “we,” “us” and “the Company’s”
refers to Cutera, Inc.
PART I
ITEM 1. BUSINESS
In this Annual Report on Form 10-K, “Cutera,” “the Company,” “we,” “us” and “the Company’s” refer to Cutera, Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries.
Cutera®, AccuTip®, CoolGlide®, CoolGlide excel®, enlighten®, excel HR®, excel V®, excel V+®, LimeLight®, MyQ®, Pearl®, PicoGenesis™,
ProWave®, Solera®, Titan®, truSculpt®, truSculpt® flex, Secret PRO®, Secret RF® and xeo® are trademarks for the systems and ancillary
products of the Company.
Company Background
Cutera was formed in 1988 as a Delaware corporation and is a global provider of laser and energy-based aesthetic systems for practitioners worldwide.
The Company designs, develops, manufactures, distributes and markets light and energy-based product platforms for use by physicians and other
qualified practitioners (collectively, “practitioners”), enabling them to offer safe and effective aesthetic treatments to their customers. In addition, the
Company distributes third-party manufactured skincare products. The Company currently offers easy-to-use products based on the following key
platforms: enlighten®, excel HR®, excel V®, excel V+®, truSculpt®, truSculpt® flex, Secret PRO®, Secret RF® and xeo® — each of which enables
physicians and other qualified practitioners to perform safe and effective aesthetic procedures, including treatment for body contouring, skin resurfacing
and revitalization, tattoo removal, removal of benign pigmented lesions, vascular conditions, hair removal, toenail fungus and women's health. The
Company’s platforms are designed to be easily upgraded to add additional applications and hand pieces, which provide flexibility for the Company’s
customers as they expand their practices. The Company’s ongoing research and development activities primarily focus on developing new products, as
well as improving and enhancing the Company’s portfolio of existing products. The Company also explores ways to expand the Company’s product
offerings through alternative arrangements with other companies, such as distribution arrangements. The Company introduced Juliet, a product for
women’s health, in December 2017, Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization, in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018,
truSculpt iD in July 2018, excel V+ in February 2019 and truSculpt flex in June 2019.
The Company’s trademarks include: “Cutera,” “AcuTip,” “CoolGlide,” “CoolGlide excel,” “enlighten,” “excel HR,” “excel V,” “excel V+,”
“LimeLight,” ‘myQ,” “Pearl,” “PicoGenesis,” “ProWave 770,” “Solera,” “Titan,” “truSculpt,” “truSculpt flex,”"Secret PRO” “Secret RF” and
“xeo.” The Company’s logo and other trade names, trademarks and service marks appearing in this document are the Company’s property. Other trade
names, trademarks and service marks appearing in this Annual Report on Form 10-K are the property of their respective owners. Solely for convenience,
the Company’s trademarks and trade names referred to in this Annual Report on Form 10-K appear without the ® or symbols, but those references are
not intended to indicate, in any way, that the Company will not assert, to the fullest extent under applicable law, the Company’s rights, or the right of the
applicable licensor to these trademarks and trade names.
4
Table of Contents
A description of each of the Company’s hand pieces, and the aesthetic conditions they are designed to treat, is contained in the section below entitled
“Products” and a summary of the features of the Company’s primary platforms is as follows:
● truSculpt flex – In June 2019, the Company introduced the truSculpt flex for the muscle-sculpting market. This product is a bio-electrical muscle
stimulation device designed to strengthen, firm and tone the abdomen, buttocks and thighs, and can treat patients at all fitness levels. The truSculpt
flex delivers Multi-Direction Stimulation with truControl, inducing muscle hypertrophy. Johari (the Company’s contract manufacturing
organization) received 510(k) clearance from the United States (“U.S.”) Food and Drug Administration (“FDA”) for muscle conditioning in 2013. It
is sold in the USA, Canada, Japan, certain Asia Pacific markets, and the European Union (“EU”) and is expected to be sold to a broader international
customer base upon required regulatory approvals. The truSculpt flex includes a consumable hand piece that needs to be "refilled" after a set number
of treatments are performed, resulting in recurring revenue.
● excel V+ – In February 2019, the Company introduced the excel V+, a new iteration of the excel V vascular platform originally introduced in 2011.
Excel V+, is a high-performance, vascular and benign pigmented lesion treatment platform designed specifically for the core-market of
dermatologists and plastic surgeons. The excel V+ has 50% more power than its predecessor and provides a greater range of parameters for faster
more customizable treatments. The excel V and excel V+ are solid-state laser platforms providing a combination of the 532 nm green laser with 1064
nm Nd:YAG technology, to provide a single, compact and efficient system that treats the entire range of cosmetic vascular and benign pigmented
lesion conditions.
● truSculpt iD –In July 2018 the Company introduced a hands-free version of the Company’s truSculpt platform, the truSculpt iD, for the non-
surgical body sculpting market. It includes consumable cycles that need to be ordered by the practitioner after a set number of treatments are
performed, resulting in recurring revenue. This product is a high-powered RF system designed for body contouring, lipolysis, and deep tissue
heating, and is able to treat all body and skin types. The truSculpt iD delivers targeted energy at 2 MHz, causing lipolysis of the subcutaneous
adipose tissue. The Company received 510(k) clearance from the FDA for lipolysis of abdominal fat in 2018. It was primarily sold in the U.S.,
Canada and Europe in 2018 and was sold to a broader international customer base in 2019. Prior truSculpt platforms include the truSculpt 3D, a 2
MHZ device for tissue heating and temporary reduction of fat in the abdomen, and the original truSculpt platform which was launched in August
2012 and delivered treatments at 1 MHz. In December 2016, the Company received 510(k) clearance from the FDA to market the truSculpt platform
for the temporary reduction in circumference of the abdomen. The truSculpt 3D includes a consumable hand piece that needs to be “refilled” after a
set number of treatments are performed, resulting in recurring revenue.
● Juliet – In December 2017, the Company introduced the Juliet laser for women’s intimate health. Juliet is a versatile multi-application platform
utilizing an Er:YAG laser with the 2940 nm wavelength. This Erbium wavelength produces noticeable results due to its high peak absorption in
water. Additionally, Juliet’s Erbium technology allows for a controlled thermal delivery to tissue, keeping the procedure safe for patients while
minimizing downtime. Juliet delivers two passes of energy to the target area during treatment. The first pass uses ablation to vaporize the tissue and
create micro-channels of injury. The second pass uses coagulation to deliver a thermal injury to the area, which further stimulates the body's normal
wound healing process, revitalizing, and remodeling damaged tissue and introducing the formation of new blood vessels. Juliet also has a disposable
tip, which must be changed for every procedure. As a result, the replacement of the tips results in recurring revenue. The Company is the distributor
of Juliet. All regulatory activities are managed by Asclepion laser technologies gmbh, the legal manufacturer. During the quarter ended June 30,
2020, the Company wrote-off $0.8 million of inventory on hand related to its Juliet platform due to declining sales. Sales related to Juliet have been
declining due to the COVID-19 pandemic and the FDA letter issued on July 30, 2018 expressing concerns regarding “vaginal rejuvenation”
procedures using energy-based devices.
● Secret RF – In January 2018, the Company introduced a new fractional radio frequency (“RF”) microneedling device that delivers heat into the
deeper layers of the skin using controlled RF energy. The targeted energy revitalizes, rebuilds and firms up tissue, effectively remodeling collagen,
improving mild wrinkles and diminishing scars while leaving the outer layer of skin intact, minimizing downtime. Each time a procedure is
performed, it requires the physician to use a new hand piece tip. The sale of the replacement tip results in recurring revenue. The Company is the
distributor of Secret RF. All regulatory activities are managed by Ilooda Co. Ltd.
● enlighten – In December 2014, the Company introduced the enlighten laser platform with a dual wavelength (1064 nanometer, or “nm” + 532 nm)
and in December 2016, the Company introduced a three wavelength model (1064 nm + 532 nm + 670 nm), enlighten III. The enlighten system is a
dual pulse duration (750 picosecond, or “ps,” and 2 nanosecond, or “ns”) laser system and is cleared for multi-colored tattoo removal and for the
treatment of benign pigmented lesions and acne scars. In 2018, the Company introduced an expanded performance enlighten III and in April 2018,
the Company introduced enlighten SR, which is a lighter version of enlighten with reduced optical performance. Clinical studies were conducted to
support an FDA clearance in October 2018 for treatment of acne scars on patients with Fitzpatrick skin types II-V when used with the Micro Lens
Array (“MLA”) hand piece attachment.
● excel HR – In June 2014, the Company introduced the excel HR platform, a premium hair removal solution for all skin types, combining the
Company’s proven long-pulse 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser and a high-power 755 nm Alexandrite laser with sapphire contact cooling.
● xeo – In 2003, the Company introduced the xeo platform, which combines intense pulsed light technology with laser applications in a single
system. The xeo is a multi-application platform on which a customer can purchase hand piece applications for the removal of unwanted hair,
treatment of vascular lesions, and skin revitalization by treating discoloration, fine lines and laxity.
In addition to the above mentioned seven primary systems, the Company continues to generate revenue from its legacy products such as GenesisPlus,
CoolGlide, and the distribution of skincare products, a product manufactured by ZO Skin Health, Inc. (“ZO”), and sold in the Japanese market. The
Company also generates revenue from the sale of post-warranty services, as well as the sales of Titan hand piece refills, and from the lease arrangements
under its membership program.
The Company offers its customers the ability to select the systems and applications that best fit their practice and to subsequently upgrade their systems
to add new applications. This upgrade path allows the Company’s customers to cost-effectively build their aesthetic practices and provides the Company
with a source of incremental revenue.
5
Table of Contents
Recent Developments
On March 9, 2021, the Company offered $125 million aggregate principal amount of 2.25% convertible senior notes due 2026 (the “notes”) in a private
placement to qualified institutional buyers pursuant to Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”). Cutera also
granted the initial purchasers of the notes an option to purchase up to an additional $13.25 million aggregate principal amount of the notes on the same
terms and conditions. The Initial Purchasers exercised their option in full on March 5, 2021, bringing the total aggregate principal amount of the Notes
to $138.25 million.
The Company entered into capped call transactions, in connection with the offering, with one or more of the initial purchasers and/or their respective
affiliates and/or other financial institutions (the “option counterparties”). The capped call transactions are expected generally to reduce potential dilution
to Cutera’s common stock upon any conversion of notes, with such reduction subject to a cap. If the initial purchasers exercise their option to purchase
additional notes, the Company expects to enter into additional capped call transactions with the option counterparties.
The net proceeds from the offering, before deducting purchasers’ discounts and offering expenses were approximately $134.1 million. The Company
used $16.1 million of the net proceeds to pay the cost of the capped call transactions described above and the remainder of the net proceeds for general
corporate purposes, which may include working capital, capital expenditures and potential acquisitions and strategic transactions.
In connection with the offering, the Company entered into Amendment No. 1 to Loan and Security Agreement on March 4, 2021, which amends the
Company’s Loan and Security Agreement, dated as of July 9, 2020 between the Company, as borrower, and Silicon Valley Bank. The Amendment
amends the Loan and Security Agreement to (i) permit the Company to issue the Notes and perform its obligations in connection therewith, and (ii)
permit the Capped Call transactions.
The Market for Non-Surgical Aesthetic Procedures
The market for non-surgical aesthetic procedures has grown significantly over the past several years. According to data presented at the IMCAS Global
Market Summit in February 2020, the medical aesthetic global market is expected to grow at 11.5% from 2019 to reach $22.2 billion by 2025. The body
contouring market is expected to grow to $1.1 billion by 2022 at annual growth rate of 7.9%.
The Company believes there are several factors contributing to the global growth of aesthetic treatment procedures and aesthetic laser equipment sales,
including:
● Improved Economic Environment and Expanded Physician Base – The improvements in overall global economic conditions since the financial
crisis of 2007-2008 have created increased demand for aesthetic procedures, which in turn has resulted in an expanding practitioner base to satisfy
the demand.
● Aging Demographics of Industrialized Countries – The aging population of industrialized countries, the amount of discretionary income
available to the “baby boomer” demographic segment ─ ages 56 to 74 as of 2020 ─ and their desire to retain a youthful appearance, contribute to the
increased demand for aesthetic procedures.
● Broader Range of Safe and Effective Treatments – Technical developments, as well as an increase in treatable conditions due to new product
introductions, lead to safe, effective, easy-to-use, and low-cost treatments with fewer side effects, resulting in broader adoption of aesthetic
procedures by practitioners. In addition, technical advancements enable practitioners to offer a broader range of treatments. These technical
developments reduce treatment and recovery times, which in turn lead to greater patient demand.
● Broader Base of Customers – Managed care and government payor reimbursement restrictions motivate physicians to establish, or seek to
expand, their elective aesthetic practices with procedures that are paid for directly by patients. As a result, in addition to core practitioners such as
dermatologists and plastic surgeons, many other practitioners, such as gynecologists, family practitioners, primary care physicians, physicians
performing aesthetic treatments in non-medical offices, and other qualified practitioners (“non-core practitioners”) expand their practices and offer
aesthetic procedures.
● Reductions in Cost per Procedure – Due in part to increased competition in the aesthetic market, the cost per procedure has been reduced in the
past few years. This attracts a broader base of customers and patients seeking aesthetic procedures.
● Wide Acceptance of Aesthetic Procedures and Increased Focus on Body Image and Appearance – According to the American Society for
Aesthetic Plastic Surgery survey in 2019 both surgical and non-surgical procedures increased compared to 2015. Surgical procedures increased by
6.2%, while non-surgical procedures increased by 13.3% over this 4 year period.
Non-Surgical Aesthetic Procedures for Improving the Body and/or Skin’s Appearance and Their Limitations
Many alternative therapies are available for improving a person’s appearance by treating specific structures within the skin. These procedures utilize
injections or abrasive agents to reach different depths of the dermis and the epidermis. In addition, non-invasive and minimally invasive treatments have
been developed that employ laser and other energy-based technologies to achieve similar therapeutic results. Some of these common aesthetic
procedures and their limitations are described below.
Non-Invasive Body Contouring – Treatments for non-invasive body sculpting can be done utilizing a variety of technologies including radio frequency,
laser, cooling and ultrasound. Procedures address reduction of unwanted fat on the abdomen, flanks, arms, thighs, submentum and back, and can require
one or more treatments. Systems with the ability to induce non-invasive lipolysis (breakdown of fat) offer a more permanent solution with an average fat
reduction of more than 20%. Side effects to this approach may include nodules that typically resolve over time, and the risk of burning the treatment
area. In June 2019, the Company introduced the truSculpt flex, a bio-electrical muscle stimulation device designed to strength, firm and tone the
abdomen, buttocks and thighs.
Tattoo removal – The most effective way to remove tattoos on the body is to utilize laser systems that deliver very short pulse durations with high peak
power in order to break up the ink particles that comprise tattoos.
The global tattoo removal market was valued at $122.8 million in 2019 and is projected to reach $219.0 million by 2026 growing at 8.5% from 2019 to
2026. According to the market research, people tend to get rid of their tattoos due to career purposes, social conditions, personal situations, and more,
which have been the key drivers for the tattoo removal market. Despite the effectiveness of lasers for tattoo removal, common complaints concerning
laser tattoo removal include a low rate of complete clearance (sometimes no better than 50% after several treatments) as well as the high number of
treatments for satisfactory clearance (often 10 or more treatments spaced four to eight weeks apart). However, the latest generation of tattoo removal
lasers produce picosecond pulse durations, (a trillionth of a second) and thereby, can meaningfully improve tattoo clearance and reduce the total number
of treatments. The Company introduced the enlighten system, a dual pulse duration laser system, that was cleared for multi-colored tattoo removal.
6
Table of Contents
Hair Removal – Techniques for hair removal include waxing, depilatories, tweezing, shaving, electrolysis, laser as well as other energy-based hair
removal modalities. The only techniques that provide a long-lasting solution are electrolysis, laser, and other energy-based technology such as an Intense
Pulsed Light (“IPL”). Electrolysis is usually painful, time-consuming and expensive for large areas, but is the most common method for removing light-
colored hair. During electrolysis, an electrologist inserts a needle directly into a hair follicle and activates an electric current in the needle. Since
electrolysis only treats one hair follicle at a time, the treatment of an area as small as an upper lip may require numerous visits and many hours of
treatment. In addition, electrolysis can cause blemishes and infection related to needle use. In comparison, lasers can quickly treat large areas with a high
degree of safety and efficacy. In 2003, the Company introduced the xeo system platform utilized for hair removal, which combines intense pulse light
technology with laser applications in a single system. In 2014, the Company introduced the excel HR platform, a premium hair removal solution for all
skin types, combining the Company’s proven long-pulse 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser and a high-power 755 nm Alexandrite laser with sapphire contact
cooling.
Skin Revitalization – Skin revitalization treatments include a broad range of popular alternatives, including Botox and collagen injections, chemical
peel, microdermabrasion, radio frequency treatment and laser and other energy-based treatments. With these treatments, patients hope to improve overall
skin tone and texture, reduce pore size, tighten skin and remove other signs of aging, including mottled pigmentation, diffuse redness and wrinkles. All
of these procedures are temporary solutions and must be repeated within several weeks or months to sustain their effect, thereby increasing the cost and
inconvenience to patients. For example, the body absorbs Botox and collagen, and patients require supplemental injections every three to six months to
maintain the benefits of these treatments.
Other skin revitalization treatments, such as chemical peels and microdermabrasion, can have undesirable side effects. Chemical peels use acidic or
caustic solutions to peel away the epidermis, and microdermabrasion generally utilizes sand crystals to resurface the skin. These techniques can lead to
stinging, redness, irritation and scabbing. In addition, more serious complications, such as changes in skin color, can result from deeper chemical peels.
With many modalities available today for skin revitalization and resurfacing, the Company has developed a range of clinically proven solutions uniquely
paired with a patient’s lifestyle and skin concerns, such as Secret PRO, which utilizes fractional CO2 for skin resurfacing and radio frequency
microneedling for deep dermal remodeling and Secret RF, a novel fractional RF microneedling system for tissue coagulation and hemostasis designed to
stimulate and remodel collagen and address the common signs of aging.
Microneedling – Also known as collagen induction therapy, microneedling is a minimally invasive revitalization treatment that involves using fine
needles to create hundreds of tiny, invisible puncture wounds in the top layer of the skin, which stimulates the body's natural wound healing processes,
resulting in cell turnover and increased collagen and elastin production. In January 2018, the Company introduced Secret RF product, a RF fractional
microneedling system that helps deliver tailored energy to improve fine lines, wrinkles, and scars from the inside out.
Women’s Intimate Health – Lasers and RF technology have emerged as a treatment for issues unique to women's health such as vulvar vaginal atrophy
and genitourinary symptoms of menopause. The condition causes vaginal dryness, inflammation and irritation, which can lead to painful or frequent
urination. Traditional treatments use estrogen therapy to combat vulvar vaginal atrophy and genitourinary symptoms of menopause to restore vaginal
health, but not all women suffering from the symptoms are candidates. Lasers have been shown to ablate the vaginal tissue generating a healing response
that may lead to symptomatic improvement.
Leg and Facial Veins – Current aesthetic treatment methods for leg and facial veins include sclerotherapy, as well as laser and other energy-based
treatments. With these treatments, patients seek to eliminate visible veins, and improve overall skin appearance. Sclerotherapy requires a skilled
practitioner to inject a saline or detergent-based solution into the target vein, which breaks down the vessel causing it to collapse and be absorbed into
the body. The need to correctly position the needle on the inside of the vein makes it difficult to treat smaller veins, which limits the treatment of facial
vessels and small leg veins. In 2019, the Company introduced the excel V+, a high-performance, vascular and benign pigmented lesion treatment
platform designed specifically for the core-market of dermatologists and plastic surgeons, which treats the entire range of cosmetic vascular and benign
pigmented lesion conditions.
Laser and other energy-based non-surgical treatments for hair removal, veins, skin revitalization and body contouring are discussed in the following
section.
Laser and Other Energy-Based Aesthetic Treatments
Laser and other energy-based aesthetic treatments can achieve therapeutic results by affecting structures within the skin. The development of safe and
effective aesthetic treatments has resulted in a well-established market for these procedures.
Practitioners can use laser and other energy-based technologies to selectively target hair follicles, veins or collagen in the dermis, as well as cells
responsible for pigmentation in the epidermis, without damaging surrounding tissue. Practitioners can also use these technologies to safely remove
portions of the epidermis and deliver heat to the dermis as a means of generating new collagen growth. Ablative skin resurfacing improves the
appearance of the skin by removing the outer layers of the skin. Ablative skin resurfacing procedures are considered invasive or minimally invasive,
depending on how much of the epidermis is removed during a treatment. Non-ablative skin resurfacing improves the appearance of the skin by treating
the underlying structure of the skin.
Safe and effective laser and energy-based treatments require an appropriate combination of the four parameters:
● Energy Level – the amount of light or radio frequency emitted to heat a target;
● Pulse Duration – the time interval over which the energy is delivered;
● Spot Size or Electrode Size – the diameter of the energy beam, which affects treatment depth and area; and
● Wavelength or Frequency – the position in the electromagnetic spectrum which impacts the absorption and the effective depth of the energy
delivered.
For example, in the case of hair removal, by utilizing the correct combination of these parameters, a practitioner can use a laser or other light source to
selectively target melanin within the hair follicle to absorb the laser energy and destroy the follicle, without damaging other delicate structures in the
surrounding tissue.
Technology and Design of the Company’s Systems
The Company’s enlighten, excel, Secret PRO, Juliet, Secret RF, truSculpt and xeo platforms provide the long-lasting benefits of laser and other energy-
based aesthetic treatments. The Company’s technology allows for a wide variety of applications in a single system. Key features of the Company’s
solutions include:
7
Table of Contents
● Multiple Applications Available in a Single System – Many of the Company’s platforms feature multiple-applications that enable practitioners to
perform a variety of aesthetic procedures using a single device. These procedures include hair removal, vascular treatments and skin revitalization,
which address discoloration, fine lines, and uneven texture. Because practitioners can use the Company’s systems for multiple indications, the
investment in a unit is spread across a greater number of patients and procedures, and the acquisition cost may be more rapidly recovered.
● Technology and Design Leadership – The Company’s innovative laser technology combines multiple wavelengths, adjustable energy levels, variable
spot sizes and a wide range of pulse durations, allowing practitioners to customize treatments for each patient and condition. The Company’s proprietary
pulsed light hand pieces for the treatment of discoloration, hair removal and vascular treatments optimize the wavelength used for treatments and
incorporate a monitoring system to increase safety. The Company’s Titan hand piece utilizes a novel light source not previously used for aesthetic
treatments. The Company’s Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces, with proprietary YSGG technology, represent the first application of the 2790 nm
wavelength for minimally invasive cosmetic dermatology.
● Upgradeable Platform – Some of the Company’s products allow the Company’s customers to upgrade their system to the Company’s newest
technologies or add new applications to their system, each of which provide the Company with a source of incremental revenue. The Company believes
that product upgradeability allows customers to take advantage of the Company’s latest product offerings and provide additional treatment options to
their patients, thereby expanding the opportunities for their aesthetic practices.
● Treatments for Broad Range of Skin Types and Conditions – For hair removal, the Company’s products are safe and effective on patients of all skin
types, including harder-to-treat patients with dark or tanned skin. In addition, the wide parameter range of the Company’s systems allows practitioners to
effectively treat patients with both fine and coarse hair. Practitioners may use the Company’s products to treat spider veins on the leg; to treat facial
veins; and perform skin revitalization procedures for discoloration, texture, fine lines and wrinkles on any type of skin. The ability to customize
treatment parameters based on skin type enables practitioners to offer safe and effective therapies to a broad base of their patients.
● Ease of Use – The Company designs its products to be easy to use. The Company’s proprietary hand pieces are lightweight and ergonomic, minimize
user fatigue, and facilitate clear views of the treatment area, reducing the possibility of unintended damage and increasing the speed of application. The
Company’s control console contains an intuitive user interface with simple, independently adjustable controls from which to select a wide range of
treatment parameters to suit each patient’s profile. For instance, the clinical navigation user interface on the xeo platform provides recommended clinical
treatment parameter ranges based on patient criteria entered. The Company’s Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces include a scanner with multiple
scan patterns to allow simple and fast treatments of the face. Finally, the Company’s truSculpt iD embodies the best of many of the above features.
Unlike other body sculpting treatments on the market that require certain body types, or pinchable fat, truSculpt iD is “body agnostic” with the ability to
customize treatments to the patient's needs and body type. In addition, the Company’s proprietary algorithms and navigation enable the practitioner to
treat a 300cm2 area in only 15 minutes.
Business Strategy
The Company’s goal is to maintain and expand its position as a leading worldwide provider of light and energy-based aesthetic devices and
complementary aesthetic products by executing the following strategies:
● Continue to Expand the Company’s Product Offering – Though the Company believes that its current portfolio of products is comprehensive, the
Company’s research and development group has a pipeline of potential products under development. The Company launched excel V in 2011, truSculpt
in 2012, ProWave LX in 2013, and excel HR and enlighten in 2014. In addition, the Company continues to expand offerings on the Company’s current
platforms with further enhancement such as the enlighten III launched in 2016, truSculpt 3D launched in 2017, enlighten SR launched in April 2018,
truSculpt iD launched in July 2018, excel V+ launched in February 2019 and truSculpt flex launched in June 2019. The Company also introduced Juliet,
a product for women’s health, in December 2017, Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization, in January 2018, and Secret
PRO, a CO2 fractional RF microneedling device, in July 2020. These products allow the Company to leverage existing customer call points and create
new customer call points.
● Increase Revenue and Improve Productivity – The Company believes that the market for aesthetic systems will continue to offer growth
opportunities. The Company continues to build brand recognition, add additional products to the Company’s international distribution channel, and
focus on enhancing the Company’s global distribution network, all of which the Company expects will contribute to increased revenue.
● Increase Focus on Practitioners with Established Medical Offices – The Company believes there is growth opportunity in targeting the Company’s
products to a broad customer base. The Company also believes that its customers’ success is largely dependent upon having an existing medical
practice, for which the Company’s systems provide incremental revenue sources to augment a customer’s existing practice revenue.
● Leverage the Company’s Installed Base – With the introduction of enlighten, excel V, excel HR and truSculpt, the Company is able to effectively
offer additional platforms into the existing installed base. In addition, each of these platforms allows for potential future upgrades that offer additional
capabilities. The Company believes this program aligns the Company’s interest in generating revenue with the Company’s customers’ interest in
improving the return on their investment by expanding the range of treatments that can be performed in their practice.
● Generate Revenue from Services and Refillable, Consumable, Hand Pieces – The Company’s Titan, truSculpt 3D, truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex
cycle and pulsed-light handpieces are refillable products, while the Company’s single use disposable tips applicable to Secret PRO, Juliet and Secret RF
are consumable products. Each provides the Company with the opportunity to participate in the procedure-based revenue from the Company’s existing
customers. The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers either through extended service contracts to cover preventive maintenance or
through direct billing for parts and labor. These post-warranty services serve as additional sources of revenue.
● Generate Revenue from Skincare (Cosmeceutical) Products – The Company generates revenue from distribution of third party manufactured
skincare products in Japan. The skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and sold to licensed physicians and other end users.
The Company recognizes revenue for these skincare products when they are sold to the customer.
● Generate Revenue from Leasing of Equipment Through a Membership Program – In the second quarter of 2020, the Company began generating
revenue from leasing equipment to customers through a membership program where the customer pays a fixed monthly fee over the lease term. The
Company enters into leasing transactions, in which the Company is the lessor, through the Company's membership program. Revenue is recognized over
the term of the lease. Along with the leased equipment, the membership program provides customers with a warranty service and a fixed amount of
consumables per month for the term of the lease.
8
Table of Contents
Products
The Company’s enlighten, excel, Secret PRO, Juliet, Secret RF, truSculpt, and xeo, and myQ platforms allow for the delivery of multiple laser and
energy-based aesthetic applications from a single system. With the Company’s xeo platform, practitioners can purchase customized systems with a
variety of the Company’s multi-technology applications. Each of the Company’s products consists of a control console and one or more hand pieces,
depending on the model.
The following table lists the Company’s currently offered products. Each checked box represents the applications included in the product in the years
noted.
Skin Revitalization
Noninvasive
Body
Contouring*
Women’s
Health
Vascular
Lesions
BPL’s
Dyschromia
& Melasma
Texture,
Lines and
Wrinkles
Acne
Scars
Tattoo
Removal Lipolysis*
Gynecology
Applications:
System
Platforms
CoolGlide
xeo
Year
2000
2001
2003
Products
CV
Excel
Nd:YAG
ProWave
770
2005
AcuTip 500 2005
Titan V/XL 2006
2006
LimeLight
Pearl
2007
Pearl
2008
Fractional
ProWave LX 2013
2011
2011
2012
2014
2014
2016
2017
2018
2018
2018
2019
2019
2020
excel V
myQ
truSculpt
excel HR
enlighten(dual wavelength)
enlighten III (MLA)
truSculpt 3D
Juliet
Secret RF
truSculpt iD
truSculpt flex
excel V+
Secret PRO
(b)
(b)
(c)
(b)
(d)
(d)
(b)
(e)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(f)
(j)
(k)
(f)
(f)
(e)
(l)
Energy
Source
(a)
(a)
(a)
Hair
Removal
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x*
x*
X
EnergySources:
(a)1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
(b)Visible and near-infrared Intense Pulsed Light;
(c)Infrared Intense Pulsed Light;
(d)2790 nm Er:YSGG laser;
(e)Combined frequency-doubled 532 nm and 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
(f)Radio frequency at 1 & 2 MHz – mono-polar
(g)Combined 755 nm Alexandrite laser and 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser;
(h)Dual wavelength 532 nm and 1064 nm Nd:YAG picosecond laser;
(i)Three wavelength 532 nm, 670 nm, and 1064 nm Nd:YAG picosecond laser;
(j)2940 nm Er:YAG laser;
(k)Radio frequency at 2 MHz mono-polar; and
(l)Radio frequency at 2 MHz Bi-polar.
* The Company’s CE Mark allows it to market truSculpt in the European Union, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for fat reduction,
body shaping and body contouring. In the U.S. the Company has 510(k) clearance for the reduction in circumference of the abdomen, non-invasive
lipolysis (breakdown of fat) of the abdomen and elevating tissue temperature for the treatment of selected medical conditions such as relief of pain,
muscle spasms, increase in local circulation, and the temporary improvement in the appearance of cellulite.
Upgrade
The Company’s enlighten, truSculpt, and xeo products, are designed to allow customers to cost-effectively upgrade to the Company’s newest
technologies or add applications to their system, each of which provides the Company with a source of additional revenue.
9
Table of Contents
Extended contract services and support
The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers through extended service contracts that cover parts and labor for a term of one, two, or three
years. The Company also offers services on a time-and-materials basis for systems and detachable hand piece replacements. Revenue related to services
performed on a time-and-materials basis is recognized when performed. These post-warranty services serve as additional sources of recurring revenue
from the Company’s installed product base.
The Company’s products are engineered to enable quick and efficient service and support. There are several separate components of the Company’s
products, each of which can be removed and replaced. The Company believes that quick and effective delivery of service is important to its customers.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had 323 employees.
In countries where the Company is represented by distribution partners, customers are serviced through the distributor. Distributors are generally
provided 14 to 16 months warranty coverage for parts only, with labor customarily provided to the end customer by the distributor. The Company’s
Titan, truSculpt 3D, truSculpt iD, and truSculpt flex hand pieces generally include a warranty for a set number of shots, instead of for a period of time.
Training
Sales of systems to customers, except system sales through distributors, include training on the use of the system to be provided within 180 days of
purchase. Training is also sold separately from systems. The Company recognizes revenue for training when the training is provided. Training is not
required for customers to use the systems.
Consumables (Other accessories)
The Company treats its customers' purchases of replacement cycles for truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex, as well as replacement Titan and truSculpt 3D
hand pieces, as Consumable revenue, which provides the Company with a source of recurring revenue from existing customers. The Juliet and Secret RF
products have single use disposable tips which must be replaced after every treatment. Sales of these consumable tips further enhance the Company’s
recurring revenue. Hand piece refills of the Company’s legacy truSculpt product are accounted for as service contract revenue.
Applications and Procedures
The Company’s products are designed to allow the practitioner to select an appropriate combination of energy level, spot size and pulse duration for
each treatment. The ability to manipulate the combinations of these parameters allows the Company’s customers to treat the broadest range of conditions
available with a single energy-based system.
Non-Invasive Body Contouring – The Company’s truSculpt technology allows practitioners to apply a hand piece directly to the skin and deliver high-
powered RF energy that results in the deep and uniform heating of the subcutaneous fat tissue at sustained therapeutic temperatures. This heating can
cause selective destruction of fat cells, which are eliminated from the treatment area through the body’s natural wound healing processes. The treatment
takes approximately 15 minutes and two or more treatments may be required to obtain the desired aesthetic results. The Company’s CE Mark allows the
Company to market truSculpt in the EU, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for fat reduction, body shaping, body contouring and
circumferential reduction. In the U.S., truSculpt has 510(k) clearance for topical heating for the purpose of elevating tissue temperature for the treatment
of selected medical conditions, such as relief of pain and muscle spasms and increase in local circulation. Additionally, the 2 MHz setting for the 40 cm2
hand piece is indicated for reduction in circumference of the abdomen and non-invasive lipolysis (breakdown of fat) of the abdomen. The truSculpt
massage device is intended to provide a temporary reduction in the appearance of cellulite.
Tattoo Removal – The Company’s enlighten systems, delivering picosecond and nanosecond pulse duration, and the Company’s my Q Q-switched laser
are used for tattoo removal, the treatment of benign pigmented lesions, and a laser skin toning procedure that the Company refers to as PicoGenesis.
Hair Removal – The Company has two platforms, excel HR and xeo, which address hair removal for all skin types as well as hair thicknesses. The
Company’s xeo platform allows practitioners to select between the 1064 nm mode for darker, course hair, and the ProWave LX hand piece designed to
address finer, vellus hair. Contact cooling is present on both hand pieces for epidermal protection. excel HR employs both a 1064 nm Nd:YAG as well
as a 755 nm Alexandrite for hair removal. Like the xeo, the 1064 nm wavelength addresses darker, course hair while the 755 nm wavelength is used for
finer, lighter hair. Both wavelengths are transmitted through the same CoolView hand piece with spot sizes up to 20 mm for the 755 nm wavelength and
up to 18 mm for the 1064 nm wavelength. The CoolView hand piece employs sapphire as a means of contact cooling – epidermal protection. Both
platforms are cleared for treating all skin types.
Vascular Lesions – Both the Company’s xeo as well as excel V platforms are capable of treating a wide range of aesthetic vein conditions, including
spider and reticular veins, and small facial veins. xeo employs the LimeLight hand piece for addressing small veins as well as vascular lesions while the
Nd:YAG is appropriate for deeper, larger vessels. LimeLight is a fixed spot size IPL while the Nd:YAG has adjustable spot sizes up to 10mm. excel V is
a dual wavelength laser – 1064 nm and 532 nm – with adjustable spot sizes ranging from 2 mm to 12 mm. The 532 nm wavelength can be used to treat
over 20 conditions ranging from small veins and vessels to a variety of vascular lesions while the Nd:YAG is appropriate for deeper, larger vessels. For
both of these devices, patients receive on average between one and six treatments, with six weeks or longer between treatments.
Skin Revitalization – The Company’s xeo, excel V, excel HR and enlighten platforms, utilizing an Nd:YAG laser, allow the Company’s customers to
perform non-invasive and minimally-invasive treatments that reduce redness, dyschromia, fine lines, improve skin texture, and treat other aesthetic
conditions. When using a 1064 nm Nd:YAG laser to improve skin texture and treat fine lines, cooling is not applied and the hand piece is held directly
above the skin. A large number of pulses are directed at the treatment site, repeatedly covering an area, such as the cheek. By delivering many pulses of
laser light to a treatment area, a gentle heating of the dermis occurs and collagen growth is stimulated to rejuvenate the skin and reduce wrinkles.
Patients typically receive four to six treatments for this procedure. The treatment typically takes less than a half hour with a spacing of two to four weeks
between treatments.
10
Table of Contents
Texture, Lines and Wrinkles – The xeo platform can address fine lines and wrinkles using the Pearl and Pearl Fractional hand pieces. When treating fine
lines, texture and wrinkles with a Pearl hand piece, the hand piece is held at a controlled distance from the skin and the scanner delivers a preset pattern
of spots to the treatment area. Cooling is not applied to the epidermis during the treatment. The energy delivered by the hand piece ablates a portion of
the epidermis while leaving a coagulated portion that will gently peel off over the course of a few days. Heat is also delivered into the dermis, which can
result in the production of new collagen. Treatment of the full face can usually be performed in 15 to 30 minutes. Patients receive on average between
one and three treatments at monthly intervals.
The Company’s Juliet laser is a versatile multi-application platform utilizing an Er:YAG laser with the 2940 nm wavelength. This Erbium wavelength
produces noticeable results with fewer side effects, due to its high peak absorption in water. Additionally, Juliet’s Erbium technology allows for a
controlled thermal delivery to tissue. The Microspot hand piece delivers fractionated energy to induce skin resurfacing and improved skin quality, tone
and texture.
Additionally, the Company’s Secret RF platform is a Radio Frequency microneedling device that employs fractionated RF energy (2 MHz) delivered at
different pre-programmed depths in the dermis to produce new collagen. The Secret RF comes with four treatment tips: a 25-pin tip, both insulated and
semi-insulated, and a 64-pin tip, both insulated and semi-insulated. The treatment has minimal side effects, negligible downtime and results in improved
skin tone and texture as well as improvement in acne scars.
Dyschromia – The Company’s pulsed-light technologies allow the Company’s customers to safely and effectively treat red and brown dyschromia (skin
discoloration), benign pigmented lesions, and rosacea. The practitioner delivers a narrow spectrum of light to the surface of the skin through the
Company’s LimeLight hand pieces. These hand pieces include one of the Company’s proprietary wavelength filters, which reduce the energy level
required for therapeutic effect and minimize the risk of skin injury.
The 532 nm wavelength green laser option of the excel V and enlighten systems, as well as the 755 nm infrared wavelength of the excel HR, can be used
to treat benign pigmented lesions in substantially the same way.
In treating benign pigmented lesions, the hand piece is placed directly on the skin and then the pulse is triggered. The cells forming the pigmented lesion
absorb the light energy, darken and then flake off over the course of two to three weeks. Several treatments may be required to completely remove the
lesion. The treatment takes a few minutes per area treated and there are typically three to four weeks between treatments.
Practitioners can also treat dyschromia and other skin conditions with the Company’s Pearl hand piece. During these treatments, the heat delivered by
the Pearl hand piece will remove the outer layer of the epidermis while coagulating a portion of the epidermis. That coagulated portion will gently peel
off over the course of a few days, revealing a new layer of skin underneath. Treatment of the full face can usually be performed in 15 to 30 minutes.
Patients receive on average between one and three treatments at monthly intervals.
Skin Quality – The Company’s Titan technology allows the Company’s customers to use deep dermal heating to tighten lax skin. The practitioner
delivers a spectrum of light to the skin through the Company’s Titan hand piece. This hand piece includes the Company’s proprietary light source and
wavelength filter which tailors the delivered spectrum of light to provide heating at the desired depth in the skin.
In treating compromised skin, the hand piece is placed directly on the skin and then the light pulse is triggered. A sustained pulse causes significant
heating in the dermis. This heating can cause immediate collagen contraction while also stimulating long-term collagen regrowth. Several treatments
may be required to obtain the desired degree of tightening of the skin. The treatment of a full face can take over an hour and there are typically four
weeks between treatments.
The Company’s CE Mark allows the Company to market the Titan in the EU, Australia and certain other countries outside the U.S. for the treatment of
wrinkles through skin tightening. However, in the U.S. the Company has a 510(k) clearance for only deep dermal heating.
Sales and Marketing
The Company markets, sells, and services the Company’s products through direct sales and service employees in North America (including Canada),
Australia, Austria, Belgium, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, Spain, Switzerland and the United Kingdom. International sales and services outside
of these direct markets are made through a network of distributors in over 42 countries, as well as a direct international sales force. The Company
internally manages its U.S. and Canadian sales organization as one North American sales region.
The Company also sells certain items like hand piece refills, cycle refills, consumable tips, and marketing brochures through the Company’s web site
www.cutera.com.
Customers generally demand quality, performance, ease of use and high productivity in relation to the cost of ownership. The Company responds to
these customer demands by introducing new products focused on these requirements in the markets it serves. Specifically, the Company believes it
introduces new products and applications that are innovative, address the specific aesthetic procedures in demand, and are upgradeable on its customers’
existing systems. In addition, the Company provides attractive upgrade pricing to new product families. To increase market penetration, the Company
also markets to non-core practitioners in addition to the Company’s core specialties of plastic surgeons and dermatologists.
The Company seeks to establish strong ongoing relationships with its customers through the upgradeability of the Company’s products, sales of
extended service contracts, hand piece refills and replacement disposable tips, ongoing training and support, and by distributing skincare products in
Japan. The Company primarily targets its marketing efforts to practitioners through office visits, workshops, trade shows, webinars and trade journals.
The Company also markets to potential patients through brochures, workshops and its website. In addition, the Company offers clinical forums with
recognized expert panelists to promote advanced treatment techniques using the Company’s products to further enhance customer loyalty and uncover
new sales opportunities.
11
Table of Contents
Competition
The industry in which the Company operates is subject to intense competition. The Company’s products compete against conventional non-energy-
based treatments, such as electrolysis, Botox and collagen injections, chemical peels, microdermabrasion and sclerotherapy. The products also compete
against laser and other energy-based products offered by other public companies, such as Abbvie (acquired Allergan, formerly Zeltiq), Sientra, Bausch
Health (formerly Valeant Pharmaceuticals), Vieve, Soliton, InMode and Lutronic, as well as private companies, including Sisram, Candela (formerly
Syneron Candela, acquired in 2017 by an affiliate of private equity funds advised by Apax Partners), Sciton, BTL Industries and several others.
Additionally, in early 2020, the affiliated private equity funds of Baring Private Equity Asia completed the acquisition of Lumenis, a leading provider
of specialty energy-based medical devices across the fields of aesthetics, urology, ophthalmology, ENT and gynecology, with an international presence.
Also in late 2019, Clayton, Dubilier & Rice entered into an agreement under which its-managed funds acquired Cynosure, LLC, a leader in medical
aesthetics systems and technologies, from Hologic, Inc. Cynosure develops, manufactures, and markets medical aesthetic treatment systems for
dermatologists, plastic surgeons, medical spas and other healthcare practitioners, with sales and distribution worldwide.
Competition among providers of laser and other energy-based devices for the aesthetic market is characterized by extensive research and development
efforts, and innovative technology. While the Company attempts to protect its products through patents and other intellectual property rights, there are
few barriers to entry that would prevent new entrants or existing competitors from developing products that would compete directly with the Company.
There are many companies, both public and private, that are developing innovative devices that use both energy-based and alternative technologies.
Some of these competitors have greater resources than the Company does or product applications for certain sub-markets in which the Company does
not participate. Additional competitors may enter the market, and the Company is likely to compete with new companies in the future. To compete
effectively, the Company has to demonstrate that the Company’s products are attractive alternatives to other devices and treatments by differentiating the
Company’s products on the basis of performance, brand name, service and price. The Company has encountered, and expects to continue to encounter,
potential customers who, due to existing relationships with the Company’s competitors, are committed to, or prefer, the products offered by these
competitors. Competitive pressures may result in price reductions and reduced margins for the Company’s products.
The Company also sells skincare products in Japan under the exclusive distribution agreement with ZO which granted the Company the exclusive right
to promote, market, sell, and distribute the products produced by ZO in Japan. ZO’s skincare products compete against other Physician-dispensed
skincare brands developed and marketed by other companies, such as Environ, Navision and Revision Skincare.
Research and Development
The Company focuses its research and development efforts on innovation and improvement for products and services that align with its mission. The
Company consistently strives to understand its customers’ expectations for total excellence. The Company accomplishes this by its commitment to
continuous improvement in design, manufacturing, and service, which the Company believes provides for superior products and services to ensure on
going customer satisfaction, trust and loyalty. The Company seeks to comply with all applicable domestic and international regulations to maintain the
highest quality.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company’s research and development activities were conducted by employees with a broad base of experience in lasers,
optoelectronics, software, and other related disciplines. The Company develops working relationships with outside contract engineering and design
consultants, giving the Company’s team additional technical and creative breadth. The Company works closely with thought leaders and customers, to
understand unmet needs and emerging applications in aesthetic medicine.
Acquisitions, Investments, and Distribution Agreements
The Company’s strategy of providing a broad range of therapeutic capabilities requires a wide variety of technologies, products, and capabilities. The
rapid pace of technological development in the aesthetic device industry and the specialized expertise required in different areas make it difficult for the
Company to develop a broad portfolio of technological solutions. In addition to internally generated growth through research and development efforts,
the Company has considered, and expects to continue to consider, acquisitions, investments, and distribution agreements to provide access to new
products and technologies in both new and existing markets.
The Company expects to further the Company’s strategic objectives and strengthen its existing businesses by making future acquisitions and
investments, or by entering into new distribution agreements in areas that the Company believes it can acquire or stimulate the development of new
technologies and products. Mergers and acquisitions of medical technology companies, as well as distribution relationships, are inherently risky and no
assurance can be given that any acquisition will be successful or will not materially adversely affect the Company’s consolidated operations, financial
condition and cash flows.
Manufacturing
The Company manufactures its products with components and subassemblies supplied by vendors and assembles and tests each of its products at the
Brisbane, California facility, and at third party contract manufacturers’ facilities. Quality control, cost reduction and inventory management are top
priorities of the manufacturing operations.
The Company purchases certain components, subassemblies, and assembled systems from a limited number of suppliers. The Company has flexibility
with its suppliers to adjust the number of components and subassemblies as well as the delivery schedules. The forecasts are based on historical
demands and sales projections. Lead times for components and subassemblies may vary significantly depending on the size of the order, time required to
fabricate and test the components or subassemblies, specific supplier requirements and current market demand for the components and subassemblies.
The potential for disruption of supply is reduced by maintaining sufficient inventories and identifying additional suppliers. The time required to qualify
new suppliers for some components, or to redesign them, could cause delays in the Company’s manufacturing. To date, the Company has not
experienced significant delays in obtaining any of its components or subassemblies.
12
Table of Contents
Patents and Proprietary Technology
The Company relies on a combination of patent, copyright, trademark and trade secret laws, and non-disclosure, confidentiality, and invention
assignment agreements to protect the Company’s intellectual property rights. As of January 25, 2021, the Company had 26 issued U.S. patents and 5
pending U.S. patent applications. The Company intends to file for additional patents and trademarks to continue to strengthen the Company’s
intellectual property rights. Patents typically have a 20-year term from the application filing date. There can be no assurance that pending patent
applications will result in the issuance of patents, that patents issued to or licensed by the Company will not be challenged or circumvented by
competitors, or that these patents will be found to be valid or sufficiently broad to protect the Company’s technology or to provide the Company with a
competitive advantage.
The Company has also obtained certain trademarks and trade names for the Company’s products and maintain certain details about the Company’s
processes, products, and strategies as trade secrets. In the U.S. and several foreign countries, the Company registers its Company name and several of its
product names as trademarks, including Cutera, AcuTip, CoolGlide, CoolGlide excel, excel, enlighten, Juliet, LimeLight, myQ, Pearl, ProWave 770,
ProWave LX , SecretRF, Secret PRO, Titan, truSculpt and xeo. The Company may have common law rights in other product names, including excel V,
Pearl Fractional, Solera, Titan and excel HR. The Company intends to file for additional trademarks to continue to strengthen the Company’s intellectual
property rights.
The Company relies on non-disclosure and non-competition agreements with employees, technical consultants, and other parties to protect, in part, trade
secrets and other proprietary technology. The Company also requires them to agree to disclose and assign to the Company all inventions conceived in
connection with the relationship. There can be no assurance that these agreements will not be breached, that the Company will have adequate remedies
for any breach, that others will not independently develop equivalent proprietary information or that third parties will not otherwise gain access to the
Company’s trade secrets and proprietary knowledge.
For additional information, please refer to Item 1A. Risk Factors of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, under the section entitled “Risk Factors -
Intellectual property rights may not provide adequate protection for some or all of the Company’s products, which may permit third parties to compete
against the Company more effectively, and the Company may be involved in future costly intellectual property litigation, which could impact the
Company’s future business and financial performance.”
Government Regulation
United States
The Company’s products are medical devices subject to regulation by numerous government agencies, including the FDA and counterpart agencies
outside the U.S. To varying degrees, each of these agencies require the Company to comply with laws and regulations governing the research,
development, testing, manufacturing, labeling, pre-market clearance or approval, marketing, distribution, advertising, promotion, record keeping,
reporting, tracking, and importing and exporting of medical devices. In the U.S., FDA regulations govern the following activities that the Company
performs and will continue to perform to ensure that medical products distributed domestically or exported internationally are safe and effective for their
intended uses:
●product design and development;
●product testing;
●product manufacturing;
●product safety;
●product labeling;
●product storage;
●record keeping;
●pre-market clearance or approval;
●advertising and promotion;
●production;
●product sales and distribution; and
●complaint handling.
FDA’s Pre-market Clearance Requirements
Unless an exemption applies, each medical device the Company wishes to commercially distribute in the U.S. will require either prior 510(k) clearance,
or de novo approval from the FDA. The FDA classifies medical devices into one of three classes. Devices deemed to pose lower risks are placed in
either Class I or II. For Class II, the manufacturer must submit to the FDA a pre-market notification requesting permission to commercially distribute
the device. This process is known as 510(k) clearance. Some low risk devices are exempted from this requirement. Devices deemed by the FDA to pose
the greatest risk, such as life-sustaining, life-supporting or implantable devices, or devices deemed not substantially equivalent to a previously cleared
510(k) device, are placed in Class III, requiring more rigorous pre-market approval. All of the Company’s current products are Class II devices.
510(k) Clearance Pathway
When 510(k) clearance is required, the Company must submit a pre-market notification demonstrating that the Company’s proposed device is
substantially equivalent to a previously cleared 510(k) device or a device that was in commercial distribution before May 28, 1976 for which the FDA
has not yet called for the submission of Pre-Market Approval, or "PMA", applications. By regulation, the FDA is required to clear or deny 510(k), pre-
market notification within 90 days of submission of the application. As a practical matter, clearance may take significantly longer, as FDA may require
additional information. Laser devices used for aesthetic procedures, such as hair removal, have generally qualified for clearance under 510(k)
procedures.
13
Table of Contents
The following table details the indications for which the Company received a 510(k) clearance for the Company’s products and when these clearances
were received.
FDA Marketing Clearances:
Laser-based products:
- treatment of vascular lesions
- hair removal
- permanent hair reduction
- treatment of benign pigmented lesions and pseudo folliculitis barbae, commonly referred to
as razor bumps, and for the reduction of red pigmentation in scars
- treatment of wrinkles
- treatment to increase clear nail in patients with onychomycosis
- expanded spot size to 5 mm for clear nail in patients with onychomycosis
- addition of Alexandrite 755 nm laser wavelength for hair removal, permanent hair reduction,
treatment of vascular, benign pigmented lesions and treatment of wrinkles
- addition of treatment of mild to moderate inflammatory acne vulgaris
- enlighten picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for the treatment of benign pigmented
lesions
- enlighten picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for multi-colored tattoo removal
- enlighten III picosecond and nanosecond 532/1064 nm for multi-colored tattoo removal and
treatment of benign pigmented lesion and picosecond 670 nm for benign pigmented lesions
- enlighten III higher performance specifications for 532/1064 nm; addition of nanosecond
mode for 670nm
- enlighten III addition of tattoo removal for lighter colored inks (green and blue) for 670 nm
- enlighten Micro Lens Array (MLA) for treatment of acne scars
Pulsed-light technologies:
- treatment of pigmented lesions
- hair removal and vascular treatments
Infrared Titan technology for deep dermal heating for the temporary relief of minor muscle and
joint pain and for the temporary increase in local circulation where applied
Solera tabletop console:
- for use with the Titan hand piece
- for use with the Company’s pulsed-light hand pieces
Pearl product for the treatment of wrinkles
Pearl Fractional product for skin resurfacing and coagulation
truSculpt radio frequency product:
- for topical heating to elevate tissue temperature for the treatment of selected medical
conditions such as relief of pain and muscle spasms and increase in local circulation; massage
device for temporary reduction in the appearance of cellulite
- Temporary reduction in circumference of the abdomen
- truSculpt iD: Hands-free treatment powering sequentially six 40 cm2 puck-style applicators
- truSculpt iD: For non-invasive lipolysis of the abdomen and for reduction in circumference
of the abdomen
- truSculpt flex: for improvement of abdominal tone, strengthening of abdominal muscles, and
development of firmer abdomen; and strengthening, toning, and firming of buttocks and
thighs
14
Date Received:
June 1999
March 2000
January 2001
June 2002
October 2002
April 2011
May 2013
December 2013
March 2016
August 2014
November 2014
October 2016
April 2016
October 2017
December 2018
March 2003
March 2005
February 2004
October 2004
January 2005
March 2007
August 2008
April 2008
December 2016
August 2017
June 2018
June 2019
Table of Contents
Product Modifications
Pursuant to FDA regulations, after a device receives 510(k) clearance, any modification that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness, or that
would constitute a major change in its intended use, labeling and biocompatibility, requires a new clearance. The FDA requires manufacturers to make
this determination initially, but the FDA can review any such decision and may disagree with a manufacturer’s determination. To date, the Company has
modified aspects of the Company’s products after receiving regulatory clearance and determined that new 510(k) clearances are not required for these
modifications. If the FDA disagrees with the Company’s determination not to seek a new 510(k) clearance, the FDA may retroactively require the
Company to seek 510(k) clearance.
Clinical Trials
When FDA approval of a Class II device requires human clinical trials, only approval from the Institutional Review Board (“IRB”), is required to
proceed with the planned and IRB approved clinical trial/study.
The Company is required to manufacture the Company’s products in compliance with the FDA’s Quality System Regulation (“QSR”) and the
international quality management standard for medical systems ISO 13485:2016. The QSR and ISO 13485 cover the methods and documentation of the
design, testing, control, manufacturing, labeling, quality assurance, packaging, storage and shipping of the Company’s products. Since 2017, the
Company has been enrolled in the Medical Device Single Audit Program (“MDSAP”). The MDSAP allows a single audit of a medical device
manufacturer’s Quality Management System (“QMS”), which satisfies the requirements of 5 regulatory jurisdictions (FDA - US, Health Canada -
Canada, Therapeutic Goods Administration (“TGA”) - Australia, Pharmaceuticals and Medical Devices Agency (“PMDA”) - Japan, and Agência
Nacional de Vigilancia Sanitária (“ANVISA”) - Brazil); and for the EU under Europäische Norm (“EN”) International Standards Organization (“ISO”)
13485:2016 and Medical Device Directive (MDD)/EU Medical Device Regulation MDR”).
MDSAP re-certification occurs every three years with a surveillance audit taking place annually. Major findings during these audits or an increase in
field reportable events could trigger regulatory enforcement action including by the FDA. The Company’s manufacturing facility is ISO 13485 certified.
The Company had a successful MDSAP re-certification audit in January 2021. There were no significant findings or observations as a result of this
audit; however, the Company’s failure to maintain compliance with the QSR requirements could result in the shutdown of the Company’s manufacturing
operations and the recall of the Company’s products, which would have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business. In the event that one of the
Company’s suppliers fails to maintain compliance with specified quality requirements, the Company may have to qualify a new supplier and could
experience manufacturing delays as a result. The Company has opted to maintain quality assurance and quality management certifications to enable the
Company to market the Company’s products in the U.S., the member states of the EU, the European Free Trade Association and countries which have
entered into Mutual Recognition Agreements with the EU.
Pervasive and Continuing Regulation
After a device is placed on the market, numerous regulatory requirements apply. These include:
● Quality system regulations, which require manufacturers, including third-party manufacturers, to follow stringent design, testing, control,
documentation and other quality assurance procedures during all aspects of the manufacturing process;
● Labeling regulations and FDA prohibitions against the promotion of products for un-cleared, unapproved or “off-label” uses;
● Medical device reporting regulations, which require that manufacturers report to the FDA if their device may have caused or contributed to a death or
serious injury or malfunctioned in a way that would likely cause or contribute to a death or serious injury if the malfunction were to recur; and
● Post-market surveillance regulations, which apply when necessary to protect the public health or to provide additional safety and effectiveness data
for the device.
The FDA has broad post-market and regulatory enforcement powers. The Company is subject to unannounced inspections by the FDA and the Food and
Drug Branch of the California Department of Health Services (or “CDHS”), to determine the Company’s compliance with the QSR and other applicable
regulations, which may include the manufacturing facilities of the Company’s subcontractors. In the past, the Company’s current manufacturing facility
has been inspected by the FDA and the CDHS. The FDA and the CDHS noted observations, but there were no findings that involved a material violation
of regulatory requirements. The Company’s responses to those observations have been accepted by the FDA and CDHS.
The Company is also regulated under the Radiation Control for Health and Safety Act, which requires laser products to comply with performance
standards, including design and operation requirements, and manufacturers to certify in product labeling and in reports to the FDA that their products
comply with all such standards. The regulations also require laser manufacturers to file new product and annual reports, maintain manufacturing, testing
and sales records, and report product defects. Various warning labels must be affixed and certain protective devices installed, depending on the class of
the product.
Failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements can result in enforcement action by the FDA, which may include any of the following
sanctions:
●Warning letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;
●Repair, replacement, recall or seizure of the Company’s products;
●Operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;
●Refusing the Company’s requests for 510(k) clearance of new products, new intended uses, or modifications to existing products;
●Withdrawing 510(k) clearance that have already been granted; and
●Criminal prosecution and penalties.
The FDA also has the authority to require the Company to repair, replace or refund the cost of any medical device that it has manufactured or
distributed. If any of these events were to occur, they could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business.
The Company is also subject to a wide range of federal, state and local laws and regulations, including those related to the environment, health and
safety, land use and quality assurance. The Company believes that compliance with these laws and regulations as currently in effect will not have a
material adverse effect on the Company’s capital expenditures, earnings and competitive and financial position.
15
Table of Contents
International
International sales of medical devices are subject to foreign governmental regulations, which vary substantially from country to country. The time
required to obtain clearance or approval by a foreign country may be different than that required for FDA clearance. And the clearance or approval
requirements may be different from those in the U.S.
In Japan, the Company is actively seeking approvals for products to supplement the Company’s existing approvals for enlighten, excel V, excel HR ,
LimeLight, ProWave, Solera, Titan, truSculpt iD and xeo.
In the European Economic Area (“EEA”), which is composed of the 28 Member States of the EU plus Norway, Liechtenstein and Iceland, a single
regulatory approval process exists, and conformity with the legal requirements is represented by the CE mark. While it remains somewhat unresolved,
the cabinet of the United Kingdom agrees that the UK should maintain conformity with the CE mark process following Brexit. Other countries, such as
Switzerland, have entered into Mutual Recognition Agreements and allow the marketing of medical devices that meet EU requirements. The EU has
adopted numerous directives and European Standardization Committees have promulgated voluntary standards regulating the design, manufacture,
clinical trials, labeling and adverse event reporting for medical devices. Devices that comply with the requirements of a relevant directive will be entitled
to bear CE conformity marking, indicating that the device conforms to the essential requirements of the applicable directives and, accordingly, can be
commercially distributed throughout the EEA and countries which have entered into a Mutual Recognition Agreement. The method of assessing
conformity varies depending on the type and class of the product, but normally involves a combination of self-assessment by the manufacturer and a
third-party assessment by a Notified Body, an independent and neutral institution appointed by a country to conduct the conformity assessment. This
third-party assessment may consist of an audit of the manufacturer’s quality system and specific testing of the manufacturer’s device. An assessment by
a Notified Body in one member state of the EEA, or one country which has entered into a Mutual Recognition Agreement is required in order for a
manufacturer to commercially distribute the product throughout these countries. ISO 9001 and ISO 13845 certification are voluntary harmonized
standards. Compliance establishes the presumption of conformity with the essential requirements for a CE Marking. In February 2000, the Company’s
facility was awarded the ISO 9001 and EN 46001 certification.
In March 2003, the Company received the Company’s ISO 9001 updated certification (ISO 9001:2000) as well as the Company’s certification for ISO
13485:1996 which replaced the Company’s EN 46001 certification. In March 2004, the Company received the Company’s ISO 13485:2003 certification
and in March 2006, March 2009, and January 2012 the Company passed ISO 13485 recertification audits. In January 2015, the Company passed a
recertification audit establishing compliance with the requirements of EN ISO 13485:2012, CAN/CSA ISO 13485:2003, and MDD 93/42/EEC. In
January 2018, the Company conducted the Company’s recertification audit to the requirements of ISO 13485:2003 under the MDSAP for the five
regulatory jurisdictions signatory to MDSAP (FDA - US, Health Canada - Canada, TGA - Australia, PMDA - Japan, and ANVISA - Brazil); and for the
EU under EN ISO 13485:2016 and MDD 93/42/EEC. In January 2021, the Company passed the recertification audit re-confirming compliance with
ISO13485:2016 and MDSAP. The MDSAP and EU certification can be used to demonstrate compliance with GMP/QSR/QMS requirements for all five
regulatory jurisdictions, replacing routine audits from each regulatory jurisdiction. For cause audits can still occur.
Applicability of Anti-Corruption Laws and Regulations
The Company’s worldwide business is subject to the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977 (the “FCPA”), the United Kingdom Bribery Act of
2010 (the “UK Bribery Act”) and other anti-corruption laws and regulations applicable in the jurisdictions where the Company operates. The FCPA can
be used to prosecute companies in the U.S. for arrangements with physicians, or other parties outside the U.S., if the physician or party is a government
official of another country and the arrangement violates the law of that country. The UK Bribery Act prohibits both domestic and international bribery,
as well as bribery across both public and private sectors. There are similar laws and regulations applicable to the Company outside the U.S., all of
which are subject to evolving interpretations. For additional information, please refer to Item 1A. Risk Factors of this Annual Report on Form 10-K,
under the sections entitled “Risk Factors – the Company’s failure to comply with rules relating to bribery, foreign corrupt practices and privacy and
security laws may subject the Company to penalties and adversely impact the Company’s reputation and business operations.”
Patient Privacy and Security Laws
Various laws worldwide protect the confidentiality of certain patient health and other consumer information, including patient medical records, and
restrict the use and disclosure of patient health information by healthcare providers. Privacy standards in Europe and Asia are becoming increasingly
strict, enforcement action and financial penalties related to privacy in the EU are growing, and new laws and restrictions are being passed. The
management of cross-border transfers of information among and outside of EU member countries is becoming more complex, which may complicate the
Company’s clinical research and commercial activities, as well as product offerings that involve transmission or use of data. The Company will continue
its efforts to comply with those requirements and to adapt the Company’s business processes to those standards.
In the U.S., the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996 (“HIPAA”), as amended by the Health Information Technology and Clinical
Health Act (“HITECH”) and their respective implementing regulations, including the final omnibus rule published on January 25, 2013, imposes
specified requirements relating to the privacy, security and transmission of individually identifiable health information. Among other things, HITECH
makes HIPAA’s privacy and security standards directly applicable to “business associates,” defined as independent contractors or agents of covered
entities that create, receive, maintain or transmit protected health information in connection with providing a service for or on behalf of a covered entity.
HITECH also increased the civil and criminal penalties that may be imposed against covered entities, business associates and possibly other persons,
and gave state attorneys new general authority to file civil actions for damages or injunctions in federal court to enforce the federal HIPAA laws and
seek attorney’s fees and costs associated with pursuing federal civil actions. In addition, state laws govern the privacy and security of health information
in certain circumstances, many of which differ from each other in significant ways, thus complicating compliance efforts. The Company potentially
operates as a business associate to covered entities in a limited number of instances. In those cases, the patient data that the Company receives may
include protected health information, as defined under HIPAA. Enforcement actions can be costly and interrupt regular operations of its business. While
the Company has not been named in any such actions, if a substantial breach or loss of data from the Company’s records were to occur, the Company
could become a target of such litigation.
16
Table of Contents
In the EU, Regulation 2016/679 on the protection of natural persons with regard to the processing of personal data and on the free movement of such
data (“General Data Protection Regulation” or “GDPR”) came into effect on May 25, 2018. The GDPR replaces Directive 95/46/EC (“Data Protection
Directive”). While many of the principles of the GDPR reflect those of the Data Protection Directive, for example in relation to the requirements relating
to the privacy, security and transmission of individually identifiable health information, there are a number of changes. In particular: (1) pro-active
compliance measures are introduced, such as the requirement to carry out a Privacy Impact Assessment and to appoint a Data Protection Officer where
health data is processed on a “large scale;” and (2) the administrative fines that can be levied are significantly increased, the maximum being the higher
of €20 million, or 4%, of the total worldwide annual turnover of the group in the previous financial year. The Company will continue its efforts to
comply with the GDPR requirements and to adapt the Company’s business processes to those requirements.
Environmental Health and Safety Laws
The Company is also subject to various environmental health and safety laws and regulations worldwide. Like other medical device companies, the
Company’s manufacturing and other operations involve the use and transportation of substances regulated under environmental health and safety laws
including those related to the transportation of hazardous materials. To the best of the Company’s knowledge at this time, the Company does not expect
that compliance with environmental protection laws will have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated results of operations, financial position
or cash flows.
Employees and Human Capital
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had 323 employees, compared to 447 employees as of December 31, 2019. The Company believes that its
future success will depend in part on the Company’s continued ability to attract, hire and retain qualified personnel. None of the Company’s employees
are represented by a labor union, and the Company believes its employee relations are good. The Company is committed to fostering a diverse and
inclusive workplace that attracts and retains exceptional talent. Through ongoing employee development, comprehensive compensation and benefits,
and a focus on health, safety and employee wellbeing, the Company strives to help its employees in all aspects of their lives so they can do their best
work.
Diversity, Equity and Inclusion
The Company is committed to create and maintain a diverse and safe work environment to capture the ideas and perspectives that fuel innovation and
enable its workforce, customers, and communities to succeed in creating the future of medical aesthetics. The Company strives to create an inclusive
workplace where people can design, manufacture, and market a comprehensive portfolio of aesthetic laser and energy-based products that enable its
customers (the practitioner) to provide safe and effective treatments. Its commitment to diversity and inclusion starts at the highest levels of the
Company.
Employee Engagement
The Company regularly collects feedback to better understand and improve the employee experience and identify opportunities to continually strengthen
its culture. The Company wants to know what is working well, what the Company can do better and how well its associates understand and practicing its
cultural values. In 2020, nearly 86% of its employees participated in its annual employee survey.
Leadership development and training
At Cutera, the Company believes that the best leaders are the ones who come from within. These leaders learn with Cutera, grow with Cutera and reach
their potential through challenging job experiences. The Company provides deliberate learning opportunities by offering valuable training resources for
employees in order to ensure its people have everything they need to succeed both personally and professionally. The Company’s employees are
encouraged to take responsibility for their own development and create learning plans that best fit their needs and development goals.
Health, Safety and Wellness
The physical health, financial wellbeing, life balance and mental health of its employees is vital to its success. The Company sponsors wellness
initiatives designed to enhance physical, financial, and mental wellbeing for all employees. The Company has successfully implemented a number of
safety and social distancing measures within its premises to protect the health and safety of associates who are required to be on-premise to support its
business.
Available Information
The Company makes its periodic and current reports, including the Company's Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current
Reports on Form 8-K and any amendments to those reports, filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934,
as well as its charters for the Company's Audit and Compensation Committees and its Code of Ethics, available free of charge, on the Company’s
website as soon as practicable after such material is electronically filed or furnished with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). The
Company’s website address is www.cutera.comand the reports are filed under “SEC Filings,” under “Financials” on the Investor Relations portion of the
Company’s website. These reports and other information concerning the Company may be accessed through the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.
ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS
The Company operates in a rapidly changing economic and technological environment that presents numerous risks, many of which are driven by
factors that the Company cannot control or predict. The Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be impacted by a number
of factors. In addition to the factors discussed elsewhere in this report, the following risks and uncertainties could materially harm the Company’s
business, financial condition or results of operations, including causing the Company’s actual results to differ materially from those projected in any
forward-looking statements. The following list of significant risk factors is not all-inclusive or necessarily in order of importance. Additional risks and
uncertainties not presently known to the Company, or that the Company currently deems immaterial, also may materially adversely affect the Company
in future periods. You should carefully consider these risks and uncertainties before investing in the Company’s securities.
17
Table of Contents
Summary of Risk Factors
The Company’s business, financial condition, operating results and cash flows are subject to numerous risks and uncertainties that are summarized below.
The below summary of risk factors should be read together with the more detailed discussion of risks set forth following this section under the heading
“Risk Factors,” as well as elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Risks Related to the Company’s Business and its Industry
■ The Company’s business, financial condition, liquidity, capital, and results of operations have been, and may continue to be, adversely
affected by the COVID-19 pandemic.
■ The increase in sales of skincare products in Japan may be temporarily caused by the change in its customer’s spending habit due to the
COVID-19 pandemic.
■ Any defects in the design, material or workmanship of its products, defective design, material or workmanship or misuse of its products
will cause additional costs, including product recalls and product liability suits, and harm the Company’s reputation.
■ Failure in hiring, training and retaining Sales professional and skilled and experienced personnel, or changes to management will cause
adversely affects the Company’s operation and operation results.
■ The aesthetic equipment market is characterized by rapid innovation, product innovation and high competition.
■ The Company competes against companies that offer alternative solutions to its products, have greater resources, or have a larger installed
base of customers and broader product offerings than the Company’s.
■ The Company’s business is subject to regulatory requirements, laser performance standards, federal regulatory reforms, FDA and other
government agencies’ regulation and oversight which may negatively affect its business, financial condition and results of operations if
the Company fails to comply with them.
■ The Company's products may cause or contribute to adverse medical events or be subject to failures or malfunctions that would be subject
to sanctions that could harm its reputation, business, financial condition and results of operations.
■ The Company may be unable to obtain or maintain international regulatory qualifications or approvals for its current or future products
and indications, which could harm its business.
■ Failure in International expansion and economic and other risks associated with international sales and operations could adversely affect
the Company’s business.
■ Some of the Company’s manufacturing operations are dependent upon third-party suppliers, making its vulnerable to supply shortages
and price fluctuations, which could harm its business.
■ Reduction or interruption in supply and an inability to develop alternative sources for supply may adversely affect the Company’s
manufacturing operations and related product sales.
■ If customers are not trained and/or the Company’s products are used by non-licensed practitioners, it could result in product misuse and
adverse treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s reputation, result in product liability litigation, distract management and
result in additional costs, all of which could harm the Company’s business.
■ The Company’s products are subject to clinical trial process which is lengthy and expensive with uncertain outcomes. Delays or failures
in the Company's clinical trials will prevent it from commercializing any modified or new products.
■ Intellectual property rights may not provide adequate protection for some or all the Company’s products, or the Company may be
involved in future costly intellectual property litigation.
■ The expense and potential unavailability of insurance coverage for the Company’s customers could adversely affect its ability to sell its
products, and therefore adversely affect its financial condition.
■ Any acquisitions that the Company makes could result in operating difficulties, dilution, and other consequences that may adversely
impact the Company’s business and results of operations.
■ Inability to access credit on favorable terms for the funding of the Company’s operations and capital projects may be limited due to
changes in credit markets.
■ Security breaches, cyber-security incidents and other disruptions could compromise the Company’s information and impact the
Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations.
■ Macroeconomic political and market conditions, and catastrophic events may adversely affect the Company’s business, results of
operations, financial condition and the trading price of the notes and the stock.
■ The Company has a relatively limited number of shares of common stock outstanding, which could result in the increase in volatility of
its stock price and the trading price of the notes.
■ Disaster or other similar event could cause damage to its facilities and equipment, which might require the Company to cease or curtail
sales of these sole sourced platforms.
■ Income tax audits or similar proceedings or changes in accounting standards may have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results
of operations and financial position.
18
Table of Contents
Risks Related to the Notes
■ Although the notes are referred to as convertible senior notes, they are effectively subordinated to any of the Company's secured debt and
any liabilities of its subsidiaries.
■ Regulatory actions and other events may adversely affect the trading price and liquidity of the notes.
■ Volatility in the market price and trading volume of the Company's common stock could adversely impact the trading price of the notes.
■ The Company may still incur substantially more debt or take other actions which would intensify the risks discussed above.
■ The Company may not have the ability to raise the funds necessary to settle conversions of the notes in cash or to repurchase the notes
upon a fundamental change, and its future debt may contain limitations on its ability to pay cash upon conversion or repurchase of the
notes.
■ The conditional conversion feature of the notes, if triggered, may adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating
results.
■ The accounting method for the notes could adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.
■ Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock, but they will be subject to all changes
made with respect to the Company's common stock to the extent the Company satisfies its conversion obligation, in whole or in part, with
shares of its common stock.
■ The conditional conversion feature of the notes could result in holders receiving less than the value of the Company's common stock into
which the notes would otherwise be convertible.
■ Upon conversion of the notes, holders may receive less valuable consideration than expected because the value of the
Company's common stock may decline after holders exercise their conversion right but before the Company satisfies it conversion
obligation.
■ The notes are not protected by restrictive covenants.
■ The increase in the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption
period may not adequately compensate holders for any lost value of their notes as a result of such transaction or redemption.
■ The conversion rate of the notes may not be adjusted for all dilutive events.
■ Provisions in the indenture governing the notes may deter or prevent a business combination that may be favorable to the holders.
■ The capped call transactions may affect the value of the notes and the Company's common stock.
■ The Company is subject to counterparty risk with respect to the capped call transactions.
■ Some significant restructuring transactions may not constitute a fundamental change, in which case the Company would not be obligated
to offer to repurchase the notes.
■ The Company has not registered the notes or the common stock issuable upon conversion, if any, which will limit the ability of holders to
resell them.
■ The Company cannot assure the holders of the notes that an active trading market will develop for the notes.
■ Any adverse rating of the notes may cause their trading price to fall.
■ The holders of the notes may be subject to tax if the Company makes or fails to make certain adjustments to the conversion rate of the
notes even though the holders do not receive a corresponding cash distribution.
■ The Company may redeem the notes at its option, which may adversely affect the holders' return.
■ The notes will initially be held in book-entry form and, therefore, holders must rely on the procedures and the relevant clearing systems to
exercise their rights and remedies.
Risks Related to Ownership of the Company's Common Stock
■ Anti-takeover provisions contained in the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws,
as well as provisions of Delaware law, could impair a takeover attempt.
■ The Company's business could be negatively affected by activist shareholders.
■ If securities or industry analysts do not publish or cease publishing research or reports about the Company, its business, its market or
its competitors, or if they adversely change their recommendations regarding the Company's common stock, the market price and trading
volume of its notes and common stock could decline.
■ The Company does not expect to declare any dividends on its common stock in the foreseeable future.
■ If the Company raises additional capital through the sale of shares of the Company’s common stock, convertible securities or debt in the
future, its stockholders’ ownership in the Company could be diluted and restrictions could be imposed on the Company’s business.
19
Table of Contents
Risks Related to the Company’s Business and its Industry
The effects of the COVID-19 pandemic have affected how the Company and its customers are operating its businesses, and the duration and extent to
which this will impact its future results of operations and overall financial performance remains uncertain.
The COVID-19 pandemic and related public health measures have affected how the Company and its customers are operating their businesses and have
materially and adversely affected the Company’s business and the Company’s financial results. To date, the impact includes: a) the deferral of
procedures using its products, b) disruptions or restrictions on the ability of many of the Company’s employees and of third parties on which the
Company relies, to work effectively, including “stay-at-home” orders and similar government actions; and c) temporary closures of its facilities and of
the facilities of the Company’s customers and suppliers. If the pandemic has a substantial impact on its employees’ or customers’ businesses and
productivity, the Company’s results of operations and overall financial performance may be materially and adversely affected. The global
macroeconomic effects of the pandemic may persist for an indefinite period, even after the pandemic has subsided.
As jurisdictions throughout the world continue to respond to the pandemic, the degree of the foregoing impacts may increase in scope or magnitude
or the Company may experience additional adverse effects in one or more regions. Any other outbreaks of contagious diseases or other adverse public
health developments in countries where the Company operates or where its customers or suppliers are located could also have a material and adverse
effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations.
Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, customers and their patients have been, and in certain regions continue to be, required, or are choosing, to defer
elective procedures in which the Company's products otherwise could be used, and many facilities that specialize in the procedures in which the
Company's products otherwise could be used have temporarily closed and in some cases continue to be temporarily closed or operating at reduced hours.
In addition, even after the pandemic subsides or governmental orders no longer prohibit or recommend against performing such procedures, patients
may continue to defer such procedures due to personal concerns. Further, facilities at which its products typically are used may not reopen or, even if
they reopen, patients may elect to have procedures performed at facilities that are, or are perceived to be, lower-risk, such as private surgery centers,
and the Company's products may not be approved at such facilities, and the Company may be unable to have the Company's products approved for use
at such facilities on a timely basis, or at all. The effect of the pandemic on the broader economy could also negatively affect demand for elective
procedures using its products, both in the near- and long-term. Workforce limitations and travel restrictions resulting from government actions taken to
contain the spread of COVID-19 have and will continue to adversely affect almost every aspect of its business. If a significant percentage of the
Company's workforce, or of the workforce of third parties on which the Company relies, cannot work, including because of illness or travel or
government restrictions, its operations will be negatively affected. Because of government restrictions and social distancing guidelines in many countries
around the world, there is an increased reliance on working from home for the Company's workforce and on the workforce of third parties on which the
Company rely. For example, most of the Company's sales personnel and third-party agents currently are working largely using virtual and online
engagement tools and tactics, which may be less effective than its typical in-person sales and marketing programs. In addition, the Company reduced
access to its hands-on customer trainings, which, in turn, adversely impacted the Company's ability to educate and train customers on the proper use
of the Company's products, which may make surgeons less comfortable using, and therefore less likely to use, the Company's products. The
Company expects that “stay-at-home” orders will also limit its ability to develop, and therefore launch, the products the Company believes will drive the
Company’s future revenue growth on the timelines the Company anticipated previously, or at all, and could also delay the planned launch of products in
2021 and beyond. It may also cause the Company not to submit required filings on its previous timelines, including with the FDA, or other regulatory
bodies, both in the U.S. and outside the U.S. The continued spread of COVID-19 has adversely impacted the Company's clinical trial operations in the
United States. In addition, changes impacting workforce function at the FDA and other regulatory bodies, as well as changes impacting workforce
function at the facilities at which the Company seeks to have new products approved for use, could adversely impact the timing of when the
Company's new products are cleared for marketing and approved for use, either of which would adversely impact the timing of its ability to sell these
new products and would have a material and adverse effect on the Company's revenue growth.
As a result of the COVID-19 outbreak, some of the Company’s customers are being required to shelter-in-place and are not working. In cases where the
Company’s customers are working, they are performing fewer procedures. When they are performing procedures, customers are mostly focused on
medically necessary procedures that should not be delayed. Non-urgent, non-essential procedures are getting cancelled or delayed. As a result of fewer
aesthetic procedures being performed and anxiety about the economic future, the Company’s customers may cancel orders for laser systems or will use
less consumables. Some of the Company’s customers will feel less confident about making investments in their practices and focus on retaining their
cash. As a result of cash conservation efforts by the Company’s customers, the Company may also encounter problems collecting on its receivables,
which will impact the Company’s cash position and could result in negative cash flows.
Further, disruptions in the manufacture and distribution of the Company's products or in its supply chain may occur as a result of the COVID-19
pandemic, including for the reasons above, or other events that result in staffing shortages, production slowdowns, stoppages, or disruptions in delivery
systems, any of which could materially and adversely affect the Company's ability to manufacture or distribute its products, or to obtain the raw
materials and supplies necessary to manufacture and distribute the Company’s products, in a timely manner, or at all.
The Company may also experience other unknown adverse impacts from COVID-19 that cannot be predicted. For example, customers and other
facilities at which the Company sells its products may renegotiate their purchase prices, including as a result of, or the perception that they may be
suffering, financial difficulty as a result of the pandemic. Similarly, facilities at which the Company seeks to sell its products in the future may require
price reductions relative to the price at which the Company previously expected to sell its products. Reduction in the prices at which the Company sells
products to existing customers may have a material and adverse effect on its future financial results and reductions in the prices at which the
Company expected to sell products would have a material and adverse effect on its expectations for revenue growth.
Further, the global capital markets experienced, and the Company expects will continue to experience, disruption and volatility due to the COVID-19
pandemic, adversely impacting access to capital not only for the Company, but also for its customers and suppliers who need access to capital. Their
inability to access capital in a timely manner, or at all, could adversely impact demand for its products and/or adversely impact its ability to manufacture
or supply its products, any of which could have a material and adverse effect on the Company's business.
20
Table of Contents
The extent to which the COVID-19 pandemic will impact the Company’s business going forward will depend on numerous evolving factors that
cannot be reliably predicted, including the duration and scope of the pandemic; governmental, business, and individuals’ actions in response to the
pandemic; and the impact on economic activity including the possibility of recession or financial market instability.
The Company expects the customers will return and the amount of revenue to increase in 2021 compared to 2020 as the economic environment outlook
due to the COVID-19 pandemic improves; however, the COVID-19 outbreak continues to be fluid and the aftermath of the business and economic
disruptions due to the COVID-19 in 2020 is still uncertain, making it difficult to forecast the final impact it could have on the Company’s future
operations. The spread of the coronavirus, which caused a broad impact in 2020 globally, including restrictions on travel, shifting work force to work
remotely and quarantine policies put into place by businesses and governments, had a material economic effect on the Company’s business. Notably,
healthcare facilities in many countries effectively banned elective procedures. Many of the Company’s products are used in aesthetic elective procedures
and as such, the bans on elective procedures substantially reduced the Company’s sales and marketing efforts in the early months of the pandemic. The
Company cannot presently predict the scope and severity of any impacts in future periods from the business shutdowns or disruptions due to
the COVID-19 pandemic, but the impact on economic activity such as the possibility of recession or financial market instability could have a material
adverse effect on the Company’s business, revenue, operating results, cash flows and financial condition.
The increase in sales of skincare products in Japan may be temporary and sales of Skincare products may decline in the future.
During 2020, the Company experienced a significant increase in sales of skincare products under the exclusive distribution agreement with ZO which
allows the Company to sell ZO’s skincare products in Japan. The reason for the increase in skincare products sales might have been the result of changes
in customers’ spending habits to purchase more aesthetic treatments which could be applied at home due to limitations on in-person aesthetic
procedures, social distancing and mask wearing requirements due to the COVID-19 pandemic. Future growth in sales of skincare products depends on
the customers’ spending habits, which may change back to original spending habits after the COVID-19 pandemic. Such changes may have a material
adverse effect on the Company’s revenue, operating results and cash flows.
The Company may be deemed ineligible to have received the PPP loan, and the Company may be required to repay the PPP loan in its
entirety and could be subject to penalties. In addition, with respect to any portion of the PPP loan not forgiven, the Company may default on payment
or breach provisions of the PPP loan.
On April 22, 2020, the Company received loan proceeds of $7.1 million pursuant to the Paycheck Protection Program (the “PPP”) under the
Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (the “CARES Act”). The Company believes that the current economic uncertainty makes the loan
necessary to support ongoing operations.
The application for these funds required the Company to, in good faith, certify that the current economic uncertainty made the loan request necessary to
support the ongoing operations of the Company. Subsequently released guidance instructs all applicants and recipients to take into account their current
business activity and the Company's ability to access other sources of liquidity sufficient to support ongoing operations in a manner that is not
significantly detrimental to their business. On April 28, 2020, in press conference remarks, the Secretary of the U.S. Department of the Treasury stated
that the SBA intends to perform a review of PPP loans over $2.0 million. The required certification made by the Company is subject to interpretation. If,
despite the good-faith belief that given the Company’s circumstances the Company satisfied all eligible requirements for the PPP loan, it is later
determined the Company was ineligible to apply for and receive the PPP loan, the Company may be required to repay the PPP loan in its entirety and the
Company could be subject to additional penalties.
The loan, which is in the form of a promissory note, dated April 21, 2020, between the Company and Silicon Valley Bank as the lender (the “Loan”),
matures on April 21, 2022 and bears interest at a fixed rate of 1.00% per annum, payable monthly commencing in September 2021. There is no
prepayment penalty. Under the terms of the PPP, all or a portion of the principal may be forgiven if the Loan proceeds are used for qualifying expenses
as described in the CARES Act, such as payroll costs, benefits, rent, and utilities. No assurance can be provided that the Company will obtain
forgiveness of the Loan in whole or in part. With respect to any portion of the Loan that is not forgiven, the Loan will be subject to customary provisions
for a loan of this type, including customary events of default relating to, among other things, payment defaults and breaches of the provisions of the
Loan. The PPP loan will be derecognized upon repayment of the loan in accordance with its terms and/or upon confirmation of forgiveness from the
SBA.
The trading price of the Company’s notes and common stock may fluctuate substantially due to several factors, some of which are discussed below.
Further, the Company has a relatively limited number of shares of common stock outstanding, a large portion of which is held by a small number of
investors, which could result in the increase in volatility of its stock price and the trading price of the notes.
There has been recent volatility in the price of the Company’s common stock. The Company believes this is due in part to the overall impact of COVID-
19 on the aesthetic industry and its partial recovery, the remaining open territories associated with the Company’s North America salesforce, and other
factors. As a result of the Company’s relatively limited public float, its common stock may be less liquid than the stock of companies with broader
public ownership. Among other things, trading of a relatively small volume of the Company’s common stock may have a greater impact on the trading
price for the Company’s notes and shares than would be the case if the Company’s public float were larger. The public market price of the Company’s
common stock has in the past fluctuated substantially and, due to the current concentration of stockholders, the trading price of the notes and the
common stock may continue to do so in the future. The market price for the Company’s notes and common stock could also be affected by a number of
other factors, including the general market conditions unrelated to the Company’s operating performance, including market volatility as a result of
the COVID-19 outbreak.
21
Table of Contents
The market price for the Company’s notes and common stock could also be affected by a number of other factors, including:
●the general market conditions unrelated to the Company’s operating performance;
●sales of large blocks of the Company’s common stock, including sales by the Company’s executive officers, directors and large institutional investors;
●quarterly variations in the Company’s, or the Company’s competitors’, results of operations;
●actual or anticipated changes or fluctuations in the Company’s results of operations;
●actual or anticipated changes in analysts’ estimates, investors’ perceptions, recommendations by securities analysts or the Company’s failure to achieve
analysts ‘estimates;
●the announcement of new products, service enhancements, distributor relationships or acquisitions by the Company or the Company’s competitors;
●the announcement of the departure of a key employee or executive officer by the Company or the Company’s competitors;
●regulatory developments or delays concerning the Company’s, or the Company’s competitors’ products; and
●the initiation of any litigation by the Company or against the Company, including the lawsuit initiated by the Company on January 31, 2020 in Federal
District Court in California against Lutronic Aesthetics, Inc. as previously disclosed on February 3, 2020, or against the Company.
Actual or perceived instability and / or volatility in the Company’s stock price could reduce demand from potential buyers of the Company’s stock,
thereby causing the trading price of the Company’s notes and stock to either remain depressed or to decline further. In addition, if the market for
medical-device company stocks or the stock market in general experiences a loss of investor confidence, the trading price of the Company’s notes and
stock could decline for reasons unrelated to the Company’s business, results of operations or financial condition. The trading price of the Company’s
notes and common stock might also decline in reaction to events that affect other companies in the Company’s industry even if these events do not
directly affect us. In the past, following periods of volatility in the market price of a company’s securities, securities class action litigation has often been
brought against that company. Any future securities litigation could result in substantial costs and divert the Company’s management’s attention and
resources from the Company’s business. This could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial
condition.
Covenants in the Loan and Security Agreement governing the Company's revolving credit facility may restrict its operations, and if the Company
does not effectively manage its business to comply with these covenants, its financial condition could be adversely impacted.
The Company entered into a Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank in July 2020, which provides for a four-year secured revolving loan
facility in an aggregate principal amount of up to $30.0 million (the “senior credit facility”). The senior credit facility contains various restrictive
covenants, including, among other things, minimum liquidity and revenue requirements, restrictions on the Company's ability to dispose of assets, make
acquisitions or investments, incur debt or liens, make distributions to its stockholders, or enter into certain types of related party transactions. These
restrictions may restrict the Company's current and future operations, particularly the Company's ability to respond to certain changes in its business or
industry, or take future actions. Pursuant to the senior credit facility, the Company granted the parties thereto a security interest in substantially all of
its assets. See Note 12 of the notes to the Company's consolidated financial statements and the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Liquidity and Capital Resources Loan and Security Agreement” in Part II, Item 8 of the Company's
Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. The Company’s ability to meet these restrictive covenants can be impacted
by events beyond the Company’s control and the Company may be unable to do so. The Company’s senior credit facility provides that its breaches or
failure to satisfy certain covenants constitutes an event of default. Upon the occurrence of an event of default, the Company’s lenders could elect to
declare all amounts outstanding under its debt agreements to be immediately due and payable. In addition, the Company's lenders would have the right
to proceed against the assets the Company provided as collateral pursuant to the senior credit facility. If the debt under its senior credit facility was to be
accelerated, the Company may not have sufficient cash on hand or be able to sell sufficient collateral to repay it, which would have an immediate
adverse effect on the Company's business and operating results.
22
Table of Contents
The Company’s annual and quarterly operating results may fluctuate in the future, which may cause the Company’s trading price for the notes and
shares to decline.
The Company’s net sales, expenses and operating results may vary significantly from year to year and quarter to quarter for several reasons, including,
without limitation:
● the ability of the Company’s sales force to effectively market and promote the Company’s products, and the extent to which those products gain
market acceptance;
● the inability to meet the Company’s debt repayment obligations under its senior credit facility due to insufficient cash;
● the possibility that cybersecurity breaches, data breaches, and other disruptions could compromise the Company’s information or result in the
unauthorized disclosure of confidential information;
● the existence and timing of any product approvals or changes;
● the rate and size of expenditures incurred on the Company’s clinical, manufacturing, sales, marketing, and product development efforts;
● the Company’s ability to attract and retain personnel;
● the availability of key components, materials and contract services, which depends on the Company’s ability to forecast sales, among other things;
● investigations of the Company’s business and business-related activities by regulatory or other governmental authorities;
● variations in timing and quantity of product orders;
● temporary manufacturing interruptions or disruptions;
● the timing and success of new product and new market introductions, as well as delays in obtaining domestic or foreign regulatory approvals for such
introductions;
● increased competition, patent expirations or new technologies or treatments;
● product recalls or safety alerts;
● litigation, including product liability, patent, employment, securities class action, stockholder derivative, general commercial and other lawsuits;
● volatility in the global market and worldwide economic conditions;
● changes in tax laws, including changes domestically and internationally, or exposure to additional income tax liabilities;
● the impact of the EU privacy regulations (GDPR) on the Company’s resources;
● the financial health of the Company’s customers and their ability to purchase the Company’s products in the current economic environment;
● other unusual or non-operating expenses, such as expenses related to mergers or acquisitions, may cause operating results to vary; and
● an epidemic or pandemic, such as the current COVID-19 pandemic.
As a result of any of these factors, the Company’s consolidated results of operations may fluctuate significantly, which may in turn cause the trading
price of the notes and the shares to fluctuate.
If defects are discovered in the Company’s products, the Company may incur additional unforeseen costs, customers may not purchase the
Company’s product and the Company’s reputation may suffer.
The Company’s success depends on the quality and reliability of its products. While the Company’s subject components are sources and products
manufactured to stringent quality specifications and processes, the Company’s products incorporate different components including optical components,
and other medical device software, any of which may contain errors or exhibit failures, especially when products are first introduced. In addition, new
products or enhancements may contain undetected errors or performance problems that, despite testing, are discovered only after commercial shipment.
Because the Company’s products are designed to be used to perform complex surgical procedures, due to the serious and costly consequences of product
failure, the Company and its customers have an increased sensitivity to such defects. In the past, the Company has voluntarily recalled certain products.
Although the Company’s products are subject to stringent quality processes and controls, the Company cannot provide assurance that its products will
not experience component aging, errors, or performance problems. If the Company experiences product flaws or performance problems, any or all of the
following could occur:
●delays in product shipments;
●loss of revenue;
●delay in market acceptance;
●diversion of the Company’s resources;
●damage to the Company’s reputation;
●product recalls;
●regulatory actions;
●increased service or warranty costs; or
●product liability claims.
Costs associated with product flaws or performance problems could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition,
results of operations or cash flows.
23
Table of Contents
The success and continuing development of the Company’s products depends, in part, upon maintaining strong relationships with physicians and
other healthcare professionals.
If the Company fails to maintain the Company’s working relationships with physicians and other ancillary healthcare and aesthetic professionals, the
Company’s products may not be developed and marketed in line with the needs and expectations of the professionals who use and support the
Company’s products. Physicians assist the Company as researchers, marketing consultants, product consultants, and public speakers, and the Company
relies on these professionals to provide the Company with considerable knowledge and experience. If the Company is unable to maintain these strong
relationships, the development and marketing of the Company’s products could suffer, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s
consolidated financial condition and results of operations.
The Company relies heavily on its sales professionals to market and sell its products worldwide. If the Company is unable to hire, effectively train,
manage, improve the productivity of, and retain the Company’s sales professionals, the Company’s business will be harmed, which would impair its
future revenue and profitability.
The Company’s success largely depends on the Company’s ability to hire, train, manage, train, and improve the productivity levels of the Company’s
sales professionals worldwide. Because of the Company’s focus on non-core practitioners in the past, several of its sales professionals do not have
established relationships with the core market, consisting of dermatologists and plastic surgeons, or where those relationships exist, they are not
appropriately strong.
Competition for sales professionals who are familiar with, and trained to sell in, the aesthetic equipment market continues to be robust. As a result, the
Company occasionally loses its sales people to competitors. The Company’s industry is characterized by a few established companies that compete
vigorously for talented sales professionals. Some of its sales professionals leave the Company for jobs that they perceive to be better opportunities, both
within and outside of the aesthetic industry. For instance, in the first quarter of 2020, the Company experienced significant turnover of the Company’s
sales professionals, including several people in key sales leadership positions. Most of these sales professionals went to work for a competitor. The
Company believes the loss of these sales professionals may negatively impacted the Company’s sales performance in the first half of 2020. The Company
believes it has adequate measures in place to protect the Company’s proprietary and confidential information when employees leave the Company,
however the ability to enforce these measures varies from jurisdiction to jurisdiction and the Company must make a case-by-case decision regarding legal
enforcement action. For instance, covenants not-to-compete are not allowed in many states, and if allowed, difficult to enforce in many jurisdictions.
Furthermore, such legal enforcement actions are expensive and the Company cannot give any assurance that these enforcement actions will be successful.
However, the Company also continues to hire and train new sales people, including several from the Company’s competitors. Several of the Company’s
sales employees and sales management are recently hired or transferred into different roles, and it will take time for them to be fully trained to improve
their productivity. In addition, due to the competition for sales professionals in the Company’s industry, the Company also recruits sales professionals
from outside the industry. Sales professionals from outside the industry typically take longer to train and become familiar with the Company’s products
and the procedures in which they are used. As a result of a lack of industry knowledge, these sales professionals may take longer to become productive
members of the Company’s sales force.
The Company trains its existing and recently recruited sales professionals to better understand the Company’s existing and new product technologies
and how they can be positioned against the Company’s competitors’ products. These initiatives are intended to improve the productivity of the
Company’s sales professionals and the Company’s revenue and profitability. It takes time for the sales professionals to become productive following
their training and there can be no assurance that the newly recruited sales professionals will be adequately trained in a timely manner, or that the
Company direct sales productivity will improve, or that the Company will not experience significant levels of attrition in the future.
Measures the Company implements in an effort to recruit, retain, train and manage the Company’s sales professionals, strengthen their relationships with
core market physicians, and improve their productivity may not be successful and may instead contribute to instability in its operations, additional
departures from the Company’s sales organization, or further reduce the Company’s revenue and harm the Company’s business. If the Company is not
able to improve the productivity and retention of the Company’s North American and international sales professionals, then the Company’s total
revenue, profitability and stock price may be adversely impacted.
The aesthetic equipment market is characterized by rapid innovation. To compete effectively, the Company must develop and/or acquire new
products, seek regulatory clearance, market them successfully, and identify new markets for the Company’s technology.
The aesthetic light and energy-based treatment system industry is subject to continuous technological development and product innovation. If the
Company does not continue to innovate and develop new products and applications, the Company’s competitive position will likely deteriorate as other
companies successfully design and commercialize new products and applications or enhancements to the Company’s current products. The Company
created products to apply the Company’s technology to body contouring, hair removal, treatment of veins, tattoo removal and skin revitalization,
including the treatment of diffuse redness, fine lines and wrinkles via hemostasis and coagulation, skin texture, pore size and benign pigmented lesions,
etc. For example, the Company introduced Juliet, a product for women’s health, in December 2017, Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for
skin revitalization, in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018, truSculpt iD in July 2018, excel V+ in February 2019, truSculpt flex in June 2019, and
the Secret Pro, a device combining the benefits of RF microneedling with the capabilities of a fractional, ablative CO2 laser in September of 2020. To
grow in the future, the Company must continue to develop and/or acquire new and innovative aesthetic products and applications, identify new markets,
and successfully launch the newly acquired or developed product offerings.
24
Table of Contents
To successfully expand the Company’s product offerings, the Company must, among other things:
●develop or otherwise acquire new products that either add to or significantly improve the Company’s current product offerings;
●obtain regulatory clearance for these new products;
●convince the Company’s existing and prospective customers that the Company’s product offerings are an attractive revenue-generating addition to their
practice;
●sell the Company’s product offerings to a broad customer base;
●identify new markets and alternative applications for the Company’s technology;
●protect the Company’s existing and future products with defensible intellectual property; and
●satisfy and maintain all regulatory requirements for commercialization.
Historically, product introductions have been a significant component of the Company’s financial performance. To be successful in the aesthetics
industry, the Company believes it needs to continue to innovate. The Company’s business strategy is based, in part, on its expectation that the Company
will continue to increase or enhance its product offerings. The Company needs to continue to devote substantial research and development resources to
make new product introductions, which can be costly and time consuming to its organization.
The Company also believes that, to increase revenue from sales of new products, the Company needs to continue to develop its clinical support, further
expand and nurture relationships with industry thought leaders, and increase market awareness of the benefits of its new products. However, even with a
significant investment in research and development, the Company may be unable to continue to develop, acquire or effectively launch and market new
products and technologies regularly, or at all. If the Company fails to successfully commercialize new products or enhancements, its business may be
harmed.
While the Company attempts to protect its products through patents and other intellectual property, there are few barriers to entry that would prevent
new entrants or existing competitors from developing products that compete directly with the Company’s. The Company expects that any competitive
advantage the Company may enjoy from current and future innovations may diminish over time as companies successfully respond to the Company’s, or
create their own, innovations. Consequently, the Company believes that it will have to continuously innovate and improve the Company’s products and
technology to compete successfully. If the Company is unable to innovate successfully, its products could become obsolete and its revenue could decline
as its customers and prospective customers purchase its competitors’ products.
Demand for the Company’s products in any of the Company’s markets could be weakened by several factors, including:
●inability to develop and market the Company’s products to the core market specialties of dermatologists and plastic surgeons;
●poor financial performance of market segments that attempt to introduce aesthetic procedures to their businesses;
●the inability to differentiate the Company’s products from those of the Company’s competitors;
●competitive threat from new innovations, product introductions capturing mind and wallet share;
●reduced patient demand for elective aesthetic procedures;
●failure to build and maintain relationships with opinion leaders within the various market segments; and
●the lack of credit financing, or an increase in the cost of borrowing, for some of the Company’s potential customers.
If the Company does not achieve anticipated demand for the Company’s products, there could be a material adverse effect on its total revenue,
profitability, employee retention and stock price.
25
Table of Contents
Exposure to United Kingdom political developments, including the effect of its withdrawal from the European Union, could be costly and difficult to
comply with and could seriously harm the Company’s business.
In June 2016, a referendum was passed in the United Kingdom to leave the European Union, commonly referred to as “Brexit.” This decision created an
uncertain political and economic environment in the United Kingdom and other European Union countries. The United Kingdom formally left the
European Union on January 31, 2020. The long-term nature of the United Kingdom’s relationship with the European Union is unclear and there is
considerable uncertainty as to when any agreement will be reached and implemented. The political and economic instability created by Brexit has
caused and may continue to cause significant volatility in global financial markets and uncertainty regarding the regulation of data protection in the
United Kingdom. In particular, although the United Kingdom enacted a Data Protection Act in May 2018 that is consistent with the EU General Data
Protection Regulation, uncertainty remains regarding how data transfers to and from the United Kingdom will be regulated. The full effect of Brexit is
uncertain and it is not possible to determine the extent of the impact of the Brexit. Consequently, no assurance can be given about the impact of the
outcome and the Company’s business, including operational and tax policies, may be seriously harmed or require reassessment.
The Company depends on skilled and experienced personnel to operate its global business effectively. Changes to management or the inability to
recruit, hire, train and retain qualified personnel, could harm the Company’s ability to successfully manage, develop and expand its business, which
would impair the Company’s future revenue and profitability.
The Company’s success largely depends on the skills, experience and efforts of the Company’s officers and other key employees. The loss of any of the
Company’s executive officers could weaken its management expertise and harm the Company’s business, and it may not be able to find adequate
replacements on a timely basis, or at all. Except for Change of Control and Severance Agreements for the Company’s executive officers and a few key
employees, the Company does not have employment contracts with any of its officers or other key employees. Any of the Company’s officers and other
key employees may terminate their employment at any time and their knowledge of the Company’s business and industry may be difficult to replace.
The Company does not have a succession plan in place for each of its officers and key employees. In addition, the Company does not maintain “key
person” life insurance policies covering any of the Company’s employees.
In addition to dependence on the Company’s officers and key employees, the Company is highly dependent on other sales and scientific personnel. For
example, in the first quarter of 2020 the Company experienced a few turnover of its sales professionals, including several people in key sales leadership
positions. Most of these sales professionals went to work for a competitor. Additionally, the Company’s product development plans depend, in part, on
the Company’s ability to attract and retain engineers with experience in medical devices. Attracting and retaining qualified personnel will be critical to
the Company’s success, and competition for qualified personnel is intense. The Company may not be able to attract and retain personnel on acceptable
terms given the competition for such personnel among technology and healthcare companies and universities. The loss of any of these persons or the
Company’s inability to attract, train and retain qualified personnel could harm the Company’s business and the Company’s ability to compete and
become profitable.
Security breaches, cyber-security incidents and other disruptions could compromise the Company’s information and impact the Company’s
business, financial condition or results of operations.
The Company relies on networks, information management software and other technology, or information systems, including the Internet and third-
party hosted services, to support a variety of business processes and activities, including procurement and supply chain, manufacturing, distribution,
invoicing, order processing and collection of payments. The Company uses information systems to process financial information and results of
operations for internal reporting purposes and to comply with regulatory financial reporting, legal and tax requirements. In addition, the Company
depends on information systems for digital marketing activities and electronic communications among the Company’s locations around the world and
between company personnel as well as customers and suppliers. Because information systems are critical to many of the Company’s operating activities,
the Company’s business processes may be impacted by system shutdowns or service disruptions. These disruptions may be caused by failures during
routine operations such as system upgrades or user errors, as well as network or hardware failures, malicious or disruptive software, computer hackers,
geopolitical events, natural disasters, failures or impairments of telecommunications networks, or other catastrophic events. These events could result in
unauthorized disclosure of material confidential information. If the Company’s information systems suffer severe damage, disruption or shutdown and
the Company business continuity plans do not effectively resolve the issues in a timely manner, the Company could experience delays in reporting the
Company’s financial results and the Company may lose revenue and profits as a result of the Company’s inability to timely manufacture, distribute,
invoice and collect payments. Misuse, leakage or falsification of information could result in a violation of data privacy laws and regulations and damage
the Company’s reputation and credibility, and could expose the Company to liability. The Company may also be required to spend significant financial
and other resources to remedy the damage caused by a security breach or to repair or replace networks and information systems. Like most major
corporations, the Company’s information systems are a target of attacks.
A cyber security attack or other incident that bypasses the Company’s information systems security could cause a security breach which may lead to a
material disruption to the Company’s information systems infrastructure or business and may involve a significant loss of business or patient health
information. If a cyber security attack or other unauthorized attempt to access the Company’s systems or facilities were successful, it could result in the
theft, destructions, loss, misappropriation or release of confidential information or intellectual property, and could cause operational or business delays
that may materially impact the Company’s ability to provide various healthcare services. Any successful cyber security attack or other unauthorized
attempt to access the Company’s systems or facilities also could result in negative publicity which could damage the Company’s reputation or brand with
the Company’s patients, referral sources, payors or other third parties and could subject the Company to a number of adverse consequences, the vast
majority of which are not insurable, including but not limited to disruptions in the Company’s operations, regulatory and other civil and criminal
penalties, fines, investigations and enforcement actions (including, but not limited to, those arising from the SEC, Federal Trade Commission, Office of
Civil Rights, the OIG or state attorneys general), fines, private litigation with those affected by the data breach, loss of customers, disputes with payors
and increased operating expense, which either individually or in the aggregate could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial
position, results of operations and liquidity.
The Company has not had any disruptions to its information systems that have materially affected its business, financial condition or results of
operations. However, there can be no assurance that such disruptions may occur and have a material adverse effect on the Company in the future.
26
Table of Contents
Changes in accounting standards and estimates could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and financial position.
Generally accepted accounting principles and the related authoritative guidance for many aspects of the Company’s business, including revenue
recognition, inventories, warranties, leases, income taxes, expected credit losses, fair-value measurements, and stock-based compensation, are complex
and involve subjective judgments. Changes in these rules or changes in the underlying estimates, assumptions or judgments by the Company’s
management could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and may retroactively affect previously reported results. For
example, recently issued authoritative guidance for credit losses may result in a significant impact to allowance for doubtful accounts.
The Company’s ability to access credit on favorable terms, if necessary, for the funding of the Company’s operations and capital projects may be
limited due to changes in credit markets.
On July 9, 2020, the Company terminated its Wells Fargo Revolving Line of Credit and subsequently entered into a Loan and Security Agreement with
Silicon Valley Bank (the “SVB Revolving Line of Credit”). The agreement provides for a four-year secured revolving loan facility in an aggregate
principal amount of up to $30.0 million. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit matures on July 9, 2024. As of December 31, 2020, the Company had not
drawn on this credit facility.
A violation of any of the covenants could result in a default under the SVB Revolving Line of Credit that would permit Silicon Valley Bank to restrict
the Company’s ability to further access the revolving line of credit for loans and letters of credit and require the immediate repayment of any outstanding
loans under the agreement. In addition, these covenants are subject to renegotiation at the beginning of each fiscal year, which further reduces the
Company’s ability to anticipate whether this source of capital will continue to be available in the near term.
Additionally, in the past, the credit markets and the financial services industry have experienced disruption characterized by the bankruptcy, failure,
collapse or sale of various financial institutions, increased volatility in securities prices, diminished liquidity and credit availability and intervention
from the U.S. and other governments. Continued concerns about the systemic impact of potential long-term or widespread downturn, energy costs,
geopolitical issues, the availability and cost of credit, the global commercial and residential real estate markets and related mortgage markets and
reduced consumer confidence have contributed to increased market volatility. The cost and availability of credit has been and may continue to be
adversely affected by these conditions. The Company cannot be certain that funding for the Company’s capital needs will be available from the
Company’s existing financial institutions and the credit markets if needed, and if available, to the extent required and on acceptable terms. The SVB
Revolving Line of Credit terminates on July 9, 2024 and if the Company cannot renew or refinance this facility or obtain funding when needed, in each
case on acceptable terms, such conditions may have an adverse effect on the Company’s revenues and results of operations.
The Company’s ability to report timely and accurate information could be negatively impacted by its plan to implement a new accounting and
enterprise resource planning (“ERP”) system.
The Company is in the process of implementing a new accounting and ERP system. The Company has not previously had a comprehensive ERP system
and to date has relied on a myriad of non-integrated systems, as well as manual processes. A system implementation of this magnitude entails a
significant degree of inherent risk. The key elements of this implementation include the conversion of data from existing systems to the new system and
the design of the new system to process and report financial and other transactions in an accurate and complete manner. If these, or other aspects of the
implementation are not executed successfully, then its ability to report timely and accurate information could be negatively impacted. Failure to report
required information in a timely and accurate fashion could result in financial penalties, fines and other administrative actions. Such events could have a
material adverse effect on the Company’s total enterprise value and stock price. Additionally, the process of implementing a new ERP system is capital
intensive and includes the inherent risk of incurring significant additional costs should the time and resources requirements of the implementation be
greater than what the Company currently anticipates.
27
Table of Contents
Macroeconomic political and market conditions, and catastrophic events may adversely affect the Company’s business, results of operations,
financial condition and the trading price of the notes and the stock.
The Company’s business is influenced by a range of factors that are beyond the Company’s control, including:
●general macro-economic and business conditions in the Company’s key markets of North America, Japan, Asia Pacific, the Middle East, Europe and
Australia;
●the lack of credit financing, or an increase in the cost of borrowing, for some of the Company’s potential customers due to increasing interest rates and
lending requirements;
●the overall demand for the Company’s products by the core market specialties of dermatologists and plastic surgeons;
●the timing and success of new product introductions by the Company or the Company’s competitors or any other change in the competitive landscape of
the market for non-surgical aesthetic procedures, including consolidation among the Company’s competitors;
●the level of awareness of aesthetic procedures and the market adoption of the Company’s products;
●changes in the Company’s pricing policies or those of the Company’s competitors;
●governmental budgetary constraints or shifts in government spending priorities;
●general political developments, both domestic and in the Company’s foreign markets, including economic and political uncertainty caused by elections;
●natural disasters;
●tax law changes;
●currency exchange rate fluctuations; and
●any trade restrictions or higher import taxes that may be imposed by foreign countries against products sold internationally by U.S. companies.
Macroeconomic developments, like global recessions and financial crises could negatively affect the Company’s business, operating results, or financial
condition which, in turn, could adversely affect the Company’s stock price. A general weakening of, and related declining corporate confidence in, the
global economy or the curtailment in government or corporate spending could cause current or potential customers to reduce their budgets or be unable
to fund product or upgrade application purchases, which could cause customers to delay, decrease or cancel purchases of the Company’s products and
services or cause customers not to pay the Company or to delay paying the Company for previously purchased products and services.
In addition, political unrest in regions like the Middle East, terrorist attacks around the globe and the potential for other hostilities in various parts of the
world, potential public health crises and natural disasters continue to contribute to a climate of economic and political uncertainty that could adversely
affect the Company’s results of operations and financial condition, including the Company’s revenue growth and profitability.
Macroeconomic declines, negative political developments, adverse market conditions and catastrophic events may cause a decline in the Company’s
revenue, negatively affect the Company’s operating results, adversely affect the Company’s cash flow and could result in a decline in the Company’s
stock price.
To successfully market and sell the Company’s products internationally, the Company must address many issues that are unique to the Company’s
international business. Furthermore, international expansion is a key component of the Company’s growth strategy, although the Company’s
international operations and foreign transactions expose the Company to additional operational challenges that the Company might not otherwise
face.
The Company is focused on international expansion as a key component of its growth strategy and has identified specific areas of opportunity in various
international markets. International revenue is a material component of the Company’s business strategy and represented 48% of its total revenue in
2020 compared to 42% of the Company’s total revenue in 2019. The Company employs a direct sales force in the major markets throughout Europe as
well as Canada, Japan and Australia/New Zealand while using third-party distributors to sell its products in several other country in the Middle East,
Asia, and South America in particular. The Company may be unable to increase or maintain its level of international revenue due to supply chain
disruptions or loss of distributor relationship.
The Company experienced significant turnover of the Company’s North America sales team during the first quarter of 2020. Though these departures
did not have an adverse effect on the Company’s international sales, they added additional pressure on the global sales team. While the Company
continues to have a direct sales and service organization in Australia, New Zealand, Japan, France, Belgium, Spain, Germany, Switzerland and the
United Kingdom, a significant portion of its international revenue is generated through its network of distributors. Though the Company continues to
evaluate and replace non-performing distributors and has recently brought greater focus to collaboration with its distribution partners, there can be no
assurance given that these initiatives will result in improved international revenue or profitability in the future.
To grow the Company’s business, it is essential to improve productivity in current sales territories and expand into new territories. However, direct sales
productivity may not improve and distributors may not accept the Company’s business or commit the necessary resources to market and sell the
Company’s products at the Company’s expectations. If the Company is not able to increase or maintain international revenue growth, the Company’s total
revenue, profitability and stock price may be adversely impacted.
If the Company fails to renew any of its distribution agreements as they expire under the terms of the particular agreement, its revenues and cash
flow may be adversely affected.
The Company's business may suffer if any of its distribution partners terminates or otherwise fails to renew its distribution agreement with the
Company and the Company is otherwise unable to replace such agreement with a distribution agreement containing similar terms. For example, the
Company's distribution agreement with ZO to distribute certain of their proprietary skincare products in Japan expires in June 2021. If ZO fails to renew
the distribution agreement or it terminates the distribution agreement early for any reason, the Company's revenues and cash flow may be adversely
affected.
28
Table of Contents
Economic and other risks associated with international sales and operations could adversely affect the Company’s business.
In 2019, 42% of the Company’s total revenue was from customers outside of North America. The Company expects its sales from international
operations and export sales to continue to be a significant portion of the Company’s revenue. The Company has placed a particular emphasis on
increasing its growth and presence in international markets. The Company’s international operations and sales are subject, in varying degrees, to risks
inherent in doing business outside the U.S. These risks include:
●changes in trade protection measures, including embargoes, tariffs and other trade barriers, and import and export regulations and licensing
requirements;
●instability and uncertainties arising from the global geopolitical environment, such as economic nationalism, populism, protectionism and anti-global
sentiment;
●changes in tax laws and potential negative consequences from the interpretation, application and enforcement by governmental tax authorities of tax
laws and policies;
●unanticipated changes in other laws and regulations or in how such provisions are interpreted or administered;
●reduced protection for intellectual property rights in some countries and practical difficulties of enforcing intellectual property and contract rights
abroad;
●possibility of unfavorable circumstances arising from host country laws or regulations, including those related to infrastructure and data transmission,
security and privacy;
●currency exchange rate fluctuations and restrictions on currency repatriation;
●difficulties and expenses related to implementing internal control over financial reporting and disclosure controls and procedures;
●disruption of sales from labor and political disturbances;
●regional safety and security considerations;
●increased costs and risks in developing, staffing and simultaneously managing global sales operations as a result of distance as well as language and
cultural differences;
●increased management, travel, infrastructure and legal compliance costs associated with having multiple international operations;
●lengthy payment cycles and difficulty in collecting accounts receivable;
●preference for locally-produced products, as well as protectionist laws and business practices that favor local companies;
●outbreak or escalation of insurrection, armed conflict, terrorism or war; and
●supply chain disruption or the loss of distributor relationships.
Changes in the geopolitical or economic environments in the countries in which the Company operates could have a material adverse effect on the
Company’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows. For example, changes in U.S. policy regarding international trade, including import
and export regulation and international trade agreements, could also negatively impact the Company’s business. In 2018, the U.S. imposed tariffs on
certain goods imported from China and certain other countries, which has resulted in retaliatory tariffs by China and other countries. Additional tariffs
imposed by the U.S. on a broader range of imports, or further retaliatory trade measures taken by China or other countries in response, could adversely
impact the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
The Company’s global operations are required to comply with the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended (“FCPA”), Chinese anti-
corruption laws, U.K. Bribery Law, and similar anti-bribery laws in other jurisdictions, and with U.S. and foreign export control, trade embargo and
customs laws. If the Company fails to comply with any of these laws, the Company could suffer civil and criminal sanctions.
Additionally, the Company continues to monitor Brexit and its potential impacts on the Company’s results of operations and financial condition.
Following the end of the “Brexit” Transition Period, from 1 January 2021 onwards, the Medicines and Healthcare Products Regulatory Agency
(“MHRA”) will be responsible for the UK medical device market. The new regulations will require medical devices to be registered with the MHRA
(but manufacturers will be given a grace period of four to 12 months to comply with the new registration process). Manufacturers based outside the UK
will need to appoint a UK Responsible Person to register devices with the MHRA in line with the grace periods. By July 1, 2023, in the UK (England,
Scotland, and Wales), all medical devices will require a UKCA (UK Conformity Assessed) mark but CE marks issued by EU notified bodies will remain
valid until this time. However, UKCA marking alone will not be recognized in the EU. The rules for placing medical devices on the Northern Ireland
market will differ from those in the UK.
In addition to the general risks that the Company faces outside the U.S., the Company’s operations in emerging markets could involve additional
uncertainties for us, including risks that governments may impose withholding or other taxes on remittances and other payments to us, or the amount of
any such taxes may increase; governments may seek to nationalize the Company’s assets; or governments may impose or increase investment barriers or
other restrictions affecting the Company’s business. In addition, emerging markets pose other uncertainties, including the difficulty of enforcing
agreements, challenges collecting receivables, protection of the Company’s intellectual property and other assets, pressure on the pricing of the
Company’s products and services, higher business conduct risks, ability to hire and retain qualified talent and risks of political instability. The Company
cannot predict the impact such events might have on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.
In addition, compliance with laws and regulations applicable to the Company’s international operations increases the Company’s cost of doing business
in foreign jurisdictions. The Company may be unable to keep current with changes in foreign government requirements and laws as they change from
time to time. Failure to comply with these regulations could have adverse effects on the Company’s business. In many foreign countries it is common for
others to engage in business practices that are prohibited by the Company’s internal policies and procedures or U.S. regulations applicable to us. In
addition, although the Company has implemented policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance with these laws and policies, there can be no
assurance that all of the Company’s employees, contractors, distributors and agents will comply with these laws and policies. Violations of laws or key
control policies by the Company’s employees, contractors, distributors or agents could result in delays in revenue recognition, financial reporting
misstatements, fines, penalties, or the prohibition of the importation or exportation of the Company’s offerings and could have a material adverse effect
on the Company’s business operations and financial results.
29
Table of Contents
To successfully market and sell third party products internationally, the Company must address many issues that are unique to the related
distribution arrangements which could reduce the Company’s available cash reserves and negatively impact the Company’s profitability.
The Company has entered into distribution arrangements pursuant to which the Company utilizes its sales force and distributors to sell products
manufactured by other companies. In Japan, the Company has a non-exclusive right to distribute a Q-switched laser product manufactured by a third
party OEM. The Company also has an exclusive agreement with ZO to distribute certain of their proprietary skincare products in Japan. Each of these
agreements requires the Company to purchase annual minimum dollar amounts of their products. Additionally, the Company has entered into
distribution arrangements with other companies to promote and sell the Secret RF and Juliet products.
Each of these distribution agreements presents its own unique risks and challenges. For example, to sell skincare products the Company needs to invest
in creating a sales structure that is experienced in the sale of such products and not in capital equipment. The Company needs to commit resources to
train the Company’s sales force, obtain regulatory licenses, and develop new marketing materials to promote the sale of these products. In addition, the
minimum commitments and other costs of distributing products manufactured by these companies may exceed the incremental revenue that the
Company derives from the sale of their products, thereby negatively impacting the Company’s profitability and reducing the Company’s available cash
reserves.
If the Company does not make the minimum purchases required in the distribution contracts, or if the third party manufacturer revokes the Company’s
distribution rights, the Company could lose the distribution rights of the products, which would adversely affect the Company’s future revenue, results
of operations, cash flows and its stock price.
The Company offers credit terms to some qualified customers and also to leasing companies to finance the purchase of its products. In the event that
any of these customers default on the amounts payable to the Company, its earnings may be adversely affected.
The Company generally offers credit terms of 30 to 90 days to qualified customers. In addition, from time to time, it offers certain key international
distributors, with whom the Company has had an extended period of relationship and payment history, payment terms that are significantly longer than
the regular 30 to 90 day terms. This allows such international distribution partners to have its products in stock and provide its products to customers on
a timely basis.
While the Company believes it has an adequate basis to ensure that it collects its accounts receivable, the Company cannot provide any assurance that
the financial position of customers to whom it has provided payment terms will not change adversely before the Company receives payment. In the
event that there is a default by any of the customers to whom the Company has provided credit terms, the Company may recognize a credit loss
provision write-off charge in the Company’s general and administrative expenses. If this write-off charge is material, it could negatively affect the
Company’s future results of operations, cash flows and its stock price.
Additionally, in the event of deterioration of general business conditions or the availability of credit, the financial strength and stability of the
Company’s customers and potential customers may deteriorate over time, which may cause them to cancel or delay their purchase of its products. In
addition, the Company may be subject to increased risk of non-payment of its accounts receivables. The Company may also be adversely affected by
bankruptcies or other business failures of the Company’s customers and potential customers. A significant delay in the collection of funds or a reduction
of funds collected may impact the Company’s liquidity or result in credit losses.
The Company’s ability to effectively compete and generate additional revenue from new and existing products depends upon the Company’s ability
to distinguish the Company and its products from the competitors and their products, and to develop and effectively market new and existing
products. The Company’s success is dependent on many factors, including the following:
●speed of new and innovative product development;
●effective strategy and execution of new product launches;
●identification and development of clinical support for new indications of the Company’s existing products;
●product performance;
●product pricing;
●quality of customer support;
●development of successful distribution channels, both domestically and internationally; and
●intellectual property protection.
To compete effectively, the Company has to demonstrate that its new and existing products are attractive alternatives to other devices and treatments, by
differentiating the Company’s products on the basis of such factors as innovation, performance, brand name, service, and price. This is difficult to do,
especially in a crowded aesthetic market. Some of the Company’s competitors have newer or different products and more established customer
relationships than the Company does, which could inhibit the Company’s market penetration efforts. For example, the Company has encountered, and
expects to continue to encounter, situations where, due to pre-existing relationships, potential customers decide to purchase additional products from the
Company’s competitors. Potential customers also may need to recoup the cost of products that they have already purchased from the Company’s
competitors and may decide not to purchase the Company’s products, or to delay such purchases. If the Company is unable to increase the Company’s
market penetration or compete effectively, its revenue and profitability will be adversely impacted.
30
Table of Contents
The Company competes against companies that offer alternative solutions to its products, have greater resources, or have a larger installed base of
customers and broader product offerings than the Company’s. In addition, increased consolidation in the Company’s industry may lead to increased
competition. If the Company is not able to effectively compete with these companies, it may harm its business.
The medical technology and aesthetic product markets are highly competitive and dynamic and are characterized by rapid and substantial technology
development and product innovations. The Company’s products compete against conventional non-energy-based treatments, such as electrolysis, Botox
and collagen injections, chemical peels, microdermabrasion and sclerotherapy. The Company’s products also compete against laser and other energy-
based products offered by public companies. Further, other companies could introduce new products that are in direct competition with the Company’s
products. The Company may also face competition from manufacturers of pharmaceutical and other products that have not yet been developed.
Competition with these companies could result in reduced selling prices, reduced profit margins and loss of market share, any of which would harm the
Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.
There has been consolidation in the aesthetic industry leading to companies combining their resources, which increases competition and could result in
increased downward pressure on the Company’s product prices. Consolidations have created newly-combined entities with greater financial resources,
deeper sales channels and greater pricing flexibility than the Company. Rumored or actual consolidation of the Company’s partners and competitors
could cause uncertainty and disruption to the Company’s business and can cause the Company’s stock price to fluctuate.
If there is not sufficient consumer demand for the procedures performed with the Company’s products, practitioner demand for its products could be
inhibited, resulting in unfavorable operating results and reduced growth potential.
Continued expansion of the global market for laser and other-energy-based aesthetic procedures is a material assumption of the Company’s business
strategy. Most procedures performed using the Company’s products are elective procedures not reimbursable through government or private health
insurance, with the costs borne by the patient. The decision to utilize the Company’s products may therefore be influenced by a number of factors,
including:
●consumer disposable income and access to consumer credit, which as a result of an unstable economy, maybe significantly impacted;
●the cost, safety and effectiveness of alternative treatments, including treatments which are not based upon laser or other energy-based technologies and
treatments which use pharmaceutical products;
●the success of the Company’s sales and marketing efforts; and
●the education of the Company’s customers and patients on the benefits and uses of the Company’s products, compared to competitors’ products and
technologies.
If, as a result of these factors, there is not sufficient demand for the procedures performed with the Company’s products, practitioner demand for the
Company’s products could be reduced, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition, revenue and result of
operations.
The Company's products and its operations are subject to extensive government regulation and oversight in the United States. If the Company fails
to obtain or maintain necessary regulatory clearances or approvals for its products, or if approvals or clearances for future products are delayed or
not issued, it will negatively affect its business, financial condition and results of operations.
The Company's laser products are medical devices subject to extensive regulation in the United States and elsewhere, including by the FDA and its
foreign counterparts. Government regulations specific to medical devices are wide ranging and govern, among other things:
●product design, development, manufacture, and release;
●laboratory and clinical testing, labeling, packaging, storage and distribution;
●product safety and efficacy;
●premarketing clearance or approval;
●service operations;
●record keeping;
●product marketing, promotion and advertising, sales and distribution;
●post-marketing surveillance, including reporting of deaths or serious injuries and recalls and correction and removals;
●post-market approval studies; and
●product import and export.
The FDA classifies medical devices into one of three classes on the basis of the intended use of the device, the risk associated with the use of the device
for that indication, as determined by the FDA, and on the controls deemed by the FDA to be necessary to reasonably ensure their safety and
effectiveness.
Class I includes devices with the lowest risk to the patient and are those for which safety and effectiveness can be assured by adherence to the FDA’s
General Controls for medical devices, which include compliance with the applicable portions of the QSR facility registration and product listing,
reporting of adverse medical events, and truthful and non-misleading labeling, advertising, and promotional materials. Class II devices are subject to the
FDA’s General Controls, and special controls as deemed necessary by the FDA to ensure the safety and effectiveness of the device. These special
controls can include performance standards, post-market surveillance, patient registries and FDA guidance documents.
31
Table of Contents
While most Class I devices are exempt from the premarket notification requirement, manufacturers of most Class II devices are required to submit to the
FDA a premarket notification under Section 510(k) of the FDCA requesting permission to commercially distribute the device. The FDA’s permission to
commercially distribute a device subject to a 510(k) premarket notification is generally known as 510(k) clearance. Devices deemed by the FDA to pose
the greatest risks, such as life sustaining, life supporting or some implantable devices, or devices that have a new intended use, or use advanced
technology that is not substantially equivalent to that of a legally marketed device, are placed in Class III, requiring approval of a PMA application.
Some pre-amendment devices are unclassified, but are subject to FDA’s premarket notification and clearance process in order to be commercially
distributed. The Company's currently marketed products are Class II devices subject to 510(k) clearance, which the Company has obtained from the
FDA.
Before a new medical device, or a new intended use of, claim for, or significant modification to an existing device, can be marketed in the United States,
a company must first submit an application for and receive either 510(k) clearance pursuant to a premarket notification submitted under Section 510(k)
of the FDCA, de-novo classification, or PMA approval from the FDA, unless an exemption applies. The 510(k), de-novo or PMA processes can be
expensive, lengthy and unpredictable. The FDA’s 510(k) clearance process usually takes from three to 12 months, but can last longer. The process of
obtaining a PMA approval is much more costly and uncertain than the 510(k) clearance process and generally takes from one to three years, or even
longer, from the time the application is filed with the FDA. In addition, a PMA approval generally requires the performance of one or more clinical
trials. Despite the time, effort and cost, a device may not be approved or cleared by the FDA. Any delay or failure to obtain necessary regulatory
clearances or approvals could harm its business. Furthermore, even if the Company is granted regulatory clearances or approvals, they may include
significant limitations on the indicated uses for the device, which may limit the market for the device.
The Company has obtained 510(k) clearances to market its products, such as the Juliet device. The FDA or other regulators could delay, limit, or deny
clearance or approval of a device for many reasons, including:
●The Company's inability to demonstrate to the satisfaction of the FDA or the applicable regulatory entity or notified body that the Company's currently
marketed devices, or any other future device, and any accessories are substantially equivalent to a legally marketed predicate device or safe or effective
for their proposed intended uses;
●the disagreement of the FDA with the design or implementation of any clinical trials or the interpretation of data from preclinical studies or clinical
trials;
●serious and unexpected adverse device effects experienced by participants in its clinical trials;
●the insufficiency of the data from preclinical studies or clinical trials to support clearance or approval, where required;
●our inability to demonstrate that the clinical and other benefits of the device outweigh the risks;
●the failure of its manufacturing process or facilities to meet applicable requirements; and
●the potential for approval policies or regulations of the FDA or applicable foreign regulatory bodies to change significantly in a manner rendering its
clinical data or regulatory filings insufficient for clearance or approval.
The regulations to which the Company is subject are complex and have tended to become more stringent over time. Regulatory changes could result in
restrictions on the Company's ability to carry on or expand its operations, higher than anticipated costs or lower than anticipated sales. The FDA
enforces these regulatory requirements through, among other means, periodic unannounced inspections. The Company does not know whether it will be
found compliant in connection with any future regulatory inspections. Moreover, the FDA and state authorities have broad enforcement powers.
Its failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements could result in enforcement action by any such agency. If any of these events were to
occur, it would negatively affect the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
If the Company fails to comply with applicable regulatory requirements, it could result in enforcement action by the U.S. FDA, federal and state
agencies or international regulatory bodies and the Company’s commercial operations would be harmed.
The Company’s products are medical devices that are subject to extensive regulation in the U.S. by the FDA for manufacturing, labeling, sale,
promotion, distribution and shipping. The FDA, state authorities and international regulatory bodies have broad enforcement powers. If the Company
fails to comply with any U.S. law or any of the applicable regulatory requirements of the FDA, or federal or state agencies, or one of the international
regulatory bodies, it could result in enforcement action by the agencies, which may include any of the following sanctions:
●warning letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;
●repair, replacement, recall or seizure of the Company’s products;
●operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;
●refusing the Company’s requests for 510(k) clearance of new products, new intended uses, or modifications to existing products;
●withdrawing 510(k) clearance or pre-market approvals that have already been granted; and
●criminal prosecution.
Federal regulatory reforms and changes occurring at the FDA could adversely affect the Company’s ability to sell its products profitably and
financial condition.
From time to time, legislation is drafted and introduced in Congress that could significantly change the statutory provisions governing the clearance or
approval, manufacture and marketing of a device. It is impossible to predict whether legislative changes will be enacted or FDA regulations, guidance or
interpretations changed, and what the impact of such changes, if any, may be.
32
Table of Contents
In addition, FDA regulations and guidance are often revised or reinterpreted by the agency in ways that may significantly affect the Company’s business
and the Company’s products. Changes in FDA regulations may lengthen the regulatory approval process for medical devices and require additional
clinical data to support regulatory clearance for the sale and marketing of the Company’s new products. In addition, it may require additional safety
monitoring, labeling changes, restrictions on product distribution or use, or other measures after the introduction of the Company’s products to market.
Either of these changes lengthen the duration to market, increase the Company’s costs of doing business, adversely affect the future permitted uses of
approved products, or otherwise adversely affect the market for its products.
For instance, on or about July 30, 2018, the FDA issued a public statement and sent letters to a number of companies in the medical aesthetics industry
expressing concerns regarding “vaginal revitalization” procedures using energy-based devices. The Company’s Juliet device is promoted and used by
physicians in procedures that are the subject of the FDA’s public warning. However, neither the Company nor its distribution partner were named in the
announcement, and neither the Company nor its distribution partner have received a letter from the agency as of the date of this filing. Working with the
Company’s distribution partner and the FDA, the Company is assessing the potential parameters of an additional study regarding the
Company’s Juliet device to address the concerns highlighted in the FDA’s statement. However, there can be no assurances that the Company will reach
an agreement with the Company’s distribution partner on the execution details of such a study, or that such a study will be successful in addressing the
FDA’s safety concerns with the Company’s Juliet device.
The Company supports any action that helps ensure patient safety going forward. The Company has a robust, multi-functional process that reviews its
promotional claims and materials to ensure they are truthful, not misleading, fair and balanced, and supported by sound scientific evidence.
Changes in funding or disruptions at the FDA and other government agencies caused by funding shortages or global health concerns could hinder
their ability to hire and retain key leadership and other personnel, or otherwise prevent new or modified products from being developed, approved or
commercialized in a timely manner or at all, or otherwise prevent those agencies from performing normal business functions on which the operation
of the Company's business may rely, which could negatively impact its business.
The ability of the FDA to review and approve new products can be affected by a variety of factors, including government budget and funding levels,
ability to hire and retain key personnel and accept the payment of user fees, and statutory, regulatory, and policy changes, and other events that may
otherwise affect the FDA’s ability to perform routine functions. Average review times at the agency have fluctuated in recent years as a result. In
addition, government funding of other government agencies on which the Company's operations may rely, including those that fund research and
development activities is subject to the political process, which is inherently fluid and unpredictable.
Disruptions at the FDA and other agencies may also slow the time necessary for new product applications to be reviewed and/or approved by necessary
government agencies, which would adversely affect its business. For example, in recent years, including for 35 days beginning on December 22, 2018,
the U.S. government shut down several times and certain regulatory agencies, including the FDA, had to furlough critical employees and stop critical
activities. Separately, in response to the COVID-19 pandemic, the FDA has indicated that it will consider alternative methods for inspections and could
exercise discretion on a case-by-case basis to approve products based on a desk review, if a prolonged government shutdown occurs, or if global health
concerns continue to prevent the FDA or other regulatory authorities from conducting their regular inspections, reviews, or other regulatory activities, it
could significantly impact the ability of the FDA to timely review and process its regulatory submissions, which could have a material adverse effect on
the Company's business.
If the Company fails to comply with the FDA’s Quality System Regulation and laser performance standards, the Company’s manufacturing
operations could be halted, and its business would suffer.
The Company is currently required to demonstrate and maintain compliance with the FDA’s Quality System Regulation (the “QSR”). The QSR is a
complex regulatory scheme that covers the methods and documentation of the design, testing, control, manufacturing, labeling, quality assurance,
packaging, storage and shipping of the Company’s products. Because the Company’s products involve the use of lasers, the Company’s products also are
covered by a performance standard for lasers set forth in FDA regulations. The laser performance standard imposes specific record-keeping, reporting,
product testing and product labeling requirements. These requirements include affixing warning labels to laser products, as well as incorporating certain
safety features in the design of laser products.
The FDA enforces the QSR and laser performance standards through periodic unannounced inspections. The Company has had multiple quality system
inspections by the FDA, as well as audits the Company’s Notified Body, and other foreign regulatory agencies, with the most recent inspection by the
FDA occurring under the Medical Device Single Audit Program in January 2021. There were no significant findings or observations as a result of this
audit. Failure to take satisfactory corrective action in response to an adverse QSR inspection or its failure to comply with applicable laser performance
standards could result in enforcement actions, including a public warning letter, a shutdown of the Company’s manufacturing operations, a recall of its
products, civil or criminal penalties, or other sanctions, such as those described in the preceding paragraph, which would cause its sales and business to
suffer.
The Company is a sponsor of Biomedical Research. As such, the BIMO audits the Company and the Company is also subject to FDA regulations relating
to the design and conduct of clinical trials. The Company is subject to unannounced BIMO audits, with the most recent inspection by FDA occurring
over 5 days in August 2016. There were no significant findings and only two observations as a result of this audit. The Company’s responses to these
observations were accepted by the FDA. Failure to take satisfactory corrective action in response to an adverse BIMO inspection or the Company’s
failure to comply with Good Clinical Practices could result in the Company no longer being able to sponsor Biomedical Research, the reversal of 510(k)
clearances previously granted based on the results of clinical trials conducted to gain clinical data to support those 510(k) clearances, or
enforcement actions, including a public warning letter, civil or criminal penalties, or other sanctions, such as those described in the preceding paragraph,
which would cause the Company’s sales and business to suffer.
If the Company modifies one of its FDA-cleared devices, it may need to seek a new clearance, which, if not granted, would prevent the Company
from selling its modified products or cause it to redesign its products.
Any modifications to an FDA-cleared device that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness or that would constitute a major change in its
intended use would require a new 510(k) clearance or possibly a pre-market approval. The Company may not be able to obtain additional 510(k)
clearance or premarket approvals for new products or for modifications to, or additional indications for, its existing products in a timely fashion, or at
all. Delays in obtaining future clearance would adversely affect its ability to introduce new or enhanced products in a timely manner, which in turn
would harm its revenue and future profitability.
33
Table of Contents
The Company has made modifications to its devices in the past and may make additional modifications in the future that it believes do not or will not
require additional clearance or approvals. If the FDA disagrees, and requires new clearances or approvals for the modifications, the Company may be
required to recall and to stop marketing the modified devices, which could harm the Company’s operating results and require it to redesign its products.
The Company may be unable to obtain or maintain international regulatory qualifications or approvals for its current or future products and
indications, which could harm its business.
Sales of the Company’s products outside the U.S. are subject to foreign regulatory requirements that vary widely from country to country. In addition,
exports of medical devices from the U.S. are regulated by the FDA. Complying with international regulatory requirements can be an expensive and
time- consuming process and approval is not certain. The time required for obtaining clearance or approvals, if required by other countries, may be
longer than that required for FDA clearance or approvals, and requirements for such clearances or approvals may significantly differ from FDA
requirements. The Company may be unable to obtain or maintain regulatory qualifications, clearances or approvals in other countries. The Company
may also incur significant costs in attempting to obtain and in maintaining foreign regulatory approvals or qualifications. If the Company experience
delays in receiving necessary qualifications, clearances or approvals to market its products outside the U.S., or if the Company fails to receive those
qualifications, clearances or approvals, the Company may be unable to market its products or enhancements in international markets effectively, or at all,
which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business and growth strategy.
Any defects in the design, material or workmanship of its products may not be discovered prior to shipment to customers, which could materially
increase its expenses, adversely impact profitability and harm its business.
The design of the Company’s products is complex. To manufacture them successfully, the Company must procure quality components and employ
individuals with a significant degree of technical expertise. If the Company’s designs are defective, or the material components used in its products are
subject to wearing out, or if suppliers fail to deliver components to specification, or if its employees fail to properly assemble, test and package its
products, the reliability and performance of its products could be adversely impacted.
If the Company’s products contain defects that cannot be repaired easily, inexpensively, or on a timely basis, the Company may experience:
●damage to the Company’s brand reputation;
●loss of customer orders and delay in order fulfillment;
●increased costs due to product repair or replacement;
●inability to attract new customers;
●diversion of resources from the Company’s manufacturing and research and development departments into the Company’s service department;
●changes in share-based compensation; and
●legal action.
The occurrence of any one or more of the foregoing could materially increase expenses, adversely impact profitability and harm the Company’s
business.
The Company's products may cause or contribute to adverse medical events or be subject to failures or malfunctions that the Company is required to
report to the FDA, and if the Company fails to do so, the Company would be subject to sanctions that could harm its reputation, business, financial
condition and results of operations. The discovery of serious safety issues with its products, or a recall of the Company's products either voluntarily
or at the direction of the FDA or another governmental authority, could have a negative impact on the Company.
The Company is subject to the FDA’s medical device reporting regulations and similar foreign regulations, which require the Company to report to the
FDA when the Company receives or becomes aware of information that reasonably suggests that one or more of its products may have caused or
contributed to a death or serious injury or malfunctioned in a way that, if the malfunction were to recur, it could cause or contribute to a death or serious
injury. The timing of its obligation to report is triggered by the date the Company becomes aware of the adverse event as well as the nature of the event.
The Company may fail to report adverse events of which it becomes aware within the prescribed timeframe. The Company may also fail to recognize
that it has become aware of a reportable adverse event, especially if it is not reported to the Company as an adverse event or if it is an adverse event that
is unexpected or removed in time from the use of the product. If the Company fails to comply with its reporting obligations, the FDA could take action,
including warning letters, untitled letters, administrative actions, criminal prosecution, imposition of civil monetary penalties, revocation of its device
clearance or approval, seizure of its products or delay in clearance or approval of future products.
The FDA and foreign regulatory bodies have the authority to require the recall of commercialized products in the event of material deficiencies or
defects in design or manufacture of a product or in the event that a product poses an unacceptable risk to health. The FDA’s authority to require a recall
must be based on a finding that there is reasonable probability that the device could cause serious injury or death. The Company may also choose to
voluntarily recall a product if any material deficiency is found. A government-mandated or voluntary recall by the Company could occur as a result of
an unacceptable risk to health, component failures, malfunctions, manufacturing defects, labeling or design deficiencies, packaging defects or other
deficiencies or failures to comply with applicable regulations. Product defects or other errors may occur in the future.
Depending on the corrective action the Company takes to redress a product’s deficiencies or defects, the FDA may require, or the Company may decide,
that it will need to obtain new clearances or approvals for the device before the Company may market or distribute the corrected device. Seeking such
clearances or approvals may delay its ability to replace the recalled devices in a timely manner. Moreover, if the Company does not adequately address
problems associated with its devices, the Company may face additional regulatory enforcement action, including FDA warning letters, product seizure,
injunctions, administrative penalties or civil or criminal fines.
34
Table of Contents
Companies are required to maintain certain records of recalls and corrections, even if they are not reportable to the FDA. The Company may initiate
voluntary withdrawals or corrections for its products in the future that the Company determines do not require notification of the FDA. If the FDA
disagrees with its determinations, it could require the Company to report those actions as recalls and the Company may be subject to enforcement action.
A future recall announcement could harm its reputation with customers, potentially lead to product liability claims against the Company and negatively
affect its sales. Any corrective action, whether voluntary or involuntary, as well as defending itself in a lawsuit, will require the dedication of its time
and capital, will distract management from operating its business and may harm its reputation and financial results.
Our products may in the future be subject to product recalls that could harm its reputation, business and financial results.
Medical devices can experience performance problems in the field that require review and possible corrective action. The occurrence of component
failures, manufacturing errors, software errors, design defects or labeling inadequacies affecting a medical device could lead to a government-mandated
or voluntary recall by the device manufacturer, in particular when such deficiencies may endanger health. The FDA requires that certain classifications
of recalls be reported to the FDA within 10 working days after the recall is initiated. Companies are required to maintain certain records of recalls, even
if they are not reportable to the FDA. The Company may initiate voluntary recalls involving its products in the future that the Company determines do
not require notification of the FDA. If the FDA disagrees with its determinations, they could require the Company to report those actions as recalls.
Product recalls may divert management attention and financial resources, expose the Company to product liability or other claims, harm its reputation
with customers and adversely impact its business, financial condition and results of operations.
Clinical trials may be necessary to support future product submissions to the FDA. The clinical trial process is lengthy and expensive with uncertain
outcomes, and often requires the enrollment of large numbers of patients, and suitable patients may be difficult to identify and recruit. Delays or
failures in the Company's clinical trials will prevent it from commercializing any modified or new products and will adversely affect its business,
operating results and prospects.
The Company has conducted clinical trials in the past and will likely conduct clinical trials in the future. Initiating and completing clinical trials
necessary to support any future product candidates, will be time-consuming and expensive and the outcome uncertain. Moreover, the results of early
clinical trials are not necessarily predictive of future results, and any product the Company advances into clinical trials may not have favorable results in
later clinical trials. The results of preclinical studies and clinical trials of its products conducted to date and ongoing or future studies and trials of its
current, planned or future products may not be predictive of the results of later clinical trials, and interim results of a clinical trial do not necessarily
predict final results. The Company's interpretation of data and results from its clinical trials do not ensure that the Company will achieve similar results
in future clinical trials. In addition, preclinical and clinical data are often susceptible to various interpretations and analyses, and many companies that
have believed their products performed satisfactorily in preclinical studies and earlier clinical trials have nonetheless failed to replicate results in later
clinical trials. Products in later stages of clinical trials may fail to show the desired safety and efficacy despite having progressed through nonclinical
studies and earlier clinical trials. Failure can occur at any stage of clinical testing. The Company's clinical studies may produce negative or inconclusive
results, and it may decide, or regulators may require us, to conduct additional clinical and non-clinical testing in addition to those the Company
has planned.
●the Company may be required to submit an IDE application to the FDA, which must become effective prior to commencing certain human clinical trials
of medical devices, and the FDA may reject the Company's IDE application and notify the Company that it may not begin clinical trials;
●regulators and other comparable foreign regulatory authorities may disagree as to the design or implementation of its clinical trials;
●regulators and/or an IRB, or other reviewing bodies may not authorize the Company or its investigators to commence a clinical trial, or to conduct or
continue a clinical trial at a prospective or specific trial site;
●the Company may not reach agreement on acceptable terms with prospective contract research organizations, or CROs, and clinical trial sites, the terms
of which can be subject to extensive negotiation and may vary significantly among different CROs and trial sites;
●clinical trials may produce negative or inconclusive results, and the Company may decide, or regulators may require the Company to conduct additional
clinical trials or abandon product development programs;
●the number of subjects or patients required for clinical trials may be larger than the Company anticipates, enrollment in these clinical trials may be
insufficient or slower than the Company anticipates, and the number of clinical trials being conducted at any given time may be high and result in fewer
available patients for any given clinical trial, or patients may drop out of these clinical trials at a higher rate than the Company anticipates;
●the Company's third-party contractors, including those manufacturing products or conducting clinical trials on the Company's behalf, may fail to comply
with regulatory requirements or meet their contractual obligations to the Company in a timely manner, or at all;
●the Company might have to suspend or terminate clinical trials for various reasons, including a finding that the subjects are being exposed to
unacceptable health risks;
●the Company may have to amend clinical trial protocols or conduct additional studies to reflect changes in regulatory requirements or guidance, which it
may be required to submit to an IRB and/or regulatory authorities for re-examination;
●regulators, IRBs, or other parties may require or recommend that the Company or its investigators suspend or terminate clinical research for various
reasons, including safety signals or noncompliance with regulatory requirements;
●the cost of clinical trials may be greater than the Company anticipates;
●clinical sites may not adhere to the clinical protocol or may drop out of a clinical trial;
●the Company may be unable to recruit a sufficient number of clinical trial sites;
●regulators, IRBs, or other reviewing bodies may fail to approve or subsequently find fault with its manufacturing processes or facilities of third-party
manufacturers with which the Company enters into agreement for clinical and commercial supplies, the supply of devices or other materials necessary to
conduct clinical trials may be insufficient, inadequate or not available at an acceptable cost, or the Company may experience interruptions in supply;
●approval policies or regulations of the FDA or applicable foreign regulatory agencies may change in a manner rendering the Company's clinical data
insufficient for approval;
●the Company's current or future products may have undesirable side effects or other unexpected characteristics; and
●impacts of regional or global public health crises including the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic could adversely affect any clinical trials the Company is
conducting or plan to conduct, including delays or difficulties in enrolling or onboarding patients, initiating clinical sites, or obtaining the requisite
regulatory approvals, interruption of key clinical trial activities, or supply chain disruptions that delay or make it more difficult or costly to obtain the
supplies and materials the Company needs for clinical trials.
35
Table of Contents
Any of these occurrences may significantly harm the Company's business, financial condition and prospects. In addition, many of the factors that cause,
or lead to, a delay in the commencement or completion of clinical trials may also ultimately lead to the denial of regulatory approval of its product
candidates.
Clinical trials must be conducted in accordance with the laws and regulations of the FDA and other applicable regulatory authorities’ legal requirements,
regulations or guidelines, and are subject to oversight by these governmental agencies and IRBs at the medical institutions where the clinical trials are
conducted. Conducting successful clinical studies will require the enrollment of large numbers of patients, and suitable patients may be difficult to
identify and recruit. Patient enrollment in clinical trials and completion of patient participation and follow-up depends on many factors, including the
size of the patient population, the nature of the trial protocol, the attractiveness of, or the discomforts and risks associated with, the treatments received
by enrolled subjects, the availability of appropriate clinical trial investigators, support staff, and proximity of patients to clinical sites and able to comply
with the eligibility and exclusion criteria for participation in the clinical trial and patient compliance. For example, patients may be discouraged from
enrolling in its clinical trials if the trial protocol requires them to undergo extensive post-treatment procedures or follow-up to assess the safety and
effectiveness of its products or if they determine that the treatments received under the trial protocols are not attractive or involve unacceptable risks or
discomforts.
The Company depends on its collaborators and on medical institutions and CROs to conduct its clinical trials in compliance with good clinical practice
("GCP") requirements. To the extent its collaborators or the CROs fail to enroll participants for its clinical trials, fail to conduct the study to GCP
standards or are delayed for a significant time in the execution of trials, including achieving full enrollment, the Company may be affected by increased
costs, program delays or both. In addition, clinical trials that are conducted in countries outside the United States may subject the Company to further
delays and expenses as a result of increased shipment costs, additional regulatory requirements and the engagement of non-U.S. CROs, as well as expose
the Company to risks associated with clinical investigators who are unknown to the FDA, and different standards of diagnosis, screening and medical
care.
Development of sufficient and appropriate clinical protocols to demonstrate safety and efficacy are required and the Company may not adequately
develop such protocols to support clearance and approval. Further, the FDA may require the Company to submit data on a greater number of patients
than the Company originally anticipated and/or for a longer follow-up period or change the data collection requirements or data analysis applicable to
the Company's clinical trials. Delays in patient enrollment or failure of patients to continue to participate in a clinical trial may cause an increase in costs
and delays in the approval and attempted commercialization of its products or result in the failure of the clinical trial. In addition, despite considerable
time and expense invested in its clinical trials, the FDA may not consider the Company's data adequate to demonstrate safety and efficacy. Such
increased costs and delays or failures could adversely affect its business, operating results and prospects.
The results of the Company's clinical trials may not support its product candidate claims or may result in the discovery of adverse side effects.
The Company cannot be certain that the results of its future clinical trials will support its future product claims or that the FDA will agree with
its conclusions regarding them. Success in pre-clinical studies and early clinical trials does not ensure that later clinical trials will be successful, and the
Company cannot be sure that the later trials will replicate the results of prior trials and pre-clinical studies. The clinical trial process may fail to
demonstrate that its product candidates are safe and effective for the proposed indicated uses, which could cause the Company to abandon a product
candidate and may delay development of others. Any delay or termination of the Company's clinical trials will delay the filing of its product submissions
and, ultimately, its ability to commercialize its product candidates and generate revenues. It is also possible that patients enrolled in clinical trials will
experience adverse side effects that are not currently part of the future product’s profile.
Product liability suits could be brought against the Company due to a defective design, material or workmanship or misuse of its products and could
result in expensive and time-consuming litigation, payment of substantial damages and an increase in its insurance rates.
If the Company’s products are defectively designed, manufactured or labeled, contain defective components or are misused, the Company may become
subject to substantial and costly litigation by the Company’s customers or their patients. Misusing the Company’s products or failing to adhere to
operating guidelines could cause significant eye and skin damage, and underlying tissue damage. In addition, if its operating guidelines are found to be
inadequate, the Company may be subject to liability. The Company has been involved, and may in the future be involved, in litigation related to the use
of its products. Product liability claims could divert management’s attention from its core business, be expensive to defend and result in sizable damage
awards against the Company. The Company may not have sufficient insurance coverage for all future claims. The Company may not be able to obtain
insurance in amounts or scope sufficient to provide the Company with adequate coverage against all potential liabilities. Any product liability claims
brought against the Company, with or without merit, could increase the Company’s product liability insurance rates or prevent the Company from
securing continuing coverage, could harm its reputation in the industry and could reduce product sales. In addition, the Company historically
experienced steep increases in its product liability insurance premiums as a percentage of revenue. If its premiums continue to rise, the Company may no
longer be able to afford adequate insurance coverage.
The Company is currently involved in litigation that could adversely affect the Company’s business and financial results, divert management’s
attention from the Company’s business, and subject the Company to significant liabilities.
On January 31, 2020, the Company filed a lawsuit in Federal District Court in California against Lutronic Aesthetics, Inc. and any involved corporate
affiliates (“Lutronic”). The lawsuit claims include misappropriation of trade secrets in violation of the Uniform Trade Secrets Act and the Defend Trade
Secrets Act; Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations Act (“RICO”) violations; tortious interference with contractual relations and with
prospective economic advantage; unfair competition as defined by the California Business and Professions Code; and aiding and abetting the breach of
fiduciary duties and/or duty of loyalty owed by certain former Company employees. On January 28, 2020, the Company initiated legal action against
certain former employees for multiple claims involving violations of these former employees’ explicit agreements with the Company, as well as
violations of duties owed to the Company under California law.
In both of these actions, the Company seeks compensatory damages, equitable relief and punitive damages, as well as fees and costs related to the legal
action. At this time, the Company is unable to predict the associated costs, expenses and timeline associated therewith. The Company cannot predict
with certainty the outcome or effect of any claim or other litigation matter, and there can be no assurance as to the ultimate outcome of any litigation or
proceeding. Litigation may have a material adverse effect on the Company because of potential adverse outcomes, defense costs, the diversion of the
Company’s management’s resources, availability of insurance coverage and other factors.
36
Table of Contents
If customers are not trained and/or the Company’s products are used by non-licensed practitioners, it could result in product misuse and adverse
treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s reputation, result in product liability litigation, distract management and result in additional
costs, all of which could harm the Company’s business.
Because the Company does not require training for users of its products and sell its products at times to non-licensed practitioners, there exists an
increased potential for misuse of the Company’s products, which could harm the Company’s reputation and the Company’s business. U.S. federal
regulations allow the Company to sell the Company’s products to or on the order of “licensed practitioners.” The definition of “licensed practitioners”
varies from state to state. As a result, the Company’s products may be purchased or operated by physicians with varying levels of training, and in many
states, by non-physicians, including nurse practitioners, chiropractors and technicians. Outside the U.S., many jurisdictions do not require specific
qualifications or training for purchasers or operators of its products. The Company does not supervise the procedures performed with the Company’s
products, nor does the Company require that direct medical supervision occur that is determined by state law. The Company and its distributors
generally offer but do not require product training to the purchasers or operators of the Company’s products. In addition, the Company sometimes sells
its systems to companies that rent its systems to third parties and that provide a technician to perform the procedures. The lack of training and the
purchase and use of its products by non-physicians may result in product misuse and adverse treatment outcomes, which could harm the Company’s
reputation and its business, and, in the event these result in product liability litigation, distract management and subject the Company to liability,
including legal expenses.
Adverse conditions in the global banking industry and credit markets may adversely impact the value of the Company’s marketable investments or
impair the Company’s liquidity.
The primary objective of most of the Company’s investment activities is to preserve principal. To achieve this objective, the Company invests its excess
cash primarily in money market funds and in highly liquid debt instruments of the U.S. government and its agencies and U.S. municipalities, in
commercial paper and high-grade corporate debt. As of December 31, 2019, the Company’s balance in marketable investments was $7.6 million. The
longer the duration of a security, the more susceptible it is to changes in market interest rates and bond yields. As yields increase, those securities with a
lower yield-at-cost show a mark-to-market unrealized loss. For example, assuming a hypothetical increase in interest rates of one percentage point, there
would not have any adverse impact the Company’s earnings. As a result, changes in the market interest rates will affect its future net income (loss).
The Company’s manufacturing operations are dependent upon third-party suppliers, making its vulnerable to supply shortages and price
fluctuations, which could harm its business.
Many of the components and materials that comprise the Company’s products are currently manufactured by a limited number of suppliers. In addition,
all of the Company’s skincare products are manufactured by its sole supplier, ZO. A supply interruption or an increase in demand beyond the
Company’s current suppliers’ capabilities could harm the Company’s ability to manufacture its products until a new source of supply is identified and
qualified. The Company’s reliance on these suppliers subjects the Company to a number of risks that could harm its business, including:
●interruption of supply resulting from modifications to or discontinuation of a supplier’s operations;
●delays in product shipments resulting from uncorrected defects, reliability issues or a supplier’s variation in a component;
●lack of long-term supply arrangements for key components with the Company’s suppliers;
●inability to obtain adequate supply in a timely manner, or on reasonable terms;
●inability to redesign one or more components in the Company’s systems in the event that a supplier discontinues manufacturing such components and
the Company’s inability to sources it from other suppliers on reasonable terms;
●difficulty locating and qualifying alternative suppliers for the Company’s components in a timely manner;
●production delays related to the evaluation and testing of products from alternative suppliers and corresponding regulatory qualifications; and delay in
supplier deliveries.
Any interruption in the supply of components or materials, or the Company’s inability to obtain substitute components or materials from alternate
sources at acceptable prices in a timely manner, could impair its ability to meet the demand of the Company’s customers, which would have an adverse
effect on the Company’s business.
Risks related to the reduction or interruption in supply and an inability to develop alternative sources for supply may adversely affect the Company’s
manufacturing operations and related product sales.
The Company maintains manufacturing operations at its facility in Brisbane, California, and purchases many of the components and raw materials used
in manufacturing these products from numerous suppliers in various countries. Any problem affecting a supplier (whether due to external or internal
causes) could have a negative impact on the Company.
In a few limited cases, specific components and raw materials are purchased from primary or main suppliers (or in some cases, a single supplier) for
reasons related to quality assurance, cost-effectiveness ratio and availability. While the Company works closely with its suppliers to ensure supply
continuity, the Company cannot guarantee that its efforts will always be successful. Moreover, due to strict standards and regulations governing the
manufacture and marketing its products, it may not be able to quickly locate new supply sources in response to a supply reduction or interruption, with
negative effects on its ability to manufacture its products effectively and in a timely fashion.
37
Table of Contents
The Company manufactures its goods at the Brisbane California site, as well as dual sourcing several product platforms at contract manufacturing
shops for redundancy. A few of the product platforms such as Enlighten and excel HR are only capable of being produced at the single site in
Brisbane, and as such the occurrence of a catastrophic disaster or other similar event could cause damage to its facilities and equipment, which
might require the Company to cease or curtail sales of these sole sourced platforms.
The Company is vulnerable to damage from various types of disasters, including fires, earthquakes, terrorist acts, floods, power losses, communications
failures, pandemics and similar events. If any such disaster were to occur, the Company may not be able to operate the Company’s business at the
Company’s facility in Brisbane, California. Before the Company could manufacture products from a replacement facility, the Company’s manufacturing
facilities which require regulatory agency approval, could require significant delays to obtain regulatory agency’s approval. The insurance the Company
maintains may not be adequate to cover the Company’s losses resulting from disasters or other business interruptions. Therefore, any such catastrophe
could seriously harm the Company’s business and consolidated results of operations.
Intellectual property rights may not provide adequate protection for some or all of the Company’s products, which may permit third parties to
compete against the Company more effectively.
The Company relies on patent, copyright, trade secret and trademark laws and confidentiality agreements to protect the Company’s technology and
products. As of January 25, 2021, the Company had issued 26 U.S. patents and 5 pending U.S. patent applications. Some of the Company’s components,
such as the Company’s laser module, electronic control system and high-voltage electronics, are not, and in the future may not be, protected by patents.
Additionally, the Company’s patent applications may not issue as patents or, if issued, may not issue in a form that will be advantageous to us. Any
patents the Company obtains may be challenged, invalidated or legally circumvented by third parties. Consequently, competitors could market products
and use manufacturing processes that are substantially similar to, or superior to, the Company’s. The Company may not be able to prevent the
unauthorized disclosure or use of the Company’s technical knowledge or other trade secrets by consultants, vendors, former employees or current
employees, despite the existence generally of confidentiality agreements and other contractual restrictions. Monitoring unauthorized uses and
disclosures of the Company’s intellectual property is difficult, and the Company does not know whether the steps it has taken to protect the Company’s
intellectual property will be effective. Moreover, the laws of many foreign countries will not protect the Company’s intellectual property rights to the
same extent as the laws of the U.S.
The absence of complete intellectual property protection exposes the Company to a greater risk of direct competition. Competitors could purchase one
of the Company’s products and attempt to replicate some or all of the competitive advantages the Company derives from the Company’s development
efforts, design around the Company’s protected technology, or develop their own competitive technologies that fall outside of the Company’s intellectual
property rights. If the Company’s intellectual property is not adequately protected against competitors’ products and methods, the Company’s
competitive position and its business could be adversely affected.
The Company may be involved in future costly intellectual property litigation, which could impact its future business and financial performance.
The Company’s competitors or other patent holders may assert that the Company’s present or future products and the methods the Company employs are
covered by their patents. In addition, the Company does not know whether its competitors own or will obtain patents that they may claim prevent, limit
or interfere with the Company’s ability to make, use, sell or import the Company’s products. For example, the Company received a letter from InMode
Ltd.’s counsel indicating that the Secret RF product which it distributes in the U.S. on behalf of ILOODA Co. Ltd., a Korean company violates U.S.
Patent No. 10,799,285, which was issued to InMode in October 2020. If the Company is unable to resolve this matter, it may have to discontinue selling
the Secret RF product and may become involved in litigation or liable for damages as a result of its sales of the Secret RF product. Although the
Company may seek to resolve any potential future claims or actions such as this one, it may not be able to do so on reasonable terms, or at all. If,
following a successful third-party action for infringement, the Company cannot obtain a license or redesign the Company’s products, it may have to
stop selling the applicable products and the Company’s business would suffer as a result. In addition, a court could require the Company to pay
substantial damages, and prohibit the Company from using technologies essential to the Company’s products, any of which would have a material
adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.
The Company may become involved in litigation not only as a result of alleged infringement of a third party’s intellectual property rights but also to
protect the Company’s own intellectual property. For example, the Company has been involved in litigation to protect the trademark rights associated
with its company name or the names of its products. Infringement and other intellectual property claims, with or without merit, can be expensive and
time- consuming to litigate, and could divert management’s attention from its core business.
The expense and potential unavailability of insurance coverage for the Company’s customers could adversely affect its ability to sell its products,
and therefore adversely affect its financial condition.
Some of the Company’s customers and prospective customers have had difficulty procuring or maintaining liability insurance to cover their operation
and use of its products. Medical malpractice carriers are withdrawing coverage in certain states or substantially increasing premiums. If this trend
continues or worsens, the Company’s customers may discontinue using the Company’s products and potential customers may opt against purchasing
laser-based products due to the cost or inability to procure insurance coverage. The unavailability of insurance coverage for the Company’s customers
and prospects could adversely affect its ability to sell its products, and that could harm its financial condition.
From time to time the Company may become subject to income tax audits or similar proceedings, and as a result the Company may incur additional
costs and expenses or owe additional taxes, interest and penalties that may negatively impact its operating results.
The Company is subject to income taxes in the U.S. and certain foreign jurisdictions where it operates through a subsidiary, including Australia,
Belgium, Canada, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, Spain, Switzerland, Italy and the United Kingdom. The Company’s determination of its tax
liability is subject to review by applicable domestic and foreign tax authorities.
The Company is going through sales tax audit as of December 31, 2020 and underwent an income tax audits for its German and Japanese subsidiaries
for the tax years December 31, 2011 through 2018. Although these income tax audits did not result in any adjustments, the final timing and resolution of
any future tax examinations are subject to significant uncertainty and could result in the Company’s having to pay amounts to the applicable tax
authority in order to resolve examination of its tax positions. An increase or decrease of tax related to tax examination resolution could result in a change
in the Company’s income tax accrual and could negatively impact its financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
38
Table of Contents
The Company may be adversely affected by changes in U.S. tax laws, importation taxes and other changes that may be imposed by the current
administration.
The Company is subject to taxes in the U.S. and other jurisdictions. Tax rates in these jurisdictions may be subject to significant change due to economic
and/or political conditions. A number of other factors may also impact the Company’s future effective tax rate including:
●the jurisdictions in which profits are determined to be earned and taxed;
●the resolution of issues arising from tax audits with various tax authorities;
●changes in valuation of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities;
●increases in expenses not deductible for tax purposes, including write-offs and impairment of goodwill in connection with acquisitions;
●changes in availability of tax credits, tax holidays, and tax deductions;
●changes in share-based compensation; and
●changes in tax laws or the interpretation of such tax laws and changes in generally accepted accounting principles.
In the U.S., the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act, as amended by the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act (collectively, the
“Affordable Care Act”), for example, has the potential to significantly impact the pharmaceutical and medical device industries. The Affordable Care
Act imposed, among other things, an annual excise tax of 2.3% on any entity that manufactures or imports medical devices offered for sale in the U.S.
Due to subsequent legislative amendments the excise tax was suspended for the period January 1, 2016 to December 31, 2019. The excise tax was
repealed at the end of 2019. The repeal of the excise tax had no material impact on the Company’s financial condition and cash flows.
Any acquisitions that the Company makes could result in operating difficulties, dilution, and other consequences that may adversely impact the
Company’s business and results of operations.
While the Company from time to time evaluates potential acquisitions of businesses, products and technologies, and anticipates continuing to make
these evaluations, the Company has no present understandings, commitments or agreements with respect to any material acquisitions or collaborative
projects. The Company may not be able to identify appropriate acquisition candidates or strategic partners, or successfully negotiate, finance or integrate
any businesses, products or technologies that the Company acquire.
The Company has limited experience as a team with acquiring companies and products. Furthermore, the integration of any acquisition and management
of any collaborative project may divert management’s time and resources from the Company’s core business and disrupt the Company’s operations and
it may incur significant legal, accounting and banking fees in connection with such a transaction. Acquisitions could diminish the Company’s available
cash balances for other uses, result in the incurrence of debt, contingent liabilities, or amortization expenses, and restructuring charges. Also, the
anticipated benefits or value of its acquisitions or investments may not materialize and could result in an impairment of goodwill and/or purchased long-
lived assets.
The Company’s failure to address these risks or other problems encountered in connection with the Company’s past or future acquisitions and
investments could cause the Company to fail to realize the anticipated benefits of such acquisitions or investments, incur unanticipated liabilities, and
harm the Company’s business and the Company’s financial condition or results.
The Company’s failure to comply with rules relating to bribery, foreign corrupt practices, and privacy and security laws may subject the Company to
penalties and adversely impact its reputation and business operations.
The Company’s business is subject to regulation and oversight worldwide including:
●the FCPA, which prohibits corporations and individuals from paying, offering to pay or authorizing the payment of anything of value to any foreign
government official, government staff member, political party or political candidate in an attempt to obtain or retain business or to otherwise influence a
person working in an official capacity;
●the UK Bribery Act, which prohibits both domestic and international bribery, as well as bribery across both public and private sectors; and bribery
provisions contained in the German Criminal Code, which, pursuant to draft legislation being prepared by the German government, may make the
corruption and corruptibility of physicians in private practice and other healthcare professionals a criminal offense;
●Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996, as amended by The Health Information Technology for Economic and Clinical Health Act,
which governs the conduct of certain electronic healthcare transactions and protects the security and privacy of protected health information; and
●analogous state and foreign law equivalents of each of the above laws, such as state laws that require device companies to comply with the industry’s
voluntary compliance guidelines and the applicable compliance guidance promulgated by the federal government; and state laws governing the privacy
and security of health information in certain circumstances, many of which differ from each other in significant ways and may not have the same effect,
thus complicating compliance efforts.
39
Table of Contents
The risk of being found in violation of these laws is increased by the fact that many of them have not been fully interpreted by the regulatory authorities
or the courts, and their provisions are open to a variety of interpretations. Because of the breadth of these laws and the narrowness of the statutory
exceptions and safe harbors available under such laws, it is possible that some of the Company’s business activities, including the
Company’s relationships with practitioners and thought leaders worldwide, some of whom recommend, purchase and/or use the Company’s devices, as
well as the Company’s sales agents and distributors, could be subject to challenge under one or more of such laws. The Company is also exposed to the
risk that the Company’s employees, independent contractors, principal investigators, consultants, vendors, independent sales agents and distributors may
engage in fraudulent or other illegal activity. While the Company has policies and procedures in place prohibiting such activity, misconduct by these
parties could include, among other infractions or violations, intentional, reckless and/or negligent conduct or unauthorized activity that violates FDA
regulations, including those laws that require the reporting of true, complete and accurate information to the FDA, manufacturing standards, laws that
require the true, complete and accurate reporting of financial information or data or other commercial or regulatory laws or requirements. It is not
always possible to identify and deter misconduct by the Company’s employees and other third parties, and the precautions the Company takes to detect
and prevent this activity may not be effective in controlling unknown or unmanaged risks or losses or in protecting the Company from governmental
investigations or other actions or lawsuits stemming from a failure to be in compliance with such laws or regulations.
There are similar laws and regulations applicable to the Company outside the U.S., all of which are subject to evolving interpretations. Global
enforcement of anti- corruption laws, including but not limited to the UK Bribery Act, the Brazil Clean Companies Act, and continued enforcement in
the Europe, Middle East and Asia Pacific has increased substantially in recent years, with more frequent voluntary self-disclosures by companies,
aggressive investigations and enforcement proceedings by governmental agencies, and assessment of significant fines and penalties against companies
and individuals. The Company’s operations create the risk of unauthorized payments or offers of payments by one of its employees, consultants, sales
agents, or distributors because these parties are not always subject to its control. It is the Company’s policy to implement safeguards to discourage these
practices; however, its existing safeguards and any future improvements may prove to be less than effective, and its employees, consultants, sales agents,
or distributors may engage in conduct for which the Company might be held responsible. Any alleged or actual violations of these regulations may
subject the Company to government scrutiny, severe criminal or civil sanctions and other liabilities, and could negatively affect its business, reputation,
operating results, and financial condition.
On July 27, 2017, the United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority announced that it intends to stop persuading or compelling banks to submit
LIBOR rates after 2021. These reforms may cause LIBOR to cease to exist, new methods of calculating LIBOR to be established or the establishment of
an alternative reference rate(s). These consequences cannot be entirely predicted and could have an adverse impact on the market value for or value of
LIBOR-linked securities, loans, and other financial obligations or extensions of credit held by the Company. Changes in market interest rates may
influence returns on financial investments and could reduce its earnings and cash flows.
While the Company believes it has a strong culture of compliance and adequate systems of control, and it seeks continuously to improve its systems of
internal controls and to remedy any weaknesses identified, there can be no assurance that the policies and procedures will be followed at all times or will
effectively detect and prevent violations of the applicable laws by one or more of its employees, consultants, agents or partners and, as a result, the
Company may be subject to penalties and material adverse consequences on its business, financial condition or results of operations.
Risks Related to the Notes
Although the notes are referred to as convertible senior notes, they are effectively subordinated to any of the Company's secured debt and any
liabilities of its subsidiaries.
The notes will be the Company's senior unsecured obligations and will rank:
●senior in right of payment to all of its indebtedness that is expressly subordinated in right of payment to the notes;
●equal in right of payment to all of its unsecured indebtedness that is not so subordinated;
●effectively junior to any of its secured indebtedness to the extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness, including any amount
outstanding under the Company's senior credit facility; and
●structurally junior to all indebtedness and other liabilities of its current or future subsidiaries (including trade payables).
In the event of the Company's bankruptcy, liquidation reorganization or other winding up, the Company's assets that secure secured indebtedness will be
available to pay obligations on the notes only after all such secured indebtedness has been repaid in full from such assets. There may not be sufficient
assets remaining to pay amounts due on any or all of the notes then outstanding.
In addition the notes are the Company's obligations exclusively and are not guaranteed by any of its subsidiaries. A portion of the Company's operations
are conducted through, and a portion of its consolidated assets are held by its subsidiaries. Accordingly, the Company's ability to service its debt,
including the notes, depends, in part, on the results of operations of its subsidiaries and upon the ability of such subsidiaries to provide the
Company with cash, whether in the form of dividends, loans or otherwise, to pay amounts due on its obligations, including the notes. The
Company's subsidiaries are separate and distinct legal entities and have no obligation contingent or otherwise, to make payments on the notes or to make
any funds available for that purpose. The Company's right to receive any assets of any of its subsidiaries upon such subsidiary’s bankruptcy, liquidation
or reorganization and, therefore, the right of the holders of notes to participate in those assets, will be subject to prior claims of creditors of the
subsidiary, including trade creditors, and such subsidiary may not have sufficient assets remaining to make any payments to the Company as a
shareholder or otherwise. In addition, dividends, loans or other distributions to the Company from such subsidiaries may be subject to contractual and
other restrictions and are subject to other business and tax considerations. The indenture governing the notes will not prohibit the Company from
incurring additional senior debt or secured debt, nor will it prohibit any of the Company's current or future subsidiaries from incurring additional
liabilities.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had $7.2 million of indebtedness for borrowed money outstanding, all of which would be effectively senior to
the notes to the extent of the collateral securing such indebtedness, and its subsidiaries had no indebtedness or other liabilities (after excluding
intercompany obligations and liabilities of a type not required to be reflected on a balance sheet of such subsidiaries in accordance with GAAP).
40
Table of Contents
Regulatory actions and other events may adversely affect the trading price and liquidity of the notes.
The Company expects that many investors in, and potential purchasers of, the notes will employ or seek to employ, a convertible arbitrage strategy with
respect to the notes. Investors would typically implement such a strategy by selling short the common stock underlying the notes and dynamically
adjusting their short position while continuing to hold the notes. Investors may also implement this type of strategy by entering into swaps on its
common stock in lieu of or in addition to short selling the common stock.
The SEC and other regulatory and self-regulatory authorities have implemented various rules and taken certain actions, and may in the future adopt
additional rules and take other actions, that may impact those engaging in short selling activity involving equity securities (including its common stock).
Such rules and actions include Rule 201 of SEC Regulation SHO, the adoption by the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. and the national
securities exchanges of a “Limit Up-Limit Down” program, the imposition of market-wide circuit breakers that halt trading of securities for certain
periods following specific market declines, and the implementation of certain regulatory reforms required by the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and
Consumer Protection Act of 2010. Any governmental or regulatory action that restricts the ability of investors in or potential purchasers of, the notes to
effect short sales of the Company's common stock, borrow its common stock or enter into swaps on the Company's common stock could adversely affect
the trading price and the liquidity of the notes.
Volatility in the market price and trading volume of the Company's common stock could adversely impact the trading price of the notes.
The Company expects that the trading price of the notes will be significantly affected by the market price of its common stock. The stock market in
recent years has experienced significant price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated to the operating performance of companies. The
market price of the Company's common stock could fluctuate significantly for many reasons, including in response to the risks described in this section,
elsewhere in this offering memorandum or the documents incorporated by reference in this offering memorandum or for reasons unrelated to
its operations, many of which are beyond the Company's control, such as reports by industry analysts, investor perceptions or negative announcements
by its customers, competitors or suppliers regarding their own performance, as well as industry conditions and general financial, economic and political
instability. A decrease in the market price of the Company's common stock would likely adversely impact the trading price of the notes. The market
price of the Company's common stock could also be affected by possible sales of its common stock by investors who view the notes as a more attractive
means of equity participation in the Company and by hedging or arbitrage trading activity that the Company expects to develop involving its common
stock. This trading activity could, in turn, affect the trading price of the notes.
The Company may still incur substantially more debt or take other actions which would intensify the risks discussed above.
The Company and its subsidiaries may incur substantial additional debt in the future, subject to the restrictions contained in its existing and future debt
agreements, some of which may be secured debt. The Company will not be restricted under the terms of the indenture governing the notes from
incurring additional debt, securing existing or future debt, recapitalizing its debt, repurchasing its stock, pledging its assets, making investments, paying
dividends, guaranteeing debt or taking a number of other actions that are not limited by the terms of the indenture governing the notes that could have
the effect of diminishing the Company's ability to make payments on the notes when due.
The Company may not have the ability to raise the funds necessary to settle conversions of the notes in cash or to repurchase the notes upon a
fundamental change, and its future debt may contain limitations on its ability to pay cash upon conversion or repurchase of the notes.
Holders of the notes will have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or a portion of their notes upon the occurrence of a fundamental change
before the maturity date at a repurchase price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be repurchased, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if
any. In addition, upon conversion of the notes, unless the Company elects to deliver solely shares of its common stock to settle such conversion (other
than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share), the Company will be required to settle a portion or all of its conversion obligation in respect
of the notes being converted in cash. Moreover, the Company will be required to repay the notes in cash at their maturity unless earlier converted,
redeemed or repurchased. However, the Company may not have enough available cash or be able to obtain financing at the time the Company
is required to make repurchases of notes surrendered therefor or pay cash with respect to notes being converted or at their maturity.
In addition, the Company's ability to repurchase notes or to pay cash upon conversions of notes or at their maturity may be limited by law, regulatory
authority or agreements governing its future indebtedness. The Company's failure to repurchase notes at a time when the repurchase is required by the
indenture or to pay cash upon conversions of notes or at their maturity as required by the indenture would constitute a default under the indenture. A
default under the indenture or the fundamental change itself could also lead to a default under agreements governing the Company's existing and future
indebtedness. Moreover, the occurrence of a fundamental change under the indenture could constitute an event of default under any such agreement. If
the payment of the related indebtedness were to be accelerated after any applicable notice or grace periods, the Company may not have sufficient funds
to repay the indebtedness.
The conditional conversion feature of the notes, if triggered, may adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.
In the event the conditional conversion feature of the notes is triggered, holders of the notes will be entitled to convert their notes at any time during
specified periods at their option. If one or more holders elect to convert their notes, unless the Company elects to satisfy the Company's conversion
obligation by delivering solely shares of its common stock (other than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share), the Company would be
required to settle a portion or all of its conversion obligation in cash, which could adversely affect the company's liquidity. In addition, even if holders of
notes do not elect to convert their notes, the Company could be required under applicable accounting rules to reclassify all or a portion of the
outstanding principal of the notes as a current rather than long-term liability, which would result in a material reduction of its net working capital.
41
Table of Contents
The accounting method for the notes could adversely affect the Company's financial condition and operating results.
The accounting method for initially reflecting the notes on the company's balance sheet, accruing interest expense for the notes and reflecting the
underlying shares of the Company's common stock in its reported diluted earnings per share may adversely affect its reported earnings and financial
condition.
The Company expects that, under current accounting principles, the initial liability carrying amount of the notes will be the fair value of a similar debt
instrument that does not have a conversion feature, valued using its cost of capital for straight, unconvertible debt. The Company expects to reflect the
difference between the net proceeds from this offering and the initial carrying amount as a debt discount for accounting purposes, which will be
amortized into interest expense over the term of the notes. As a result of this amortization, the interest expense that the Company expects to recognize
for the notes for accounting purposes will be greater than the cash interest payments the Company will pay on the notes, which will result in lower
reported income or higher reported losses. The lower reported income or higher reported losses resulting from this accounting treatment could depress
the trading price of its common stock and the notes.
However, in August 2020, the Financial Accounting Standards Board published an Accounting Standards Update, or ASU 2020-06, eliminating the
separate accounting for the debt and equity components as described above. ASU 2020-06 will be effective for SEC-reporting entities for fiscal years
beginning after December 15, 2021 (or, in the case of smaller reporting companies, December 15, 2023), including interim periods within those fiscal
years. However, early adoption is permitted in certain circumstances for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2020, including interim periods
within those fiscal years.
When ASU 2020-06 is adopted by the Company, the Company expects the elimination of the separate accounting described above to reduce the interest
expense that the Company expects to recognize for the notes for accounting purposes. In addition, ASU 2020-06 eliminates the use of the treasury stock
method for convertible instruments that can be settled in whole or in part with equity, and instead require application of the “if-converted” method.
Under that method, diluted earnings per share would generally be calculated assuming that all the notes were converted solely into shares of common
stock at the beginning of the reporting period, unless the result would be anti-dilutive. The application of the if-converted method may reduce the
Company's reported diluted earnings per share.
Furthermore, if any of the conditions to the convertibility of the notes is satisfied, then the Company may be required under applicable accounting
standards to reclassify the liability carrying value of the notes as a current, rather than a long-term, liability. This reclassification could be required even
if no noteholders convert their notes and could materially reduce the Company's reported working capital.
Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock, but they will be subject to all changes made with
respect to the Company's common stock to the extent the Company satisfies its conversion obligation, in whole or in part, with shares of its common
stock.
Holders of notes will not be entitled to any rights with respect to the Company's common stock (including, without limitation, voting rights and rights to
receive any dividends or other distributions on its common stock) prior to the conversion date relating to such notes (if the Company has elected to settle
the conversion by delivering solely shares of its common stock (other than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share)) or the last trading day
of the observation period (if the Company elects to pay and deliver, as the case may be, a combination of cash and shares of its common stock in respect
of the relevant conversion), but holders of notes will be subject to all changes affecting the Company's common stock. For example, if an amendment is
proposed to the Company's certificate of incorporation or bylaws requiring stockholder approval and the record date for determining the stockholders of
record entitled to vote on the amendment occurs prior to the conversion date related to a holder’s conversion of its notes (if the Company has elected to
settle the relevant conversion by delivering solely shares of its common stock (other than paying cash in lieu of delivering any fractional share)) or the
last trading day of the observation period (if the Company elects to pay and deliver, as the case may be, a combination of cash and shares of its common
stock in respect of the relevant conversion), such holder will not be entitled to vote on the amendment, although such holder will nevertheless be subject
to any changes affecting its common stock.
The conditional conversion feature of the notes could result in holders receiving less than the value of the Company's common stock into which the
notes would otherwise be convertible.
Prior to the close of business on the business day immediately preceding December 15, 2025, holders may convert their notes only if specified
conditions are met. If the specific conditions for conversion are not met, holders will not be able to convert their notes, and holders may be unable to
receive the value of the cash, common stock or a combination of cash and common stock, as applicable, into which their notes would otherwise be
convertible.
Upon conversion of the notes, holders may receive less valuable consideration than expected because the value of the Company's common stock may
decline after holders exercise their conversion right but before the Company satisfies it conversion obligation.
Under the notes, a converting holder will be exposed to fluctuations in the value of the Company's common stock during the period from the date such
holder surrenders notes for conversion until the date the Company satisfies its conversion obligation.
Upon conversion of the notes, the Company will satisfy its conversion obligation by paying or delivering, as the case may be, cash, shares of
its common stock, or a combination of cash and shares of its common stock, at the Company's option. If the Company satisfies its conversion obligation
solely in cash or through payment and delivery, as the case may be, of a combination of cash and shares of its common stock, the amount of cash and
shares of common stock, if any, due upon conversion will be based on a daily conversion value calculated on a proportionate basis for each trading day
in a 40 trading day observation period. This period would be: (i) subject to clause (ii), if the relevant conversion date occurs prior to December 15, 2025,
the 40 consecutive trading day period beginning on and including, the second trading day immediately succeeding such conversion date; (ii) if the
relevant conversion date occurs during a redemption period, the 40 consecutive trading days beginning on and including, the 41st scheduled trading day
immediately preceding the date that is specified as the redemption date in the related notice of redemption; and (iii) subject to clause (ii), if the relevant
conversion date occurs on or after December 15, 2025, the 40 consecutive trading days beginning on and including, the 41st scheduled trading day
immediately preceding the maturity date. Accordingly, if the price of the Company's common stock decreases during this period, the value of
consideration holders receive will be adversely affected. In addition, if the market price of the Company's common stock at the end of such period is
below the average of the daily volume weighted-average prices of the Company's common stock during such period, the value of any shares of the
Company's common stock that holders will receive in satisfaction of its conversion obligation will be less than the value used to determine the number
of shares that holders will receive.
If the Company elects to satisfy its conversion obligation solely in shares of the Company's common stock upon conversion of the notes, the
Company will be required to deliver the shares of its common stock, together with cash for any fractional share, on the second business day following
the relevant conversion date. Accordingly, if the price of the Company's common stock decreases during this period, the value of the shares that
holders receive will be adversely affected and would be less than the conversion value of the notes on the conversion date.
42
Table of Contents
The notes are not protected by restrictive covenants.
The indenture governing the notes will not contain any financial or operating covenants or restrictions on the payments of dividends, the incurrence of
indebtedness or the issuance or repurchase of securities by the Company or any of its subsidiaries. The indenture will not contain any covenants or other
provisions to afford protection to holders of the notes in the event of a fundamental change or other corporate transaction involving the Company subject
to certain exceptions.
The increase in the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption period may
not adequately compensate holders for any lost value of their notes as a result of such transaction or redemption.
If a make-whole fundamental change occurs prior to the maturity date or upon its issuance of a notice of redemption the Company will, under certain
circumstances, increase the conversion rate by a number of additional shares of its common stock for notes converted in connection with such make-
whole fundamental change or during the related redemption period. The increase in the conversion rate will be determined based on the date on which
the specified corporate transaction becomes effective or the redemption notice date, as applicable, and the price paid (or deemed to be paid) per share of
the Company's common stock in such transaction or on such redemption notice date. The increase in the conversion rate for notes converted in
connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption period may not adequately compensate holders for any lost value of their
notes as a result of such transaction or redemption. Furthermore, if the Company calls only a portion of the outstanding notes for redemption, only those
notes called (or deemed called) for redemption will become convertible as a result of such call for redemption and only the conversion rate of notes
converted in connection with such notice of redemption will be increased. Accordingly, notes not called for redemption will not become convertible if
not otherwise convertible at such time and will remain outstanding, and may have reduced liquidity and a resulting reduced trading price.
Our obligation to increase the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with a make-whole fundamental change or during a redemption period
could be considered a penalty, in which case the enforceability thereof would be subject to general principles of reasonableness and equitable remedies.
The conversion rate of the notes may not be adjusted for all dilutive events.
The conversion rate of the notes is subject to adjustment for certain events, including, but not limited to, the issuance of certain stock dividends on the
Company's common stock, the issuance of certain rights or warrants, subdivisions, combinations, distributions of capital stock, indebtedness, or assets,
cash dividends and certain issuer tender or exchange offers. However, the conversion rate will not be adjusted for other events, such as a third-party
tender or exchange offer or an issuance of the Company's common stock for cash, that may adversely affect the trading price of the notes or its common
stock. An event that adversely affects the value of the notes may occur, and that event may not result in an adjustment to the conversion rate.
Provisions in the indenture governing the notes may deter or prevent a business combination that may be favorable to holders.
If a fundamental change occurs prior to the maturity date, holders of the notes will have the right, at their option, to require the Company to repurchase
all or a portion of their notes. In addition, if a make-whole fundamental change occurs prior the maturity date, the Company will in some cases be
required to increase the conversion rate for a holder that elects to convert its notes in connection with such make-whole fundamental change.
Furthermore, the indenture governing the notes will prohibit the Company from engaging in certain mergers or acquisitions unless, among other things,
the surviving entity assumes the Company's obligations under the notes. These and other provisions in the indenture could deter or prevent a third party
from acquiring the Company even when the acquisition may be favorable to holders.
The capped call transactions may affect the value of the notes and the Company's common stock.
In connection with the pricing of the notes, the Company intend to enter into capped call transactions with the counterparties. The capped call
transactions will cover, subject to customary adjustments, the number of shares of the Company's common stock initially underlying the notes. The
capped call transactions are expected generally to reduce the potential dilution to the Company's common stock upon any conversion of the notes. If the
initial purchasers exercise their option to purchase additional notes, the Company expects to enter into additional capped call transactions with the
counterparties.
The Company expects that, in connection with establishing their initial hedge of the capped call transactions, the counterparties or their respective
affiliates may enter into various derivative transactions with respect to the Company's common stock and/or purchase shares of its common stock
concurrently with or shortly after the pricing of the notes, including with certain investors in the notes. This activity could increase (or reduce the size of
any decrease in) the market price of the Company's common stock or the notes at that time.
43
Table of Contents
In addition, the Company expects that the counterparties or their respective affiliates may modify their hedge positions by entering into or unwinding
various derivatives with respect to its common stock and/or purchasing or selling the Company's common stock or other securities in secondary market
transactions following the pricing of the notes and prior to the maturity of the notes and are likely to do so on each exercise date of the capped call
transactions. This activity could also cause or prevent an increase or a decrease in the market price of the Company's common stock or the notes, which
could affect their ability to convert the notes and, to the extent the activity occurs during any observation period related to a conversion of notes, it could
affect the amount and value of the consideration that holders will receive upon conversion of the notes.
In addition, if any such capped call transactions fail to become effective, whether or not this offering of notes is completed, the counterparties (or their
respective affiliates) may unwind their hedge positions with respect to the Company's common stock, which could adversely affect the price of the
Company's common stock and the value of the notes.
The Company does not make any representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any potential effect that the transactions described
above may have on the price of the notes or the shares of the Company's common stock. In addition, the Company does not make any representation that
the counterparties will engage in these transactions or that these transactions, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.
The Company is subject to counterparty risk with respect to the capped call transactions.
The counterparties to the capped call transactions that the Company expects to enter into are financial institutions, and the Company will be subject to
the risk that one or more of the counterparties may default or otherwise fail to perform, or may exercise certain rights to terminate, their obligations
under the capped call transactions. The Company's exposure to the credit risk of the counterparties will not be secured by any collateral.
Global economic conditions have in the past resulted in the actual or perceived failure or financial difficulties of many financial institutions. If a
counterparty to one or more capped call transactions becomes subject to insolvency proceedings, the Company will become an unsecured creditor in
those proceedings with a claim equal to its exposure at the time under such transaction. the Company's exposure will depend on many factors but,
generally, its exposure will increase if the market price or the volatility of the Company's common stock increases. In addition, upon a default or other
failure to perform, or a termination of obligations, by a counterparty, the counterparty may fail to deliver the consideration required to be delivered to the
Company under the capped call transactions and it may experience more dilution than the Company currently anticipates with respect to its common
stock. The Company can provide no assurances as to the financial stability or viability of the counterparties.
Some significant restructuring transactions may not constitute a fundamental change, in which case the Company would not be obligated to offer to
repurchase the notes.
Upon the occurrence of a fundamental change, holders have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or a portion of their notes. However, the
fundamental change provisions will not afford protection to holders of notes in the event of other transactions that could adversely affect the notes. For
example, transactions such as leveraged recapitalizations, refinancings, restructurings or acquisitions initiated by the Company may not constitute a
fundamental change requiring the Company to offer to repurchase the notes. In the event of any such transaction the holders would not have the right to
require the Company to repurchase the notes, even though each of these transactions could increase the amount of its indebtedness, or otherwise
adversely affect its capital structure or any credit ratings, thereby adversely affecting the holders of notes.
The Company has not registered the notes or the common stock issuable upon conversion, if any, which will limit their ability to resell them.
The notes and the shares of common stock issuable upon conversion of the notes, if any, have not been registered under the Securities Act or any state
securities laws. Unless the notes and any shares of common stock issuable upon conversion of the notes, if any, have been registered, they may not be
transferred or resold except in a transaction exempt from or not subject to the registration requirements of the Securities Act and applicable state
securities laws. The Company does not intend to file a registration statement for the resale of the notes and the common stock, if any, into which the
notes are convertible.
The Company cannot assure holders that an active trading market will develop for the notes.
Prior to this offering, there has been no trading market for the notes, and the Company does not intend to apply to list the notes on any securities
exchange or to arrange for quotation on any automated dealer quotation system. The Company has been informed by the initial purchasers that they
intend to make a market in the notes after the offering is completed. However, the initial purchasers may cease their market-making at any time without
notice. In addition, the liquidity of the trading market in the notes, and the market price quoted for the notes, may be adversely affected by changes in
the overall market for this type of security and by changes in the Company's financial performance or prospects or in the prospects for companies in
its industry generally. As a result, the Company cannot assure holders that an active trading market will develop for the notes. If an active trading market
does not develop or is not maintained, the market price and liquidity of the notes may be adversely affected. In that case holders may not be able to sell
their notes at a particular time or holders may not be able to sell their notes at a favorable price.
Any adverse rating of the notes may cause their trading price to fall.
The Company does not intend to seek a rating on the notes. However, if a rating service were to rate the notes and if such rating service were to lower its
rating on the notes below the rating initially assigned to the notes or otherwise announces its intention to put the notes on credit watch, the trading price
of the notes could decline.
44
Table of Contents
Holders may be subject to tax if the Company makes or fails to make certain adjustments to the conversion rate of the notes even though holders do
not receive a corresponding cash distribution.
The conversion rate of the notes is subject to adjustment in certain circumstances, including the payment of cash dividends. If the conversion rate is
adjusted as a result of a distribution that is taxable to the Company's common stockholders, such as a cash dividend, holders may be deemed to have
received a dividend subject to U.S. federal income tax without the receipt of any cash. In addition, a failure to adjust (or to adjust adequately) the
conversion rate after an event that increases their proportionate interest in the Company could be treated as a deemed taxable dividend to holders if the
failure to adjust (or to adjust adequately) is made in connection with a distribution of cash or other property to the Company's common stockholders. If a
make-whole fundamental change occurs prior to the maturity date or the Company issues a notice of redemption under some circumstances, the
Company will increase the conversion rate for notes converted in connection with the make-whole fundamental change or during the related redemption
period. Such increase may also be treated as a distribution subject to U.S. federal income tax as a dividend. It is unclear whether any such deemed
dividend would be eligible for the preferential tax treatment generally available for dividends paid by U.S. corporations to certain U.S. holders. If
holders are a non-U.S. holders, any deemed dividend generally would be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax at a 30% rate, or such lower rate as may
be specified by an applicable treaty, which may be set off against subsequent payments with respect to the notes (or common stock into which the notes
convert). The Company do not currently expect to make distributions on its common stock, although no assurance can be given in this regard.
The Company may redeem the notes at its option, which may adversely affect their return.
The Company may not redeem the notes prior to March 20, 2024. On or after March 20, 2024 it may redeem for cash all or any portion of the notes, at
its option if the last reported sale price of its common stock has been at least 130% of the conversion price then in effect for at least 20 trading days
(whether or not consecutive) during any 30 consecutive trading day period (including the last trading day of such period) ending on and including, the
trading day immediately preceding the date on which the Company provides notice of redemption at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal
amount of the notes to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. If the Company calls any note for
redemption, holders may convert their note called for redemption (or any portion thereof) at any time prior to the close of business on the second
scheduled trading day immediately preceding the applicable redemption date. Prevailing interest rates at the time the Company redeem the notes may be
lower than the interest rate on the notes. Upon such redemption or conversion, the cash comprising the redemption price, in the case of a redemption, or
the applicable conversion consideration, in the case of a conversion in connection with a redemption notice, in either case, may not fully compensate
holders for any future interest payments that holders would have otherwise received or for any other lost time value of their notes.
The notes will initially be held in book-entry form and, therefore, holders must rely on the procedures and the relevant clearing systems to exercise
their rights and remedies.
Unless and until certificated notes are issued in exchange for book-entry interests in the notes, owners of the book-entry interests will not be considered
owners or holders of notes. Instead, DTC, or its nominee, will be the sole holder of the notes. Payments of principal, interest (including any additional
interest), cash amounts due upon conversion and other amounts owing on or in respect of the notes in global form will be made to the paying agent,
which will make the payments to DTC. Thereafter, such payments will be credited to DTC participants’ accounts that hold book-entry interests in the
notes in global form and credited by such participants to indirect participants. Unlike holders of the notes themselves, owners of book-entry interests
will not have the direct right to act upon the Company's solicitations for consents or requests for waivers or other actions from holders of the notes.
Instead, if a holder owns a book-entry interest, such holder will be permitted to act only to the extent such holder has received appropriate proxies to do
so from DTC or, if applicable, a participant. The Company cannot assure holders that the procedures implemented for the granting of such proxies will
be sufficient to enable holders to vote on any requested actions on a timely basis.
Risks Related to Ownership of the Company's Common Stock
Anti-takeover provisions contained in the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws, as well as
provisions of Delaware law, could impair a takeover attempt.
The Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws and Delaware law contain provisions which could have
the effect of rendering more difficult, delaying or preventing an acquisition deemed undesirable by the Company's board of directors. Among other
things, the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws include provisions:
●authorizing a classified board of directors whose members serve staggered three-year terms;
●authorizing “blank check” preferred stock, which could be issued by the Company's board of directors without stockholder approval and may contain
voting, liquidation, dividend and other rights superior to its common stock;
●limiting the liability of, and providing indemnification to, its directors and officers;
●limiting the ability of its stockholders to call and bring business before special meetings;
●requiring advance notice of stockholder proposals for business to be conducted at meetings of the Company's stockholders and for nominations of
candidates for election to its board of directors; and
●controlling the procedures for the conduct and scheduling of board of directors and stockholder meetings.
These provisions, alone or together, could delay or prevent hostile takeovers and changes in control or changes in the Company's management.
As a Delaware corporation, the Company is also subject to provisions of Delaware law, including Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law
(the “DGCL”), which prevents certain stockholders holding more than 15% of its outstanding capital stock from engaging in certain business
combinations without approval of the holders of at least two-thirds of the Company's outstanding common stock not held by such stockholder.
Any provision of the Company's amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws or Delaware law that has the effect of
delaying, preventing or deterring a change in control could limit the opportunity for its stockholders to receive a premium for their shares of the
Company's capital stock, and could also affect the price that some investors are willing to pay for its common stock.
45
Table of Contents
The Company's business could be negatively affected by activist shareholders.
Responding to actions by activist shareholders could be costly and time-consuming, disrupt the Company's operations and divert the attention of
management and its employees. Additionally, perceived uncertainties as to the Company's future direction as a result of shareholder activism or changes
to the composition of its board of directors may lead to the perception of a change in the direction of its business or other instability, which may be
exploited by its competitors, cause concern to the Company's current or potential customers, and make it more difficult to attract and retain qualified
personnel. If customers choose to delay, defer or reduce transactions with the Company or do business with its competitors instead of the Company, then
the Company's business, financial condition and operating results would be adversely affected. In addition, the share price of its common stock and the
trading price of the notes could experience periods of increased volatility as a result of shareholder activism.
If securities or industry analysts do not publish or cease publishing research or reports about the Company, its business, its market or
its competitors, or if they adversely change their recommendations regarding the Company's common stock, the market price and trading volume of
its notes and common stock could decline.
The trading market for the Company's notes and common stock will be influenced, to some extent, by the research and reports that securities or industry
analysts publish about the Company, its business, its market or its competitors. If any of the analysts who cover the Company adversely change their
recommendations regarding its common stock or provide more favorable recommendations about its competitors, the market price of the
Company's notes and common stock would likely decline. If any of the analysts who cover the Company cease coverage of the company or fail to
regularly publish reports on it, the Company could lose visibility in the financial markets, which in turn could cause the market price and trading volume
of its notes and common stock to decline.
The Company does not expect to declare any dividends on its common stock in the foreseeable future.
The Company does not anticipate declaring any cash dividends to holders of its common stock in the foreseeable future. Consequently, investors may
need to rely on sales of its common stock after price appreciation, which may never occur, as the only way to realize any future gains on their
investment. Investors seeking cash dividends should not purchase shares of its common stock.
If the Company raises additional capital through the sale of shares of the Company’s common stock, convertible securities or debt in the future, its
stockholders’ ownership in the Company could be diluted and restrictions could be imposed on the Company’s business.
On April 21, 2020, the Company issued and sold an aggregate of 2,742,750 shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.001 per share at a
price to the public of $10.50 per share. The shares include the full exercise of the underwriter’s option to purchase an additional 357,750 shares of
common stock. The Company received net proceeds from the offering of approximately $26.5 million, after deducting underwriting discounts,
commissions, and offering expenses of $2.1 million. In addition to this offering, the Company may issue shares of its common stock or securities
convertible into its common stock to raise additional capital in the future. To the extent the Company issues such securities, its stockholders may
experience substantial dilution and the trading price of the Company’s common stock could decline. If the Company obtains funds through a credit
facility or through the issuance of debt or preferred securities, such debt or preferred securities could have rights senior to the existing stockholders’
rights as a common shareholder, which could impair the value of the Company’s common stock.
ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
Not applicable.
46
Table of Contents
ITEM 2. PROPERTIES
The Company occupies 66,000 square feet for its U.S. Corporate office in Brisbane, California, under a lease which extends through January 31, 2028.
The original lease expired on December 31, 2017, and the Company entered into a Second Amendment on July 6, 2017 that extended the term of the lease
to January 31, 2023 and a Third Amendment on July 9, 2020 that extended the term of the lease to January 31, 2028. The amendment provides for the
following: a) The extension of the lease term, with the extended term to begin on February 1, 2023 and continue until January 31, 2028; b) the abatement
of the monthly base rent for the four month period beginning September 1, 2020 and ending December 31, 2020; c) the amendment of monthly base rent
during the extension term to approximately $0.2 million for January 2021 with annual increases of 3.5% thereafter; and d) the waiver by the Company of
its early termination right in the lease. Pursuant to the terms of the Third Amendment to the Lease Agreement, the Company has the option to extend the
term of the lease by an additional 60 months.
In addition, the Company has leased office facilities in certain countries as follows:
Country
Japan
France
Spain
Belgium
Square Footage
Approximately 5,896
Approximately 2,239
Approximately 3,584
Approximately 151
Lease termination or Expiration
Two leases, one of which was amended during fiscal year 2020 and extended to March
2024, and the other which initially expired in December 31, 2019 and was extended for
another two years to December 31, 2021.
One lease which expires in October 2021.
One lease which was set to expire in January 31, 2021 but was extended for another two
years to January 31, 2023.
One lease signed effective March 1, 2020, which expires in November 2023.
The Company believes that these facilities are suitable and adequate for its current and future needs for at least the next twelve months.
ITEM 3.
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
From time to time, the Company may be involved in legal and administrative proceedings and claims of various types. For a description of material
pending legal and regulatory proceedings and settlements as of December 31, 2020, please see Note 11 to the Company’s consolidated financial
statements entitled “Commitments and Contingencies,” Part II Item 8, included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
ITEM 4.
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
Not applicable.
47
Table of Contents
PART II
ITEM 5.
MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER
PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
Stock Exchange Listing
The Company’s common stock trades on The NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “CUTR.” As of March 1, 2021, the closing sale price
of its common stock was $35.12 per share.
Common Stockholders
The Company had 5 stockholders of record as of March 1, 2021. The Company believes the actual number of stockholders is greater than this number
of record holders and includes stockholders who are beneficial owners, but whose shares are held in “street” name by brokers and other nominees. This
number of holders of record also does not include stockholders whose shares may be held in trust by other entities.
Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
There were no repurchases of the Company’s common stock under the Company’s Stock Repurchase Program in 2020.
Sales of Unregistered Securities
The Company did not sell any unregistered securities during the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Dividends
For a discussion regarding the Company’s intentions with respect to dividends, see the section titled “Stock-based Compensation Expense” set forth in
Part II Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans
The information required by this Item regarding equity compensation plans is incorporated by reference to the information set forth in Part III Item 12
of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
48
Table of Contents
Performance Graph
The graph below compares Cutera, Inc.'s cumulative 5-Year total shareholder return on common stock with the cumulative total returns of the NASDAQ
Composite index and the NASDAQ Medical Equipment index. The graph tracks the performance of a $100 investment in the Company’s common stock
and in each index (with the reinvestment of all dividends) from December 31, 2015 to December 31, 2020.
In accordance with SEC rules, the information contained under “Performance Graph” shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material,” or to be “filed”
with the SEC or subject to the SEC’s Regulation 14A or 14C, other than as provided under Item 201(e) of Regulation S-K, or to the liabilities of Section
18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, except to the extent that the Company specifically request that the information be treated as
soliciting material or specifically incorporate it by reference into a document filed under the Securities Act, or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended.
49
Table of Contents
ITEM 6.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
The following selected consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements and the
accompanying Notes and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” included elsewhere in this report.
The selected data in this section is not intended to replace the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Consolidated Statements of Operations Data (in
thousands, except per share data):
Net revenue
Cost of revenue
Gross profit
Operating expenses:
Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative
Lease termination income
Total operating expenses
Income (loss) from operations
Interest and other income, net
Income (loss) before income taxes
Income tax (benefit) provision
Net income (loss)
Net income (loss) per share:
Basic
Diluted
Weighted-average number of shares used in per share
calculations:
Basic
Diluted
Year Ended December 31,
2020*
2019*
2018*
2017
147,683 $
71,911
75,772
52,766
14,322
31,512
—
98,600
(22,828)
(579)
(23,407)
470
(23,877) $
181,712 $
83,549
98,163
71,109
15,085
24,033
—
110,227
(12,064)
(199)
(12,263)
85
(12,348) $
162,720 $
82,338
80,382
151,493
65,383
86,110
58,420
14,359
20,995
—
93,774
(13,392)
(123)
(13,515)
17,255
(30,770) $
52,070
12,874
14,090
(4,000)
75,034
11,076
884
11,960
(18,033)
29,993 $
(1.43) $
(1.43) $
(0.88) $
(0.88) $
(2.23) $
(2.23) $
2.16 $
2.04 $
$
$
$
$
2016
118,056
49,921
68,135
41,563
11,232
12,943
—
65,738
2,397
323
2,720
143
2,557
0.19
0.19
16,691
16,691
14,096
14,096
13,771
13,771
13,873
14,728
13,225
13,753
As of December 31,
Consolidated Balance Sheet Data (in
thousands):
Cash, cash equivalents and marketable investments $
Working capital (current assets less current
liabilities)
Total assets
Total long-term liabilities
Retained earnings (accumulated deficit)
Total stockholders’ equity
2020*
2019*
2018*
2017
2016
47,047 $
33,921 $
35,575 $
35,912 $
54,074
51,938
132,733
21,495
(60,235)
56,880
36,424
113,738
9,174
(36,358)
45,942
39,578
97,637
3,631
(24,010)
46,386
45,063
111,238
3,034
2,947
64,893
59,460
91,854
2,455
(27,046)
61,010
* Financial results for year ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, as compared to the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 reflect the effects of
adopting ASU 2014-09, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606)” and the related amendments, which provided a new basis of accounting for
the Company’s revenue arrangements during fiscal year 2018. The adoption of ASC 606 limits the comparability of revenue and operating expenses
presented in the statement of operations for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, when compared to the years ended December 31, 2017
and 2016. The adoption of ASC 606 also limits the comparability of certain balance sheet items, including total assets, for the years ended December 31,
2020, 2019 and 2018 when compared to the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016. See Note 1, “Revenue Recognition” to the Consolidated Financial
Statements set forth in Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Financial results for year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, as compared to the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 also reflect the effects of
adopting ASU 2016-02, "Leases," (also known as ASC Topic 842) which requires, among other items, lease accounting to recognize most leases as assets
and liabilities on the balance sheet. The adoption of ASC 842 limits the comparability of certain balance sheet items for the year ended December 31, 2020
and 2019 when compared to the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016. For additional information regarding the impact from adoption of this
accounting standard, See Note 1, “Leases” to the Consolidated Financial Statements set forth in Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
50
Table of Contents
ITEM 7.
MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
The following discussion should be read in conjunction with the Company’s audited financial statements and notes thereto for the fiscal year ended
December 31, 2020. This Annual Report on Form 10-K, including the following sections, contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Throughout this Report, and particularly in this Item 7, the forward-looking statements are based upon
the Company’s current expectations, estimates and projections and that reflect the Company’s beliefs and assumptions based upon information available
to the Company at the date of this Report. In some cases, you can identify these statements by words such as “may,” “might,” “could,” “will,”
“should,” “expects,” “plans,” “anticipates,” “likely,” “believes,” “estimates,” “intends,” “forecasts,” “foresees,” “predicts,” “potential” or
“continue,” and other similar terms. These forward-looking statements are not guarantees of future performance and are subject to risks, uncertainties,
and assumptions that are difficult to predict. The Company’s actual results, performance or achievements could differ materially from those expressed
or implied by the forward-looking statements. The forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, statements relating to the Company’s
future financial performance, the ability to grow the Company’s business, increase the Company’s revenue, manage expenses, generate additional cash,
achieve and maintain profitability, develop and commercialize existing and new products and applications, improve the performance of the Company’s
worldwide sales and distribution network, and to the outlook regarding long term prospects. The Company cautions you not to place undue reliance on
these forward-looking statements, which reflect management’s analysis only as of the date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The Company
undertakes no obligation to update forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances occurring after the date of this Form 10-K.
Some of the important factors that could cause the Company’s results to differ materially from those in the Company’s forward-looking statements, and
a discussion of other risks and uncertainties, are discussed in Item 1A—Risk Factors. The Company encourages you to read that section carefully as
well as other risks detailed from time to time in the Company’s filings with the SEC.
Introduction
The Management’s Discussion and Analysis (“MD&A”) is organized as follows:
●Executive Summary. This section provides a general description and history of the Company’s business, a brief discussion of the Company’s product
lines and the opportunities, trends, challenges and risks the Company focuses on in the operation of the Company’s business.
●Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates. This section describes the key accounting policies that are affected by critical accounting estimates.
●Recent Accounting Guidance. This section describes the issuance and effect of new accounting pronouncements that are or may be applicable to us.
●Results of Operations. This section provides the Company’s analysis and outlook for the significant line items on the Company’s Consolidated
Statements of Operations.
●Liquidity and Capital Resources. This section provides an analysis of the Company’s liquidity and cash flows, as well as a discussion of the Company’s
commitments that existed as of December 31, 2020.
Executive Summary
Company Description
The Company is a leading medical device company specializing in the research, development, manufacture, marketing and servicing of light and other
energy-based aesthetics systems for practitioners worldwide. In addition to internal development of products, the Company distributes third party
sourced products under the Company’s own brand names. The Company offers easy-to-use products which enable practitioners to perform safe and
effective aesthetic procedures, including treatment for body contouring, skin resurfacing and revitalization, tattoo removal, removal of benign pigmented
lesions, vascular conditions, hair removal, toenail fungus and women's intimate health. The Company’s platforms are designed to be easily upgraded to
add additional applications and hand pieces, which provide flexibility for the Company’s customers as they expand their practices. In addition to systems
and upgrade revenue, the Company generates revenue from the sale of post warranty service contracts, providing services for products that are out of
warranty, hand piece refills and other per procedure related revenue on select systems and distribution of third-party manufactured skincare products.
The Company also expands its revenues from sales of third-party skincare products by utilizing its network and relationships with physicians and
practitioners.
The Company’s ongoing research and development activities primarily focus on developing new products, as well as improving and enhancing the
Company’s portfolio of existing products. The Company also explores ways to expand the Company’s product offerings through alternative
arrangements with other companies, such as distribution arrangements. The Company introduced Juliet, a product for women’s intimate health, in
December 2017, Secret RF, a fractional RF microneedling device for skin revitalization, in January 2018, enlighten SR in April 2018, truSculpt iD in
July 2018, excel V+ in February 2019 truSculpt flex in June 2019, Secret PRO in July 2020 and excel V+III during the fourth quarter of 2020.
The Company’s corporate headquarters and U.S. operations are located in Brisbane, California, where the Company conducts manufacturing,
warehousing, research and development, regulatory, sales and marketing, service, and administrative activities. The Company markets sells and
services the Company’s products through direct sales and service employees in North America (including Canada), Australia, Austria, Belgium, France,
Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, Spain, Switzerland and the United Kingdom. Sales and Services outside of these direct markets are made through a
worldwide distributor network in over 42 countries.
51
Table of Contents
Products and Services
The Company derives revenue from the sale of Products and Services. Product revenue includes revenue from the sale of systems, hand pieces and
upgrade of systems (collectively “Systems” revenue), replacement hand pieces, truSculpt iD cycle refills, and truSculpt flex cycle refills, as well as
single use disposable tips applicable to Juliet and Secret RF (“Consumables” revenue), the sale of third party manufactured skincare products
(“Skincare” revenue); and the leasing of equipment through a membership program . A system consists of a console that incorporates a universal graphic
user interface, a laser and (or) other energy-based module, control system software and high voltage electronics, as well as one or more hand pieces.
However, depending on the application, the laser or other energy-based module is sometimes contained in the hand piece such as with the Company’s
Pearl and Pearl Fractional applications instead of within the console.
The Company offers customers the ability to select the system that best fits their practice at the time of purchase and then to cost-effectively add
applications to their system as their practice grows. This provides customers the flexibility to upgrade their systems whenever they choose and provides
the Company with a source of additional Systems revenue. The Company’s primary system platforms include excel, enlighten, Juliet, Secret RF,
truSculpt and xeo.
Skincare revenue relates to the distribution of ZO’s skincare products in Japan. The skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and
sold to medical offices and licensed physicians. The Company acts as the principal in this arrangement, as the Company determines the price to charge
customers for the skincare products and controls the products before they are transferred to the customer.
Service includes prepaid service contracts, enlighten installation, customer marketing support and labor on out-of-warranty products.
Significant Business Trends
The Company believes that the ability to grow revenue will be primarily impacted by the following:
●continuing to expand the Company’s product offerings, both through internal development and sourcing from other vendors;
●ongoing investment in the Company’s global sales and marketing infrastructure;
●use of clinical results to support new aesthetic products and applications;
●enhanced luminary development and reference selling efforts (to develop a location where Company’s products can be displayed and used to assist in
selling efforts);
●customer demand for the Company’s products;
●consumer demand for the application of the Company’s products;
●marketing to physicians in the core dermatology and plastic surgeon specialties, as well as outside those specialties; and
●generating recurring revenue from the Company’s growing installed base of customers through the sale of system upgrades, services, hand piece refills,
truSculpt cycles, skincare products and replacement tips for Juliet and Secret RF products.
For a detailed discussion of the significant business trends impacting the Company’s business, please see the section titled “Results of Operations” below.
Critical accounting policies, significant judgments and use of estimates
The preparation of the Company’s audited consolidated financial statements and related notes requires the Company to make judgments, estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses, and related disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. The
Company has based its estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that the Company believes to be reasonable under the
circumstances. The Company periodically reviews its estimates and makes adjustments when facts and circumstances dictate. To the extent that there are
material differences between these estimates and actual results, its financial condition or results of operations will be affected.
An accounting policy is considered to be critical if it requires an accounting estimate to be made based on assumptions about matters that are highly
uncertain at the time the estimate is made, and if different estimates that reasonably could have been used, or changes in the accounting estimates that
are reasonably likely to occur periodically, could materially impact the consolidated financial statements. The Company believes that its critical
accounting policies reflect the more significant estimates and assumptions used in the preparation of its audited consolidated financial statements. The
critical accounting policies, judgments and estimates should be read in conjunction with the Company’s audited consolidated financial statements and
the notes thereto and other disclosures included in this report.
For an analysis of the Company’s Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates please refer to Note 1 “Summary of significant accounting policies” to the
Company’s audited consolidated financial statements included in Part II, Item 8 of this report.
The Company believes the following critical accounting policies, estimates and assumptions may have a material impact on reported financial condition
and operating performance and may involve significant levels of judgment to account for highly uncertain matters or are susceptible to significant
change:
Revenue Recognition
See "Part II, Item 8. Revenue Recognition, Note 1" to the consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2020, included in this
Annual Report on Form 10-K for additional information about the Company’s revenue recognition policy, significant judgement and criteria for
recognizing revenue.
The Company enters into contracts with multiple performance obligations where customers purchase a combination of systems and services.
Determining whether systems and services are considered distinct performance obligations that should be accounted for separately requires judgment.
The Company determines the transaction price for a contract based on the consideration it expects to receive in exchange for the transferred goods or
services. To the extent the transaction price includes variable consideration, such as expected price adjustments for returns, the Company applies
judgment when estimating variable consideration and when estimating the extent to which the transaction price is subject to the constraint on variable
consideration. The Company evaluates constraints based on its historical and projected experience with similar customer contracts.
52
Table of Contents
The Company allocates revenue to each performance obligation in proportion to the relative standalone selling prices and recognize revenue when
control of the related goods or services is transferred for each performance obligation.
The Company utilizes the observable standalone selling price when available, which represents the price charged for the performance obligation when
sold separately. When standalone selling prices for systems or services are not directly observable, the Company determines the standalone selling prices
using relevant information available and applies suitable estimation methods including, but not limited to, the cost plus a margin approach.
The Company determines the standalone selling price (“SSP”), for systems based on directly observable sales in similar circumstances to similar
customers. The SSPs for extended service contracts are based on observable prices when sold on a standalone basis.
Under the Company’s loyalty program, customers accumulate points based on their purchasing levels. Once a loyalty program member achieves a
certain tier level, the member earns a reward such as the right to attend the Company’s advanced training event for truSculpt, or a ticket for the
Company’s annual forum. A customer’s account must be in good standing to receive the benefits of the rewards program. Rewards are earned on a
quarterly basis and must be used in the following quarter. All unused rewards are forfeited. The fair value of the reward earned by loyalty program
members is included in accrued liabilities and recorded as a reduction of net revenue at the time the reward is earned.
Incremental costs of obtaining a contract, including sales commissions, are allocated to the distinct goods and services to which they relate based on the
relative stand-alone selling prices. Incremental costs related to obligations delivered at inception are recognized at contract inception. Those related to
obligations delivered over time are capitalized and amortized on a straight-line basis over the expected customer relationship period if the Company
expects to recover those costs. The Company uses the portfolio method to recognize the amortization expense related to these capitalized costs related to
initial contracts and such expense is recognized over a period associated with the revenue of the related portfolio, which is generally two to three years
for the Company’s product and service arrangements.
Valuation of Goodwill
Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of net identifiable assets and liabilities.
Goodwill is initially valued based on the excess of the purchase price of a business combination over the fair value of acquired net assets recognized
and represents the future economic benefits arising from other assets acquired that could not be individually identified and separately recognized.
Goodwill is not amortized, but is tested for impairment annually, at the reporting unit level, in the fourth quarter and whenever events or circumstances
indicate impairment may exist. An impairment charge is recorded for the amount, if any, by which the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds its implied
fair value. See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 1" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.
Capitalized Cloud Computing Costs
The Company capitalizes costs incurred related to implementation costs incurred in a hosting arrangement that is a service contract to develop or obtain
internal-use software in accordance with ASU No. 2018-15, "Intangibles (Topic 350): Customer’s Accounting for Implementation Costs Incurred in a
Cloud Computing Arrangement That Is a Service Contract," which aligns the requirements for capitalizing implementation costs incurred in a hosting
arrangement that is a service contract with the requirements for capitalizing implementation costs incurred to develop or obtain internal-use software.
The capitalized implementation costs are then amortized over the term of the hosting arrangement inclusive of expected contract renewals, which is
generally three to five years. See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 1" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for
more information. The Company periodically assesses the capitalized implementation costs for impairment. If the Company determines that an
impairment is necessary, the Company records an impairment loss.
Leases
Lessee
The Company is a party to certain operating and finance leases for vehicles, office space and storages. The Company’s material operating leases consist
of office space, as well as storage facilities. The Company’s leases generally have remaining terms of 1 to 10 years, some of which include options to
renew the leases for up to 5 years.
The Company determines if a contract contains a lease at inception. Right of Use Assets and lease liabilities are recognized at the lease commencement
date. Operating lease liabilities represent the present value of lease payments not yet paid. Operating lease Right of Use assets represent the right to use
an underlying asset and are based upon the operating lease liabilities adjusted for prepayments or accrued lease payments, initial direct costs, lease
incentives, and impairment of operating lease assets. To determine the present value of lease payments not yet paid, the Company estimates the
incremental secured borrowing rates corresponding to the maturities of the leases. The Company based the rate estimates on prevailing financial market
conditions, credit analysis and management judgment.
The Company recognizes expense for these leases on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Additionally, tenant incentives used to fund leasehold
improvements are recognized when earned and reduce the Company’s right-of-use asset related to the lease. These are amortized through the right-of-
use asset as reductions of expense over the lease term.
53
Table of Contents
Lessor
Beginning in 2020, the Company also enters into leasing transactions, in which the Company is the lessor, offered through the Company's membership
program. All of the Company's leases for equipment rentals were initially accounted for as operating leases. The lease agreements are typically
for three years; however, the customer has the right to terminate the lease after twelve months with no penalty. As such, the Company has determined
that the expected term of the lease is twelve-months. Rental charges are a fixed monthly fee, paid at the beginning of each month, over the term of the
lease. Along with the leased equipment, the membership program provides customers with a warranty service and a fixed amount of consumables per
month for the term of the lease, which are classified as non-lease components. The Company has made an accounting policy election to account for
qualifying lease components and associated non-lease components as a single component; accordingly, a lease component and an associated warranty
service non-lease component are combined and accounted for as an operating lease. The consumables do not qualify for the practical expedient and are
accounted for as a separate non-lease component.
The initial direct costs related to the Company’s operating leases for equipment rentals include the related commissions paid to employees upon the
origination of a lease agreement. These costs are included in Other current assets and prepaid expenses on the consolidated balance sheets and are
amortized over the lease term of twelve-months.
During the fourth quarter ended December 31, 2020, some of the membership program agreements were amended to grant the lessees an option to
purchase the leased system from the Company, at any time during the period of 12 months from signing the amended agreement. For contracts signed
under the amended membership agreement, the Company classified and accounted for the arrangement as sales-type leases, as the Company
determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option.
At the commencement of the sales-type leases, the Company derecognized the underlying equipment and recognized a lease receivable if collectability
criteria was met.
The Company adopted ASC Topic 842 on January 1, 2019, applying the modified retrospective method to all leases existing at the date of initial
application. The comparative information has not been adjusted and continues to be reported under the accounting standards in effect for the prior
period.
See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Notes 1 and 11" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.
Valuation of Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value, cost being determined on a standard cost basis which approximates actual cost on a
first-in, first-out basis. Net realizable value is the estimated selling prices in the ordinary course of the Company’s business, less reasonably predictable
costs of completion, disposal, and transportation. Standard costs are monitored and updated quarterly or as necessary, to reflect changes in raw material
costs, labor to manufacture the product and overhead rates.
The cost basis of the Company’s inventory is reduced for any products that are considered excess or obsolete based upon assumptions about future
demand and market conditions. The Company provides for excess and obsolete inventories when conditions indicate that the inventory cost is not
recoverable due to physical deterioration, forecast usage, obsolescence, reductions in estimated future demand and reductions in selling prices.
Inventory provisions are measured as the difference between the cost of inventory and net realizable value to establish a lower cost basis for the
inventories. The Company balances the need to maintain strategic inventory levels with the risk of obsolescence due to changing technology, timing of
new product introductions and customer demand levels.
The Company includes demonstration units within inventories. Demonstration units are carried at cost and amortized over an estimated economic life
of two years. Amortization expense related to demonstration units is recorded in Products cost of revenue or in the respective operating expense line
based on which function and purpose for which the demonstration units are being used. Proceeds from the sale of demonstration units are recorded as
revenue and all costs incurred to refurbish the systems prior to sale are charged to cost of revenue.
See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 1" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.
Stock-based Compensation Expense
The Company’s equity incentive plans are broad-based, long-term programs intended to attract and retain talented employees and align stockholder and
employee interests. The Company’s equity incentive plans provide for the grant of incentive stock options, non-statutory stock options, RSAs, restricted
stock units (“RSUs”), stock appreciation rights, performance stock units, performance shares, and other stock or cash awards. See "Part II, Item 8.
Financial Statements, Note 6" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.
The Company accounts for stock-based compensation costs in accordance with the accounting standards for share-based compensation, which require
that all share-based payments to employees and non-employees be recognized in the consolidated statements of operations based on their fair values.
54
Table of Contents
The Company uses the Black-Scholes option-pricing model using the single-option approach to determine the fair value of options granted. Option-
pricing models require the input of highly subjective assumptions, particularly for the expected stock price volatility and the expected term of options.
The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. Treasury yield for a duration similar to the expected term at the date of grant. The Company has never
paid any cash dividends on its common stock and it has no intention to pay a dividend at this time; therefore, the Company assumes that no dividends
will be paid over the expected terms of option awards. The Company determines the assumptions to be used in the valuation of option grants as of the
date of grant. As such, the Company uses different assumptions during the year if it grants options at different dates.
The assumptions used in the Black-Scholes-option pricing model to determine the fair value of an award include the following:
Expected Term: The expected term represents the weighted-average period that the stock options are expected to be outstanding prior to being
exercised. The Company determines expected term based on historical exercise patterns and its expectation of the time it will take for employees to
exercise options still outstanding.
Expected Volatility: For the underlying stock price volatility of the Company’s stock, the Company estimates volatility solely based on the Company’s
historical volatility of its stock price.
Forfeitures: The amount of stock-based compensation recognized during a period is based on the value of the portion of the awards that are ultimately
expected to vest. Under ASC 718, the Company has made an accounting policy to estimate forfeitures at the time awards are granted and revises, if
necessary, in subsequent periods if actual forfeitures differ from those estimates.
Risk-Free Interest Rate: The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant for the expected term of the
stock option.
The Company grants RSUs to the Company’s directors, officers and management employees and non-employees. The fair value of RSUs is based on
the stock price on the grant date using a single-award approach. The RSUs are subject to a service vesting condition and are recognized on a straight-
line basis over the requisite service period. Shares are issued on the vesting dates, net of applicable tax withholding requirements to be paid by the
Company on behalf of the recipient. As a result, the actual number of shares issued will be fewer than the actual number of RSUs outstanding.
Furthermore, the Company records the obligation for withholding amounts to be paid by the Company as a reduction to additional paid-in capital.
Performance stock units are granted to the Company’s officers and management employees and non-employees. PSU’s with operational measurement
goals are measured at the market price of the Company’s stock on the date of grant. The final number of shares of common stock issuable at the end of
the performance measurement period, subject to the recipient’s continued service through that date, is determined based on the expected degree of
achievement of the performance goals. Stock-based compensation expense for PSUs is recognized based on the expected degree of achievement of the
performance goals over the vesting period. On the vesting date of PSU awards, the Company issues fully paid up common stock, net of the minimum
statutory tax withholding requirements to be paid by the Company and records the obligation for withholding amounts as a reduction to additional paid-
in capital.
During 2020 and 2019, the Company’s Board granted to executive officers, senior management and certain employees PSUs that vest subject to the
recipients’ continued service and to the achievement of certain operational goals for the Company’s 2020 and 2019 fiscal year which consist of the
achievement of revenue targets for consumable products, revenue targets for international revenue, and certain operational milestones related to product
performance and business management.
On April 1, 2020, the Company issued RSUs to settle bonuses owed to management under the 2019 Management Bonus Program. In the past, the
Company paid these bonuses with cash on hand. However, due to the economic conditions resulting from COVID-19, fully vested shares were issued in
lieu of cash. The Company issued 209,981 shares related to this bonus payment to management and recognized $2.6 million in stock-based
compensation expense during fiscal year 2020. The Company also recorded an equivalent reduction in bonus expense as a result of the settlement of the
bonus in shares.
For a significant majority of the Company’s awards, share-based compensation expense is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service
period, which ranges from one to four years depending on the award. The Company recognizes share-based compensation expense for the portion of
the equity award that is expected to vest over the requisite service period and develops an estimate of the number of share-based awards which will
ultimately vest, primarily based on historical experience within separate groups of employees and expectations regarding achievement of PSU goals for
PSU awards. The forfeiture rates used in 2020 ranged from 0% to 20.8%. The estimated forfeiture rate is reassessed periodically throughout the
requisite service period. Such estimates are revised if they differ materially from actual forfeitures. For the award types discussed above, if the
employee or non-employee terminates employment prior to being vested in an award, then the award is forfeited.
Modifications of the terms of outstanding awards may result in significant increases or decreases in share-based compensation. During the third quarter
of 2020, the Company’s Board modified RSUs awards granted to certain senior management that vest subject to the recipients’ continued service.
55
Table of Contents
There were no significant modifications to the terms of outstanding options, and PSUs during 2020.
During the quarter ended March 31, 2020, the Company’s Board of Directors granted its executive officers, senior management, and certain employees
98,580 PSUs. The PSUs granted in the quarter ended March 31, 2020 vest subject to the recipients continued service and to the achievement of specific
optional and regulatory milestones.
On August 2, 2020, the Board awarded its new CFO, Rohan Seth, an option grant for 60,000 shares, which vests over 5 years, and a PSU award
covering a target of 22,423 shares, which vests over 2.5 years and is subject to performance-based criteria relating to the achievement of certain goals
with 40% based on achievement of Finance department goals and 60% based on the Company’s achievement of financial performance. The maximum
number of shares that may vest under the award is 150% of the target number of shares of Common Stock subject to the award.
See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Notes 1 and 6" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated financial statements for more information.
Income Taxes
The provision for income taxes is determined using the asset and liability approach of accounting for income taxes. Under this approach, deferred taxes
represent the estimated future tax effects of temporary differences between book and tax treatment of assets and liabilities and carryforwards to the
extent they are realizable.
The Company is subject to taxes on earnings in both the U.S. and various foreign jurisdictions. On a quarterly basis, the Company assesses the
realizability of its deferred tax assets. For those jurisdictions where tax carryforwards are likely to expire unused or the projected operating results
indicate that realization is not more likely than not, a valuation allowance is recorded to offset the deferred tax asset within that jurisdiction. In
assessing the need for a valuation allowance, the Company considers future taxable income and ongoing prudent and feasible tax planning strategies. In
the event that the Company determines that it would be able to realize its deferred tax assets in the future in excess of the net recorded amount, a
reduction of the valuation allowance would increase income in the period such determination was made. Likewise, should the Company determine that
it would not be able to realize all or part of its net deferred tax asset in the future, a reduction to the deferred tax asset would be charged to income in
the period such determination was made.
The Company’s net taxable temporary differences and tax carryforwards are recorded using the enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in
the periods in which the deferred tax liability or asset is expected to be settled or realized. Should the expected applicable tax rates change in the future,
an adjustment to the Company’s deferred taxes would be credited or charged, as appropriate, to income in the period such determination was made.
The Company’s effective tax rates have differed from the statutory rate primarily due to changes in the valuation allowance, foreign operations,
research and development tax credits, state taxes, and certain benefits realized related to stock option activity. The Company’s current effective tax rate
does not assume U.S. taxes on undistributed profits of foreign subsidiaries. These earnings could become subject to incremental foreign withholding or
U.S. state taxes, should they either be deemed or actually remitted to the U.S. The Company’s future effective tax rates could be adversely affected by
earnings being lower in countries where the Company has lower statutory rates and being higher in countries where the Company has higher statutory
rates, or by changes in tax laws, accounting principles, interpretations thereof, net operating loss carryback, research, and development tax credits, and
due to changes in the valuation allowance applied to its U.S. deferred tax assets. In addition, the Company is subject to the examination of the
Company’s income tax returns by the Internal Revenue Service and other tax authorities. The Company regularly assesses the likelihood of adverse
outcomes resulting from these examinations to determine the adequacy of the Company’s provision for income taxes.
Undistributed earnings of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries as of December 31, 2020 are considered to be indefinitely reinvested and, accordingly, no
provision for income taxes has been provided thereon. Due to the Transition Tax and Global Intangible Low-Tax Income (“GILTI”) regimes as enacted
by the 2017 Tax Act, those foreign earnings will not be subject to federal income taxes when actually distributed in the form of a dividend or otherwise.
The Company, however, could still be subject to state income taxes and withholding taxes payable to various foreign countries. The amounts of taxes
which the Company could be subject to are not material to the accompanying financial statements.
On March 27, 2020, the U.S. federal government enacted the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (“CARES Act”). The CARES Act
changed several of the existing U.S. corporate income tax laws by, among other things, increasing the amount of deductible interest, allowing companies
to carry back certain Net Operating Losses (“NOLs”) and increasing the amount of NOLs that corporations can use to offset income. Further, in
December 2020, the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021 was signed into law. It clarified that gross income does not include any amount that would
otherwise arise from the forgiveness of a PPP loan. The CARES Act did not have a material impact on the Company's income tax provision, deferred tax
assets and liabilities, and related taxes payable.
56
Table of Contents
The Company periodically assesses its exposures related to its global provision for income taxes and believe that it has appropriately accrued taxes for
contingencies. Any reduction of these contingent liabilities or additional assessment would increase or decrease income, respectively, in the period such
determination was made.
The Company records a liability for uncertain tax positions that do not meet the more likely than not standard as prescribed by the authoritative
guidance for income tax accounting. The Company records tax benefits for only those positions that it believes will more likely than not be
sustained. For positions that the Company believes that it is more likely than not that it will prevail, the Company records a benefit considering the
amounts and probabilities that could be realized upon ultimate settlement. If the Company judgment as to the likely resolution of the uncertainty
changes, if the uncertainty is ultimately settled or if the statute of limitation related to the uncertainty expires, the effects of the change would be
recognized in the period in which the change, resolution or expiration occurs. The Company has included in the Company’s Consolidated Balance
Sheet a long-term income tax liability for unrecognized tax benefits and accrued interest and penalties of $1,864 and $1,461 as of December 31, 2020
and December 31, 2019, respectively. See “Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 7. Income Taxes” in the accompanying Notes to consolidated
financial statements for more information.
Litigation
The Company has been, and may in the future become, subject to a number of legal proceedings involving securities litigation, product liability,
intellectual property, contractual disputes, trademark and copyright, and other matters. The Company records a liability and related charge to earnings in
its consolidated financial statements for legal contingencies when the loss is considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated. The
Company’s assessment is reevaluated each accounting period and is based on all available information, including discussion with any outside legal
counsel that represents us. If a reasonable estimate of a known or probable loss cannot be made, but a range of probable losses can be estimated, the low-
end of the range of losses is recognized if no amount within the range is a better estimate than any other. If a loss is reasonably possible, but not probable
and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
The Company does not participate in transactions that generate relationships with unconsolidated entities or financial partnerships, such as entities often
referred to as structured finance, variable interest or special purpose entities, which would have been established for the purpose of facilitating off-
balance sheet arrangements or other contractually narrow or limited purposes. As of December 31, 2020, the Company was not involved in any
unconsolidated transactions.
Recent Accounting Pronouncement
In addition to the impacts from new accounting pronouncements included above see Note 1 — “Summary of Significant Accounting Pronouncements”
in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. for a complete discussion of recent accounting
pronouncements adopted and not adopted.
Results of Operations
The following table sets forth selected consolidated financial data expressed as a percentage of net revenue.
Net revenue
Cost of revenue
Gross profit
Operating expenses:
Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative
Total operating expenses
Loss from operations
Interest and other expense, net
Loss before income taxes
Income tax provision
Net loss
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
100%
49%
51%
36%
10%
20%
66%
(15)%
(1)%
(16)%
—%
(16)%
100%
46%
54%
39%
8%
13%
61%
(7)%
—%
(7)%
—%
(7)%
100%
51%
49%
36%
9%
13%
58%
(8)%
—%
(8)%
11%
(19)%
57
Table of Contents
Net Revenue
The following table sets forth selected consolidated revenue by major geographic area and product category with changes thereof.
(Dollars in thousands)
Revenue mix by geography:
United States
International
$
$
Consolidated total revenue
United States as a percentage of total revenue
International as a percentage of total revenue
Revenue mix by product category:
Systems
2020
61,202
86,481
147,683
41%
59%
Year Ended December 31,
2019
% Change
% Change
2018
-42% $
15%
-19% $
106,243
75,469
181,712
58%
42%
4% $
24%
12% $
101,862
60,858
162,720
63%
37%
- North America
- Rest of World
Total Systems
Consumables
Skincare
Total Products
Service
Total Net revenue
Total Net Revenue
$
$
50,721
40,045
90,765
9,287
25,061
125,113
22,570
147,683
-48% $
-8%
-35%
-4%
194%
-21%
-2%
-19% $
96,718
43,760
140,478
9,648
8,512
158,638
23,074
181,712
3% $
13%
6%
132%
47%
11%
14%
12% $
93,977
38,618
132,595
4,162
5,778
142,535
20,185
162,720
The Company’s revenue decreased by $34.0 million, or 19%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to 2019, due to significant decline in
sales in the North America market as a direct result of the COVID-19 pandemic. The decrease was partially offset by increase in sales of Skincare
products.
Revenue by Geography
The Company’s U.S. revenue decreased by $45.0 million, or 42%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. The
decrease was due primarily to the COVID-19 pandemic. In response to the pandemic, government authorities imposed mandatory business closures,
shelter-in place and work-from-home orders and social distancing protocols during 2020 that significantly impacted the Company’s business operation.
The Company’s U.S. revenue increased $4.4 million, or 4%, for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to 2018. The increase was due primarily
to continued demand of the truSculpt portfolio, including the recently launched truSculpt flex, as well as the Company’s excel V+ system.
The Company’s international revenue increased $11.0 million, or 15%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019,
driven primarily by an increase in skincare product sales in Japan as a result of increased marketing and promotional efforts, as well as changes in
customers behavior due to the COVID-19 as some consumers opted to purchase skincare products rather than go to a doctor’s office for treatment due to
the COVID 19 pandemic, partially offset by decrease in the Company's distributor business due to the COVID-19 pandemic.
The Company’s international revenue increased $14.6 million, or 24%, for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to 2018, driven primarily by
increases in service revenue, systems, skincare products and consumables.
Revenue by Product Type
Systems Revenue
Systems revenue in North America decreased by $46.0 million, or 48%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019,
due primarily to the COVID-19 pandemic that impacted system sales. The Rest of the World systems revenue decreased by $3.7 million, or 8%,
compared to the same period in 2019. The decrease in Rest of the World revenue was primarily due to a decrease in the Company’s distributor business
in the Middle East due to the COVID-19 pandemic.
Systems revenue in North America increased $2.7 million, or 3%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018, due
primarily to the recently launched excel V+ and truSculpt flex systems. The Rest of the World systems revenue increased by $5.1 million, or 13%,
compared to the same period in 2018. The increase in Rest of the World revenue was primarily a result of an increase in the Company’s direct business
in Asia Pacific and Europe, as well as an increase in the Company’s distributor business in the Middle East due to the Company’s expansion to these
markets and new products launches.
58
Table of Contents
Consumables Revenue
Consumables revenue decreased $0.4 million, or 4%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. The decrease in
consumables revenue was primarily due to decreased sales in installed base of truSculpt iD, Secret RF, and truSculpt flex, each of which have a
consumable element, as well as the decline in usage of the consumables due to the COVID-19 pandemic.
Consumables revenue increased $5.5 million, or 132%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018. The increase in
consumables revenue was due to the introduction of Secret RF and Juliet during January 2019, and truSculpt iD in July 2019, each of which have
consumable elements.
Skincare Revenue
The Company’s revenue from Skincare products in Japan increased $16.5 million, or 194%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the
same period in 2019. This increase was due primarily to increased marketing and promotional efforts, as well as changes in customers behavior due to
the COVID-19 pandemic as some consumers opted to purchase skincare products rather than go to a doctor's office for treatment.
The Company’s revenue from Skincare products in Japan increased $2.7 million, or 47%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same
period in 2018. This increase was due primarily to increased marketing and promotional activities, and a temporary increase in consumer demand due to
changes in the Japanese consumption tax rate from 8% to 10% effective October 1, 2019.
Service Revenue
The Company’s Service revenue decreased $0.5 million, or 2%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. This
decrease was due primarily to decreased sales of service contracts and support and maintenance services provided on a time and materials basis to the
Company’s network of international distributors due to the COVID-19 pandemic.
The Company’s Service revenue increased $2.9 million, or 14%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018. This
increase was due primarily to increased sales of service contracts, and support and maintenance services provided on a time and materials basis to the
Company's network of international distributors.
Gross Profit
(Dollars in thousands)
Gross Profit
2020
% Change
Year Ended December 31,
2019
% Change
$
75,772
(23)% $
98,163
22% $
As a percentage of total revenue
51%
54%
2018
80,382
49%
The Company’s cost of revenue consists primarily of material, personnel expenses, product warranty costs, and manufacturing overhead expenses.
Gross profit as a percentage of revenue for the year ended December 31, 2020 decreased from 54% to 51%, compared to same period in 2019. The
decrease in gross profit as a percentage of revenue was primarily driven by a lower overhead absorption on lower revenue, the decline in the average
sales price of systems due to the COVID-19 pandemic and reduction-in-force and furloughed costs implemented by the Company during the first nine
months of 2020, partially offset by costs savings from the reduction-in-force and furlough and continuous investments in its international direct service
support and operational improvement activities.
Gross profit as a percentage of revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 increased from 49% to 54%, compared to same period in 2018. The
increase in gross profit as a percentage of revenue was largely driven by demand for the Company's new products with higher margins, as well as strong
growth in consumables and skincare products. The year ended December 31, 2018 also included a $5 million product remediation charge when the
Company recognized a liability for a product remediation plan related to of one of its legacy systems. The accrued expense consisted of the estimated
cost of materials and labor to replace the component in all units that were under the Company's standard warranty or were covered under existing
service contracts.
Sales and Marketing
(Dollars in thousands)
Sales and marketing
2020
% Change
Year Ended December 31,
2019
% Change
$
52,766
(26)% $
71,109
22% $
As a percentage of total revenue
36%
39%
2018
58,420
36%
Sales and marketing expenses consist primarily of personnel expenses, expenses associated with customer-attended workshops and trade shows, post-
marketing studies, advertising and training.
The $18.3 million, or 26%, decrease in sales and marketing expenses for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same period in 2019 was due
primarily to:
● $8.0 million decrease in labor costs due to a decrease in commission as a result of lower sales, salary reduction, furloughs and reductions-in-force
in early 2020;
● $4.8 million decrease in promotional and product demonstration expenses due to cancellation of trade shows and promotional events as a result
of the COVID-19 pandemic;
● $3.3 million decrease in travel related expenses resulting from the travel restrictions due to the COVID-19 pandemic;
● $1.1 million decrease in stock-based compensation due to decreased headcount; and
● $1.1 million decrease in consulting and outside professional fees.
59
Table of Contents
The $12.7 million, or 22%, increase in sales and marketing expenses for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the same period in 2018 was due
primarily to:
● $6.4 million increase in labor costs due to increased headcount;
● $2.4 million increase in stock-based compensation due to increased headcount;
● $1.9 million increase in consulting and outside professional fees;
● $1.2 million increase in software user license fees and other expenses;
● $0.5 million of higher travel related expenses in North America resulting from increased headcount; and
● $0.3 million of higher promotional and product demonstration expenses.
Research and Development (“R&D”)
(Dollars in thousands)
Research and development
As a percentage of total
revenue
2020
% Change
Year Ended December 31,
2019
% Change
2018
$
14,322
(5)% $
15,085
5% $
14,359
10%
8%
9%
R&D expenses consist primarily of personnel expenses, clinical research, regulatory and material costs. R&D expenses decreased by $0.8 million, or
5%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. The decrease in expense for the year ended December 31, 2020 was
due primarily to $0.6 million decrease in salaries and benefits due to cost cutting measures implemented in response to the COVID 19 pandemic, $0.5
million decrease in consulting services and $0.3 million decrease in travel and other costs, offset by a net increase in material and equipment costs used
for research and development activities of $0.6 million.
R&D expenses increased by 5% for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018. The increase in expense of $0.7 million
for the year ended December 31, 2019 was due primarily to an increase in stock-based compensation.
General and Administrative (“G&A”)
(Dollars in thousands)
General and administrative
2020
% Change
Year Ended December 31,
2019
% Change
$
31,512
31% $
24,033
14% $
As a percentage of total revenue
21%
13%
2018
20,995
13%
G&A expenses consist primarily of personnel expenses, legal, accounting, audit and tax consulting fees, as well as other general and administrative
expenses. G&A expenses increased by $7.5 million, or 31%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. The increase
in expenses was due primarily to $5.2 million increase in professional fees, consulting services and legal fees, $1.6 million increase in credit loss
expense, $0.5 million increase in software user license expense and $0.8 million increase due to a write off of capitalized Enterprise Resource Planning
cloud computing costs, partially offset by $0.4 million decrease in personnel related expenses, including stock-based compensation expense, and $0.2
million decrease in travel and other expense.
G&A expenses increased 14% for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the same period in 2018. The increase in expenses of $3.0 million
was due primarily to $1.1 million of personnel related expenses, inclusive of a $1.3 million decrease in stock-based compensation, $0.9 million increase
in professional fees, consulting services and legal fees related to the ongoing implementation efforts of a new Enterprise Resource Planning system and
$ 0.6 million related to executive severance costs.
Interest and Other Expense, Net
Interest and other income, net, consists of the following:
(Dollars in thousands)
Total interest and other expense, net
2020
$
As a percentage of total net revenue
% Change
Year Ended December 31,
2019
% Change
(579)
0.0%
191% $
(199)
(0.1)%
62% $
2018
(123)
(0.1)%
Interest and other expense, net increased $0.4 million, or 191%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to 2019. The increase was primarily
due to an amortization of loan costs related to the revolving loan obtained from Silicon Valley Bank during the year ended December 31, 2020 and a
decrease in interest income from marketable investments.
Net interest and other income expense was marginally higher for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the year ended December 31, 2018.
Income Tax Provision
(Dollars in thousands)
Income loss before income taxes
Income tax provision
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
$ Change
$ Change
2018
$
(23,407) $
470
(11,144) $
385
(12,263) $
85
1,252 $
(17,170)
(13,515)
17,255
During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company incurred income tax expense in foreign jurisdictions as the Company applied a full valuation
allowance against all U.S. federal and state deferred tax assets. During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company incurred income tax expense in
foreign jurisdictions which was partially offset by an income tax benefit of $0.3 million related to the release of reserves for uncertain tax positions in
Germany.
60
Table of Contents
Liquidity and Capital Resources
Sources and Uses of Cash
The Company’s principal source of liquidity is cash from maturity and sales of marketable investments and cash generated from the issuance of
common stock through exercise of stock options and the Company’s employee stock purchasing program. The Company actively manages its cash
usage and investment of liquid cash to ensure the maintenance of sufficient funds to meet its daily needs. The majority of the Company’s cash and
investments are held in U.S. banks and its foreign subsidiaries maintain a limited amount of cash in their local banks to cover their short-term operating
expenses.
As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company had $51.9 million and $36.4 million of working capital, respectively. Cash and cash
equivalents plus marketable investments increased by $13.1 million to $47.0 million as of December 31, 2020, from $33.9 million as of December 31,
2019, primarily as a result of cash obtained from financing activities, including net proceeds from the Company’s secondary offering of $26.5 million
and proceeds from the PPP loan of $7.1 million, partially offset by a decrease in sales caused by the business disruptions due to the COVID-19
pandemic. The Company’s $6.4 million cash inflow from investing activities is due primarily to the liquidation of marketable investments.
As of December 31, 2019, and December 31, 2018, the Company had $36.4 million and $39.6 million of working capital, respectively. Cash and cash
equivalents plus marketable investments decreased by $1.7 million to $33.9 million as of December 31, 2019, from $35.6 million as of December 31,
2018, primarily as a result of increased inventory purchases related to the increasing demand of the Company’s products, and an increase in investments
in sales, service, and other management headcount to facilitate continued revenue expansion.
Cash, Cash Equivalents and Marketable Investments
The following table summarizes the Company’s cash and cash equivalents and marketable investments (in thousands):
(Dollars in thousands)
Cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities:
Cash and cash equivalents
Marketable investments
Total
Consolidated Cash Flow Data
In summary, the Company’s cash flows were as follows:
(Dollars in thousands)
Cash flows provided by (used in):
Operating activities
Investing activities
Financing activities
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
2020
Year ended December 31,
2019
Change
47,047 $
—
47,047 $
26,316 $
7,605
33,921 $
20,731
(7,605)
13,126
2020
Year ended December 31,
2019
2018
(16,934) $
6,389
31,276
20,731 $
(2,217) $
1,067
1,414
264 $
308
10,773
787
11,868
$
$
$
$
Net cash used in operating activities was $16.9 million during 2020, which was due primarily to:
● $23.9 million net loss adjusted for non-cash related items consisting primarily of stock-based compensation expense of $10.1 million, $2.6
million amortization of capitalized contract costs, $2.1 million of provision for credit losses and $1.4 million depreciation and amortization.
● $6.0 million cash used as a result of a decrease in accounts payable;
● $3.2 million cash used due to an increase in other current assets and prepaid expenses;
● $3.0 million cash used as a result of a decrease in deferred revenue;
● $2.6 million cash used as a result of an increased accounts receivable;
● $2.1 million cash used due to increase other long-term assets;
● $0.8 million cash used as a result of a decrease in extended warranty liabilities; partially offset by
● $5.4 million cash generated as a result of a decrease in inventories; and
● $0.9 million cash generated as a result of increased accrued liabilities.
Net cash used in operating activities was $2.2 million during 2019, which was due primarily to:
● $12.3 million net loss adjusted for non-cash related items consisting primarily of stock-based compensation expense of $9.8 million, $2.9
million amortization of capitalized contract costs and $1.5 million depreciation and amortization expenses;
● $5.9 million cash used due to an increase in inventories;
● $3.4 million cash used to increase long term assets;
● $2.5 million cash used as a result of increased accounts receivables;
● $1.8 million cash used to increase other current assets and prepaid expenses;
● $1.4 million cash used for increased inventory purchases leading to an increase in accounts payable;
● $1.2 million cash used as a result of a decrease in extended warranty liabilities; partially offset by
● $7.2 million cash generated by an increase in accrued liabilities; and
● $1.7 million cash generated as a result of increased deferred revenue.
61
Table of Contents
Net cash provided by operating activities was $0.3 million during 2018, which was due primarily to:
● $30.8 million net loss as adjusted for non-cash related items consisting primarily of valuation allowance against certain U.S. differed tax assets of
● $17.4 million (excluding the $1.2 million tax effect of the ASC 606 Adoption), stock-based compensation expense of $7.2 million, $1.3 million
provision for accounts receivable credit losses and $3.0 million depreciation and amortization expenses;
● $4.3 million cash generated from an increase in accounts payable due primarily to increased inventory related purchases;
● $3.2 million cash generated due to an increase in extended warranty liabilities;
● $1.3 million cash generated as a result of increased deferred revenue;
● $0.8 million cash generated as a result of a decrease in inventories;
● $0.1 million cash generated due to a decrease in other long liabilities; partially offset by
● $3.8 million cash used to settle accrued liabilities;
● $2.8 million cash used to increase other long-term assets;
● $1.1 million cash used to increase other current assets and prepaid expenses; and
● $0.1 million cash used as a result of increased accounts receivables.
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
Net cash provided by investing activities was $6.4 million during 2020, which was attributable primarily to:
● $33.7 million in net proceeds from the maturities of marketable investments; partially offset by
● $26.1 million of cash used to purchase marketable investments; and
● $1.3 million of cash used to purchase property, equipment and software.
Net cash provided by investing activities was $1.1 million during 2019, which was attributable primarily to:
● $14.7 million in net proceeds from the sales and maturities of marketable investments; partially offset by
● $12.7 million of cash used to purchase marketable investments; and
● $1.0 million of cash used to purchase property, equipment and software.
Net cash provided by investing activities was $10.8 million during 2018, which was attributable primarily to:
● $23.1 million in net proceeds from the sales and maturities of marketable investments; partially offset by
● $10.9 million of cash used to purchase marketable investments; and
● $1.5 million of cash used to purchase property, equipment and software.
Cash Flows from Financing Activities
Net cash provided by financing activities was $31.3 million during 2020, which was primarily due to:
● $26.5 million proceeds from the issuance of common stock in connection with public offering, net of issuance costs;
● $7.2 million proceeds from the PPP loan;
● $1.6 million net proceeds from the issuance of common stock due to employee exercising their stock options and purchasing stock through the
Employee Stock Purchase Plan (“ESPP”) program; partially offset by
● $3.4 million of cash used for taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards; and
● $0.5 million of cash used to pay capital lease obligations.
Net cash provided by financing activities was $1.4 million during 2019, which was primarily due to:
● $2.9 million proceeds from the issuance of common stock due to employee exercising their stock options and purchasing stock through the ESPP
program; partially offset by
● $0.8 million of cash used for taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards; and
● $0.6 million of cash used to pay capital lease obligations.
Net cash provided by financing activities was $0.8 million during 2018, which was primarily due to:
● $4.4 million proceeds from the issuance of common stock due to employee exercising their stock options and purchasing stock through the ESPP
program; offset by
● $3.1 million of cash used for taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards; and
● $0.5 million of cash used to pay capital lease obligations.
Adequacy of Cash Resources to Meet Future Needs
The Company had cash and cash equivalents of $47.0 million as of December 31, 2020. For fiscal year 2020, the Company’s principal source of
liquidity is cash generated from proceeds received from its April 2020 offering, the PPP loan, maturity and sales of marketable investments and cash
generated from the issuance of common stock through exercise of stock options and the Company’s employee stock purchasing program. In addition, on
March 9, 2021, the Company issued and sold $125 million aggregate principal amount of 2.25% Convertible Senior Notes. The Company believes that
the existing cash resources are sufficient to meet the Company’s anticipated cash needs for working capital and capital expenditures for at least the next
several years, but there can be no assurances.
62
Table of Contents
Loan and Security Agreement
On July 9, 2020, the Company terminated its undrawn revolving line of credit with Wells Fargo and subsequently entered into a Loan and Security
Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank for a four-year secured revolving loan facility (“SVB Revolving Line of Credit”) in an aggregate principal amount
of up to $30.0 million. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit matures on July 9, 2024. As of December 31, 2020, there were no borrowings under the SVB
Revolving Line of Credit.
Covenants
On July 9, 2020, the Company terminated its undrawn revolving line of credit with Wells Fargo and subsequently entered into a Loan and Security
Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank. The agreement provides for a four-year secured revolving loan facility (“SVB Revolving Line of Credit”) in an
aggregate principal amount of up to $30.0 million. See "Part II, Item 8. Financial Statements, Note 12. Debt" in the accompanying Notes to consolidated
financial statements for more information.
The Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank contains customary affirmative covenants, such as financial statement reporting
requirements and delivery of borrowing base certificates, as well as customary covenants that restrict the Company’s ability to, among other things,
incur additional indebtedness, sell certain assets, guarantee obligations of third parties, declare dividends, or make certain distributions, and undergo a
merger or consolidation or certain other transactions. The Loan and Security Agreement also contains certain financial condition covenants, including
maintaining a quarterly minimum revenue of $90.0 million, determined in accordance with GAAP on a trailing twelve-month basis. This quarterly
minimum revenue requirement is subject to renegotiation at the beginning of each fiscal year.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had not drawn on the SVB Revolving Line of Credit and the Company is in compliance with all financial
covenants of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit.
Contractual Obligations
The following are the Company’s contractual obligations, consisting of future minimum lease commitments related to facility and vehicle leases as of
December 31, 2020:
Contractual Obligations
Operating leases
Finance leases
Total leases
Purchase Commitments
Total
21,448 $
635
22,083 $
$
$
Payments Due by Period ($’000’s)
Less Than
1 Year
1-3 Years
3-5 Years
More Than
5 Years
3,062 $
374
3,436 $
6,319 $
261
6,580 $
5,759 $
—
5,759 $
6,308
—
6,308
The Company maintains certain open inventory purchase commitments with its suppliers to ensure a smooth and continuous supply for key components.
The Company’s liability in these purchase commitments is generally restricted to an agreed-upon period. Such time periods can vary among different
suppliers. The Company’s open inventory purchase commitments were not material for the year ended December 31, 2020. The Company believes it has
adequate funds to fulfill any such commitments in the future using the sources discussed in this Item 7 – Management’s Discussion & Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations.
Other
In the normal course of business, the Company enters into agreements that contain a variety of representations, warranties, and indemnification
obligations. For example, the Company has entered into indemnification agreements with each of the Company’s directors and executive officers. The
Company’s exposure under the various indemnification obligations is unknown and not reasonably estimable as they involve future claims that may be
made against us. As such, the Company has not accrued any amounts for such obligations.
63
Table of Contents
ITEM 7A
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
Interest Rate and Market Risk
The primary objective of the Company’s investment activities is to preserve principal while at the same time maximizing the income the Company
receives from investments without significantly increasing risk. To achieve this objective, the Company maintains its portfolio of cash equivalents and
short- and long-term investments in a variety of high-quality securities, including U.S. treasuries, U.S. government agencies, corporate debt, cash
deposits, money market funds, commercial paper, non-U.S. government agency securities, and municipal bonds. The securities are classified as
available-for-sale and consequently are recorded at fair value with unrealized gains or losses reported as a separate component of accumulated other
comprehensive loss. The Company had no marketable securities as of December 31, 2020.
On July 27, 2017, the United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority announced that it intends to stop persuading or compelling banks to submit
LIBOR rates after 2021. These reforms may cause LIBOR to cease to exist, new methods of calculating LIBOR to be established or the establishment of
an alternative reference rate(s). While the Company expects that reasonable alternatives to LIBOR will be implemented prior to the 2021 target date or
that the 2021 cessation date may be extended, the Company cannot predict the consequences and timing of these developments, and could have an
adverse impact on the market value for or value of LIBOR-linked securities, loans, and other financial obligations or extensions of credit held by the
Company. The changes may influence returns on financial investments and could reduce the Company’s earnings and cash flows.
The uncertain financial markets could result in a tightening in the credit markets, a reduced level of liquidity in many financial markets, and extreme
volatility in fixed income and credit markets. The credit ratings of the securities the Company has invested in could further deteriorate and may have an
adverse impact on the carrying value of these investments.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had not drawn on the SVB Revolving Line of Credit. Overall interest rate sensitivity is primarily influenced by
any amount borrowed on the line of credit and the prevailing interest rate on the line of credit facility. The effective interest rate on the line of credit
facility is based on a floating per annum rate equal to the greater of either 1.75% above the Prime Rate or 5%. The Prime Rate was 3.25% as of
December 31, 2020, and accordingly the Company may incur additional expenses if the Company has an outstanding balance on the line of credit and
the Prime Rate increases in future periods.
Inflation
The Company does not believe that inflation has had a material effect on the Company’s business, financial condition, or results of operations. If the
Company’s costs were to become subject to significant inflationary pressures, the Company may not be able to fully offset such higher costs through
price increases. The Company’s inability or failure to do so could harm the Company’s business, financial condition, and results of operations.
Foreign Exchange Fluctuations
The Company generates revenue in Japanese Yen, Euros, Australian Dollars, Canadian Dollars, British Pounds and Swiss Francs. Additionally, a portion
of the Company’s operating expenses and assets and liabilities are denominated in each of these currencies. Therefore, fluctuations in these currencies
against the U.S. dollar could materially and adversely affect the Company’s results of operations upon translation of the Company’s revenue
denominated in these currencies, as well as the re-measurement of the Company’s international subsidiaries’ financial statements into U.S. dollars. The
Company has historically not engaged in hedging activities relating to the Company’s foreign currency denominated transactions.
64
Table of Contents
ITEM 8.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
CUTERA, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY COMPANIES
ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The following Consolidated Financial Statements of the Registrant and its subsidiaries are required to be included in Item 8:
Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
Consolidated Balance Sheets
Consolidated Statements of Operations
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Loss
Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Schedule II -Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
Page
66
68
69
70
71
72
73
98
All other required schedules are omitted because of the absence of conditions under which they are required or because the required information is
given in the Consolidated Financial Statements or the Notes thereto.
65
Table of Contents
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
Stockholders and Board of Directors
Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California
Opinion on the Consolidated Financial Statements
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Cutera, Inc. (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related
consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive loss, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December
31, 2020, and the related notes and schedule (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). In our opinion, the consolidated
financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company at December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the results of its
operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, in conformity with accounting principles generally
accepted in the United States of America.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the Company's
internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued
by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) and our report dated March 23, 2021 expressed an unqualified
opinion thereon.
Change in Accounting Principle
As discussed in Notes 1 and 11 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company has changed its accounting method for accounting for leases in
fiscal year 2019 due to the adoption of Topic 842: Leases using a modified retrospective approach.
Basis for Opinion
These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the
Company’s consolidated financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting
Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal
securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud.
Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or
fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and
disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis
for our opinion.
Critical Audit Matter
The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current period audit of the consolidated financial statements that was
communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that: (1) relates to accounts or disclosures that are material to the consolidated
financial statements and (2) involved especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of a critical audit matter does not
alter in any way our opinion on the consolidated financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below,
providing a separate opinion on the critical audit matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.
The Company recognized total net revenue of approximately $147.7 million for the year ending December 31, 2020. As described in Note 1 to the
consolidated financial statements, the Company recognizes revenue in a manner that best depicts the transfer of control of promised products or services
to the customer, in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the Company expects to be entitled. The Company’s contracts with customers may
include, individually, or in combination, systems, extended service contracts, training, marketing support services and accessories. Certain of the
Company’s contracts, which include some with international distributors, can include non-standard payment and other sales terms that can impact
management’s conclusions as to whether it is probable at contract inception that the Company will collect substantially all of the consideration to which it
will be entitled or whether control has transferred to the customer. Management applies significant effort and judgment in evaluating the impact of these
non-standard payment and sales terms on revenue recognition.
We identified the evaluation of non-standard payment and other sales terms in the Company’s contracts with international distributors as a critical audit
matter. Auditing the impact of non-standard payment and other sales terms on management’s conclusions of whether the transfer of control has occurred
requires significant auditor effort and increased auditor judgment in performing procedures to evaluate management’s judgement.
The primary procedures we performed to address this critical audit matter included:
● Examining certain international distributor contracts, including any amendments or modifications, for non-standard payment terms and,
where such terms are present, evaluating management’s assessment of whether collection is probable, based on a consideration of indicators
of the international distributor’s liquidity and of the collection and credit memo history with the international distributor and with
similar international distributors with similar payment terms.
● Examining certain international distributor contracts, including any amendments or modifications, for non-standard terms governing transfer
of control and, where such terms are present, evaluating management’s conclusions regarding the transfer of control based on an assessment
of considerations including whether the international distributor has physical possession and legal title to the product, whether the Company
has a present right to payment, and other factors relevant to the determination of whether the international distributor has the ability to direct
the use of and obtain substantially all of the remaining benefit from the product.
/s/ BDO USA, LLP
We have served as the Company's auditor since 2014.
San Francisco, California
March 23, 2021
66
Table of Contents
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
Stockholders and Board of Directors
Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California
Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
We have audited Cutera, Inc.’s (the “Company’s”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, based on criteria established in
Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the “COSO
criteria”). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020,
based on the COSO criteria.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the
consolidated balance sheets of the Company as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive loss,
stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, and the related notes and schedule and our report
dated March 23, 2021 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.
Basis for Opinion
The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness
of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Item 9A, Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting.
Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm
registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with U.S. federal securities laws and the
applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan
and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material
respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and
testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other
procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting
and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal
control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately
and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as
necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of
the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance
regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the
financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation
of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
/s/ BDO USA, LLP
San Francisco, California
March 23, 2021
67
Table of Contents
CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
(in thousands, except share and per share data)
Assets
Current assets:
Cash and cash equivalents
Marketable investments
Accounts receivable, net of allowance for credit losses of $1,598 and $1,354, respectively
Inventories
Other current assets and prepaid expenses
Total current assets
Property and equipment, net
Deferred tax assets
Operating lease right-of-use assets
Goodwill
Other long-term assets
Total assets
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
Current liabilities:
Accounts payable
Accrued liabilities
Operating lease liabilities
PPP Loan Payable
Extended warranty liabilities
Deferred revenue
Total current liabilities
Deferred revenue, net of current portion
Income tax liability
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion
PPP Loan payable, net of current portion
Other long-term liabilities
Total liabilities
Commitments and contingencies (Note 11)
Stockholders’ equity:
Common stock, $0.001 par value: Authorized: 50,000,000 shares; Issued and outstanding: 17,679,232 and
14,315,586 shares at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively
Additional paid-in capital
Accumulated deficit
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
Total stockholders’ equity
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
December 31,
2020
2019
47,047 $
—
21,962
28,508
8,779
106,296
2,299
643
17,076
1,339
5,080
132,733 $
6,684 $
31,079
2,260
3,630
1,216
9,489
54,358
1,748
—
15,950
3,555
242
75,853
18
117,097
(60,235)
—
56,880
132,733 $
26,316
7,605
21,556
33,921
5,648
95,046
2,817
423
7,702
1,339
6,411
113,738
12,685
30,307
2,800
—
1,999
10,831
58,622
3,391
93
5,112
—
578
67,796
14
82,346
(36,358)
(60)
45,942
113,738
$
$
$
$
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
68
Table of Contents
Net revenue:
Products
Service
Total net revenue
Cost of revenue:
Products
Service
Total cost of revenue
Gross profit
Operating expenses:
Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative
Total operating expenses
Loss from operations
Interest and other expense, net
Loss before income taxes
Income tax provision
Net loss
Net loss per share:
Basic and diluted
CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(in thousands, except per share data)
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
125,113 $
22,570
147,683
58,325
13,586
71,911
75,772
52,766
14,322
31,512
98,600
(22,828)
(579)
(23,407)
470
(23,877) $
158,638 $
23,074
181,712
64,693
18,856
83,549
98,163
71,109
15,085
24,033
110,227
(12,064)
(199)
(12,263)
85
(12,348) $
142,535
20,185
162,720
66,843
15,495
82,338
80,382
58,420
14,359
20,995
93,774
(13,392)
(123)
(13,515)
17,255
(30,770)
(1.43) $
(0.88) $
(2.23)
16,691
14,096
13,771
$
$
$
Weighted-average number of shares used in per share calculations:
Basic and diluted
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
69
Table of Contents
Net loss
Other comprehensive income (loss):
Available-for-sale investments
CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE LOSS
(in thousands)
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
$
(23,877) $
(12,348) $
(30,770)
Net change in unrealized gain (loss) on available-for-sale investments
Less: Reclassification adjustment for net losses on investments recognized
during the year
Total change in unrealized gain (loss) on available-for-sale investments
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
Comprehensive loss
(3)
9
63
60
60
(23,817) $
—
9
9
(12,339) $
14
9
23
23
(30,747)
$
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
70
Table of Contents
CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
(in thousands, except share amounts)
Balance at December 31, 2017
Adjustment to opening balance for ASC 606
adoption
Issuance of common stock for employee
purchase plan
Exercise of stock options
Issuance of common stock in settlement of
restricted and performance stock units, net
of shares withheld for employee taxes, and
stock awards
Stock-based compensation expense
Net loss
Net change in unrealized gain on available-
for-sale investments
Balance at December 31, 2018
Issuance of common stock for employee
purchase plan
Exercise of stock options
Issuance of common stock in settlement of
restricted and performance stock units, net
of shares withheld for employee taxes, and
stock awards
Stock-based compensation expense
Net loss
Net change in unrealized gain on available-
for-sale investments
Balance at December 31, 2019
Issuance of common stock for employee
purchase plan
Exercise of stock options
Issuance of common stock in connection with
public offering, net of issuance costs of
$2,303
Issuance of common stock in settlement of
restricted and performance stock units, net
of shares withheld for employee taxes, and
stock awards
Stock-based compensation expense
Net loss
Net change in unrealized gain on available-
for-sale investments
Balance at December 31, 2020
Common Stock
Shares
Amount
Additional
Paid-in
Capital
Retained
Earnings
(Accumulated
Deficit)
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (loss)
Total
Stockholders’
Equity
13,477,973 $
13 $
62,025 $
2,947 $
(92) $
64,893
-
64,511
271,902
154,466
-
-
-
13,968,852 $
-
1
-
-
-
-
-
14 $
-
3,813
1,680
2,718
-
-
(3,129)
7,157
-
-
-
(30,770)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
70,451 $
-
(24,010) $
23
(69) $
82,810
160,798
-
-
1,281
1,613
-
-
103,126
-
-
-
14,315,586 $
56,751
73,227
-
-
-
-
14 $
-
(831)
9,832
-
-
-
(12,348)
-
82,346 $
-
(36,358) $
632
947
-
-
2,742,750
3
26,492
490,918
-
-
1
-
-
(3,429)
10,109
-
-
-
(23,877)
-
17,679,232 $
-
18 $
-
117,097 $
-
(60,235) $
-
-
-
-
-
9
(60) $
-
-
-
-
-
60
- $
3,813
1,681
2,718
(3,129)
7,157
(30,770)
23
46,386
1,281
1,613
(831)
9,832
(12,348)
9
45,942
632
947
26,495
(3,428)
10,109
(23,877)
60
56, 880
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
71
Table of Contents
CUTERA, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(in thousands)
Cash flows from operating activities:
Net loss
Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by (used in) operating
activities:
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
$
(23,877) $
(12,348) $
(30,770)
Stock-based compensation
Depreciation and amortization
Amortization of contract acquisition costs
Impairment of capitalized cloud computing costs
Change in deferred tax assets
Provision for credit losses
Change in right-of-use asset
Other
Changes in assets and liabilities:
Accounts receivable
Inventories
Other current assets and prepaid expenses
Other long-term assets
Accounts payable
Accrued liabilities
Extended warranty liabilities
Other long-term liabilities
Operating lease liabilities
Deferred revenue
Income tax liability
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
Cash flows from investing activities:
Acquisition of property and equipment
Disposal of property and equipment
Proceeds from sales of marketable investments
Proceeds from maturities of marketable investments
Purchase of marketable investments
Net cash provided by investing activities
Cash flows from financing activities:
Proceeds from exercise of stock options and employee stock purchase plan
Proceeds from long-term debt
Gross proceeds from issuance of common stock in connection with public
offering
Issuance costs on the public offering
Taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards
Payments on capital lease obligation
Net cash provided by financing activities
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
Supplemental cash flow information:
Cash paid for interest
Cash paid (refunded) for income taxes, net of (refunds) payments
Supplemental non-cash investing and financing activities:
Assets acquired under finance lease
Assets acquired under operating lease
$
$
$
$
$
10,109
1,394
2,593
805
(220)
2,144
2,522
513
(2,550)
5,413
(3,164)
(2,067)
(6,034)
944
(783)
—
(1,598)
(2,985)
(93)
(16,934)
(1,279)
30
5,648
28,050
(26,060)
6,389
1,579
7,167
28,798
(2,303)
(3,428)
(537)
31,276
20,731
26,316
47,047 $
63 $
(1) $
43 $
11,735 $
9,832
1,548
2,915
—
34
590
2,502
(83)
(2,509)
(5,907)
(1,762)
(3,355)
1,406
7,157
(1,160)
(140)
(2,292)
1,656
(301)
(2,217)
(991)
45
—
14,700
(12,687)
1,067
2,894
—
—
—
(831)
(649)
1,414
264
26,052
26,316 $
81 $
59 $
738 $
— $
7,157
1,209
1,834
—
17,438
1,257
—
241
(117)
768
(1,070)
(2,754)
4,277
(3,781)
3,159
140
1,305
15
308
(1,488)
41
13,044
10,050
(10,874)
10,773
4,399
—
—
—
(3,129)
(483)
787
11,868
14,184
26,052
85
472
610
—
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
72
Table of Contents
CUTERA, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTE 1—SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Description of Operations and Principles of Consolidation
Cutera, Inc. (“Cutera” or the “Company”) provides energy-based aesthetic systems for practitioners worldwide. The Company develops, manufactures,
distributes, and markets energy-based product platforms for use by physicians and other qualified practitioners, enabling them to offer safe and effective
aesthetic treatments to their customers. The Company currently markets the following system platforms: enlighten, excel, Secret PRO, Juliet, Secret RF,
truSculpt and xeo. Several of the Company’s systems offer multiple hand pieces and applications, providing customers the flexibility to upgrade their
systems. The sales of (i) systems, system upgrades, and hand pieces (collectively “Systems” revenue); (ii) replacement hand pieces, Titan, truSculpt
3D,truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex cycle refills, as well as single use disposable tips applicable to Secret PRO, Juliet and Secret RF (“Consumables”
revenue); (iii) the distribution of third party manufactured skincare products (“Skincare” revenue); and (iv) the leasing of equipment through a
membership program; are collectively classified as “Products” revenue. In addition to Products revenue, the Company generates revenue from the sale of
post-warranty service contracts, parts, detachable hand piece replacements (except for Titan, truSculpt 3D, truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex and service
labor for the repair and maintenance of products that are out of warranty, all of which are collectively classified as “Service” revenue.
The Company’s corporate headquarters and U.S. operations are located in Brisbane, California, where the Company conducts manufacturing,
warehousing, research and development, regulatory, sales and marketing, service, and administrative activities. The Company also maintains regional
distribution centers (“RDCs”) in selection locations across the U.S. These RDCs serve as forward warehousing for systems and service parts in various
geographies. The Company markets sells and services the Company’s products through direct sales and service employees in North America (including
Canada), Australia, Austria, Belgium, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, Spain, Switzerland, and the United Kingdom. Sales and services outside of
these direct markets are made through a worldwide distributor network in over 42 countries. The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of
the Company and its subsidiaries. All inter-company transactions and balances have been eliminated.
Use of Estimates
The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires the Company’s management to make estimates and assumptions
that affect the amounts reported of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial
statements and the accompanying notes, and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reported periods. Actual results could differ
materially from those estimates.
On an ongoing basis, management evaluates its estimates, including those related to warranty obligations, sales commission, allowance for credit losses,
sales allowances, valuation of inventories, fair value of goodwill, useful lives of property and equipment, impairment testing for long-lived-assets,
implicit and incremental borrowing rates related to the Company’s leases, assumptions regarding variables used in calculating the fair value of the
Company's equity awards, expected achievement of performance based vesting criteria, management performance bonuses, assumptions used in operating
and sales-type lease classification, the standalone selling price of the Company's products and services, the period of benefit used to capitalize and
amortize contract acquisition costs, variable consideration, contingent liabilities, recoverability of deferred tax assets, residual value of leased equipment,
lease term and effective income tax rates. Management bases estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that are believed to be
reasonable, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities.
Risks and Uncertainties
The Company's future results of operations involve a number of risks and uncertainties. Factors that could affect the Company's future operating results
and cause actual results to vary materially from expectations include, but are not limited to, rapid technological change, continued acceptance of the
Company's products, stability of global financial markets, cybersecurity breaches and other disruptions that could compromise the Company’s
information or results, business disruptions that are caused by natural disasters or pandemic events, management of international activities, competition
from substitute products and larger companies, ability to obtain and maintain regulatory approvals, government regulations and oversight, patent and other
types of litigation, ability to protect proprietary technology from counterfeit versions of the Company's products, strategic relationships and dependence
on key individuals.
In March 2020, the World Health Organization declared the COVID-19 outbreak a pandemic. The COVID-19 outbreak has negatively affected the United
States and global economies. The spread of the coronavirus, which caused a broad impact in 2020 globally, including restrictions on travel, shifting work
force to work remotely and quarantine policies put into place by businesses and governments, had a material economic effect on the Company’s business
during the year ended December 31, 2020. Notably, healthcare facilities in many countries effectively banned elective procedures. Many of the
Company’s products are used in aesthetic elective procedures and as such, the bans on elective procedures substantially reduced the Company’s sales and
marketing efforts in the early months of the pandemic and led the Company to implement cost control measures. While the Company hopes that the
customers will return and the amount of revenue will increase in 2021 as the economic environment outlook due to the COVID-19 pandemic improves,
the COVID-19 outbreak continues to be fluid and the aftermath of the business and economic disruptions due to the COVID-19 is still uncertain, making
it difficult to forecast the final impact it could have on the Company’s future operations, including disruptions in the Company's supply chain and contract
manufacturing operations. The Company cannot presently predict the scope and severity of any impacts in future periods from the business shutdowns or
disruptions due to the COVID-19 pandemic, but the impact on economic activity such as the possibility of recession or financial market instability could
have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, revenue, operating results, cash flows and financial condition. As a result of the events and
impact surrounding the COVID-19 pandemic, the Company assessed whether any impairment of its goodwill or its long-lived assets had occurred, and
has determined that no charges other than an impairment loss of $0.8 million on capitalized cloud computing costs related to the indefinite delay of the
implementation of cloud-based enterprise resource planning software had occurred during 2020. The Company’s assumptions about future conditions
important to its assessment of potential impairment of its long-lived assets, and goodwill, including the impacts of the COVID–19 pandemic and other
ongoing impacts to its business, are subject to uncertainty, and the Company will continue to monitor these conditions in future periods as new
information becomes available, and will update its analyses accordingly.
Comparability
The Company adopted the new lease standard effective January 1, 2019, using the modified retrospective method. Prior period financial statements
were not retrospectively restated. The financial results for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 were prepared using the new lease accounting
standard whereas the financial results for the year ended December 31, 2018 were prepared using prior effective guidance. As a result, the consolidated
statement of operations for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 is not directly comparable to the consolidated statements of operations for the
year ended December 31, 2018.
73
Table of Contents
Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements
In June 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments-
Credit Losses (Topic 326):"Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments", which replaces the incurred loss methodology with an expected
credit loss methodology that is referred to as the current expected credit loss (CECL) methodology. ASU 2016-13 is effective for fiscal years beginning
after December 15, 2019, with early adoption permitted. The amendments in this update are required to be applied using the modified retrospective
method with an adjustment to accumulated deficit and are effective for the Company beginning with fiscal year 2020, including interim periods. The
measurement of expected credit losses under the CECL methodology is applicable to financial assets measured at amortized cost, including loan
receivables, available for sale securities and held-to-maturity debt securities. An entity with available for sale securities and trade receivables will be
required to use historical loss information, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts to determine expected lifetime credit losses.
Pooling of assets with similar risk characteristics is also required. The Company adopted ASU 2016-13 on January 1, 2020 on a modified retrospective
basis. Upon adoption, the standard did not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.
The Company identified trade receivables and available-for-sale debt securities as impacted by the new guidance. However, the Company determined
that the historical losses related to these available-for-sale debt securities are not material as the Company invests in high grade short-term securities.
The Company establishes an allowance for credit losses on trade receivables based on the credit quality of clients, current economic conditions, the age
of the accounts receivable balances, historical loss information, and current conditions and forecasted information, and write-off amounts against the
allowance when they are deemed uncollectible.
The Company’s allowance for credit losses increased from $1.4 million at January 1, 2020 to $1.6 million at December 31, 2020, due to increase in
aged accounts receivable. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized a provision for credit losses of $2.1 million and wrote
off $1.2 million against the allowance for credit losses.
In August 2018, the FASB issued ASU No. 2018-13, “Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820): Disclosure Framework- Changes to the Disclosure
Requirements for Fair Value Measurement”, to improve the fair value measurement reporting of financial instruments. The amendments in this update
require, among other things, added disclosure of the range and weighted average of significant unobservable inputs used to develop Level 3 fair value
measurements. The amendments in this update eliminate, among other things, disclosure of the reasons for and amounts of transfers between Level 1
and Level 2 for assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis and an entity's valuation processes for Level 3 fair value
measurements. The amendments in this update are effective for the Company beginning with fiscal year 2020, with early adoption permitted.
Retrospective application is required for all amendments in this update except the added disclosures, which should be applied prospectively. The
adoption of the amendments in this update did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.
Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements Not Yet Adopted by the Company
In December 2019, the FASB issued ASU No. 2019-12 “Income Taxes (Topic 740)-Simplifying the Accounting for Income Taxes”, to remove certain
exceptions and improve consistency of application, including, among other things, requiring that an entity reflect the effect of an enacted change in tax
laws or rates in the annual effective tax rate computation in the interim period that includes the enactment date. The amendments in this update will be
effective for the Company beginning with fiscal year 2021, with early adoption permitted. Most amendments within the standard are required to be
applied on a prospective basis, while certain amendments must be applied on a retrospective or modified retrospective basis. The adoption of the
amendments in this update is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.
In March 2020, the FASB issued ASU No. 2020-04, “Reference Rate Reform (Topic 848): Facilitation of the Effects of Reference Rate Reform on
Financial Reporting.” ASU No. 2020-04 provides optional expedients and exceptions for applying U.S. GAAP to contract modifications and hedging
relationships, subject to meeting certain criteria that reference LIBOR or another rate that is expected to be discontinued. The amendments in ASU No.
2020-04 are effective for all entities as of March 12, 2020 through December 31, 2022. The Company is currently assessing the impact of ASU No.
2020-04 and the LIBOR transition on its consolidated financial statements.
In August 2020, the FASB issued ASU No. 2020-06, "Debt – Debt with Conversion and Other Options (Topic 470) and Derivatives and Hedging –
Contracts in Entity’s Own Equity (Topic 815)." This amendment simplifies the accounting for convertible debt instruments by removing the beneficial
conversion and cash conversion separation models for convertible instruments. Under the amendment, the embedded conversion features are no longer
separated from the host contract for convertible instruments with conversion features that are not required to be accounted for as derivatives or that do
not result in substantial premiums accounted for as paid-in capital. The update also amends the accounting for certain contracts in an entity’s own equity
that are currently accounted for as derivatives because of specific settlement provisions. In addition, the new guidance modifies how particular
convertible instruments and certain contracts that may be settled in cash or shares impact the computation of diluted earnings per share. The
amendments in this update are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2021, including interim periods within those fiscal years. Early
adoption is permitted, but no earlier than fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2020. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of this
guidance on its consolidated financial statements.
The Company reviewed all other recently issued, but not yet effective, accounting pronouncements and does not expect the future adoption of any such
pronouncements will have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
74
Table of Contents
Revenue recognition
Revenue is recognized upon transfer of control of promised products or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the
Company expects to be entitled in exchange for promised goods or services. The Company’s performance obligations are satisfied either over time or at
a point in time. Revenue from performance obligations that are transferred to customers over time accounted for approximately 15%, 13% and
12%, respectively, of the Company’s total revenue for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.
The Company has certain system sale arrangements that contain multiple products and services. For these bundled sale arrangements, the Company
accounts for individual products and services as separate performance obligations if they are distinct. The Company’s products and services are distinct
if a customer can benefit from the product or service on its own or with other resources that are readily available to the customer, and if the Company’s
promise to transfer the products or service to the customer is separately identifiable from other promises in the sale arrangements. The Company’s
system sale arrangements can include all or a combination of the following performance obligations: the system and software license (considered as one
performance obligation), system accessories (hand pieces), training, other accessories, extended service contracts, marketing services, and time and
materials services.
For the Company’s system sale arrangements that include an extended service contract, the period of service commences at the expiration of the
Company’s standard warranty offered at the time of the system sale. The Company considers the extended service contracts terms in the arrangements
that are legally enforceable to be performance obligations. Other than extended service contracts and marketing services, which are satisfied over time,
the Company generally satisfies all performance obligations at a point in time. Systems, system accessories (hand pieces), service contracts, training,
and time and materials services are also sold on a stand-alone basis, and these performance obligations are satisfied at a point in time. For contracts with
multiple performance obligations, the Company allocates the transaction price of the contract to each performance obligation on a relative standalone
selling price basis.
Nature of Products and Services
Systems
Systems revenue is generated from the sale of systems and from the sale of upgrades to existing systems. A system consists of a console that incorporates
a universal graphic user interface, a laser or other energy-based module, control system software and high voltage electronics, as well as one or more hand
pieces. In certain applications, the laser or other energy-based module is contained in the hand piece, such as with the Company’s Pearl and Pearl
Fractional applications, rather than within the console.
The Company offers customers the ability to select the system that best fits their practice at the time of purchase and then to cost-effectively add
applications to their system as their practice grows. This provides customers the flexibility to upgrade their systems whenever they choose and provides
the Company with a source of additional Systems revenue.
The system or upgrade and the right to use the embedded software represent a single performance obligation as the software license is integral to the
functionality of the system or upgrade.
For systems sold directly to end-customers that are credit approved, revenue is recognized when the Company transfers control to the end-customer,
which occurs when the product is shipped to the customer or when the customer receives the product, depending on the nature of the arrangement. When
collectability is not established in advance of receipt of payment from the customer, revenue is recognized upon the later of the receipt of payment or the
satisfaction of the performance obligation. For systems sold through credit approved distributors, revenue is recognized at the time of shipment to the
distributor.
The Company typically receives payment for its system consoles and other accessories within 30 days of shipment. Certain international distributor
arrangements allow for longer payment terms.
Skincare products
The Company sells third-party manufactured skincare products in Japan. The skincare products are purchased from a third-party manufacturer and sold to
medical offices and licensed physicians. The Company warrants that the skincare products are free of significant defects in workmanship and materials for
90 days from shipment. These are typically sold in a separate contract as the only performance obligations. The Company acts as the principal in this
arrangement, as the Company determines the price to charge customers for the skincare products and controls the products before they are transferred to
the customer. The Company recognizes revenue for skincare products at a point in time upon shipment.
Consumables and other accessories
The Company classifies its customers' purchases of replacement cycles for truSculpt iD and truSculpt flex, as well as replacement hand pieces, Titan and
truSculpt 3D hand pieces, and single use disposable tips applicable to Secret PRO, Juliet, and Secret RF, as Consumable revenue, which provides the
Company with a source of recurring revenue from existing customers. The Juliet and Secret RF products’ single use disposable tips must be replaced after
every treatment. Sales of these consumable tips further enhance the Company’s recurring revenue. The Company’s systems offer multiple hand pieces and
applications, which allow customers to upgrade their systems.
Equipment leasing
The Company leases equipment to customers through membership programs and receives a fixed monthly fee over the term of the arrangement. The
Company classifies its lease income as product revenue. The Company recognizes lease income over the term of the lease if the lease is classified as an
operating lease. For agreements that grant customers the right to purchase the leased system, the Company typically classifies the lease as a sales-type
lease as the Company has determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option. On the commencement of sales-type
leases, the Company recognizes revenue upfront in product revenue and the corresponding receivables recorded in Other current assets and prepaid
expenses on the consolidated balance sheets (Notes 1 and 11). Revenue from equipment leases was not material in the year ended December 31, 2020.
75
Table of Contents
Extended contract services
The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers through extended service contracts that cover parts and labor for a term of one, two, or three
years. Service contract revenue is recognized over time, using a time-based measure of progress, as customers benefit from the service throughout the
service period. The Company also offers services on a time-and-materials basis for systems and detachable hand piece replacements. Revenue related to
services performed on a time-and-materials basis is recognized when performed. These post-warranty services serve as additional sources of recurring
revenue from the Company’s installed product base.
Training
Sales of systems to customers include training on the use of the system to be provided within 180 days of purchase. The Company considers training a
separate performance obligation as customers can immediately benefit from the training together with the customer’s system. Training is also sold
separately from systems. The Company recognizes revenue for training when the training is provided. Training is not required for customers to use the
systems.
Customer Marketing Support
In North America, the Company offers marketing and consulting phone support to its customers across all system platforms. These customer marketing
support services include a practice development model and marketing training, performed remotely with ongoing phone consultations for six months from
date of purchase. The Company considers customer marketing support a separate performance obligation and recognizes revenue over the six-month term
of the contracts.
The Company classifies as product revenue the sales of systems, system upgrades, hand pieces, hand piece refills (applicable to Titan® and truSculpt) and
the distribution of third-party manufactured skincare products.
Significant Judgments
The determination of whether two or more contracts entered into at or near the same time with the same customer should be combined and accounted for
as one contract may require the use of significant judgment. In making this determination, the Company considers whether the contracts are negotiated as
a package with a single commercial objective, have price interdependencies, or promise goods or services that represent a single performance obligation.
While the Company’s purchase agreements do not provide customers with a contractual right of return, the Company maintains a sales allowance to
account for potential returns or refunds as a reduction in transaction price at the time of sale.
The Company determines standalone selling price ("SSP") for each performance obligation as follows:
● Systems: The SSPs for systems are based on directly observable sales in similar circumstances to similar customers.
● Extended service contracts: SSP is based on observable price when sold on a standalone basis to similar customers.
Loyalty Program
The Company launched a customer loyalty program during the third quarter of 2018 for qualified customers located in the U.S. and Canada. Under the
loyalty program, customers accumulate points based on their purchasing levels which can be redeemed for such rewards as the right to attend the
Company’s advanced training event for truSculpt, or a ticket for the Company’s annual forum. A customer’s account must be in good standing to receive
the benefits of the rewards program. Rewards are earned on a quarterly basis and must be used in the following quarter. All unused rewards are forfeited.
The fair value of the reward earned by loyalty program members is included in accrued liabilities and recorded as a reduction. of net revenue at the time
the reward is earned. As of December 31, 2020, the accrual for the loyalty program included in accrued liabilities was $0.3 million.
Deferred Sales Commissions
Incremental costs of obtaining a contract, which consist primarily of commissions and related payroll taxes, are capitalized, and amortized on a straight-
line basis over the expected period of benefit, except for costs that are recognized when product is sold. The Company uses the portfolio method to
recognize the amortization expense related to these capitalized costs related to initial contracts and such expense is recognized over a period associated
with the revenue of the related portfolio, which is generally two to three years.
Total capitalized costs for the year ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 were $3.4 million and $4.6 million, respectively, and are included in
Other long-term assets in the Company’s consolidated balance sheet. Amortization expenses for these assets were $2.6 million, $2.9 million and $1.8
million, respectively, during the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 and were included in sales and marketing expense in the Company’s
consolidated statement of operations.
Cash Equivalents, and Marketable Investments
The Company invests its cash primarily in money market funds, U.S. Treasury bills and in highly liquid debt instruments of U.S. federal and municipal
governments and their agencies, commercial paper, and corporate debt securities. All highly liquid investments with stated maturities of three months or
less from date of purchase are classified as cash equivalents; all highly liquid investments with stated maturities of greater than three months are classified
as marketable investments. The majority of the Company’s cash and investments are held in U.S. banks and the Company's foreign subsidiaries maintain
a limited amount of cash in their local banks to cover short term operating expenses.
The Company determines the appropriate classification of its investments in marketable securities at the time of purchase and re-evaluates such
designation at each balance sheet date. The Company’s marketable securities are classified and accounted for as available-for-sale securities. Investments
with remaining maturities of more than one year are viewed by the Company as available to support current operations and are classified as current assets
under the caption marketable investments in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Investments in marketable securities are carried at fair value,
with the unrealized gains and losses reported as a component of stockholders’ equity. Any realized gains or losses on the sale of marketable securities are
determined on a specific identification method, and such gains and losses are reflected as a component of Interest and other income (expense), net.
76
Table of Contents
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
Fair value is an exit price representing the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in the principal or most
advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. The fair value hierarchy
contains three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value, in accordance with ASC 820, as follows:
● Level 1: inputs, which include quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;
● Level 2: inputs, which include observable inputs other than Level 1 inputs, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities, quoted prices for
identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data
for substantially the full term of the asset or liability. For available-for-sale securities, the Company reviews trading activity and pricing as of the
measurement date. When sufficient quoted pricing for identical securities is not available, the Company uses market pricing and other observable market
inputs for similar securities obtained from various third-party data providers. These inputs either represent quoted prices for similar assets in active
markets or have been derived from observable market data; and
● Level 3: inputs, which include unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant to the fair value of the
underlying asset or liability. Level 3 assets and liabilities include those whose fair value measurements are determined using pricing models, discounted
cash flow methodologies, or similar valuation techniques, as well as significant management judgment or estimation.
In determining fair value, the Company utilizes valuation techniques that maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable
inputs to the extent possible as well as considers counterparty credit risk in its assessment of fair value.
Impairment of Marketable Investments
After determining the fair value of available-for-sales debt instruments, gains or losses on these securities are recorded to other comprehensive income,
until either the security is sold, or the Company determines that the decline in value is other-than-temporary. The primary differentiating factors that the
Company considers in classifying impairments as either temporary or other-than-temporary impairments are the Company’s intent and ability to retain the
investment in the issuer for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in market value or the maturity of the investment, the length
of the time and the extent to which the market value of the investment has been less than cost and the financial condition and near-term prospects of the
issuer. The Company had no investments as of December 31, 2020. There were no other-than-temporary impairments in the years ended December 31,
2020, 2019 and 2018.
Allowance for Sales Returns and Credit Losses
The allowance for sales returns is based on the Company’s estimates of potential future product returns and other allowances related to current period
product revenue. The Company analyzes historical returns, current economic trends and changes in customer demand and acceptance of the Company's
products.
The allowance for credit losses on trade receivables is based on the credit quality of clients, current economic conditions, the age of the accounts
receivable balances, historical loss information, and current conditions and forecasted information. The Company writes off amounts against the
allowance when they are deemed uncollectible.
Concentration of Credit Risk and Other Risks and Uncertainties
The Company operates in markets that are highly competitive and rapidly changing. Significant technological changes, shifting customer needs, the
emergence of competitive products or services with new capabilities and other factors could negatively impact the Company’s operating results.
The Company is also subject to risks related to changes in the value of the Company’s significant balance of financial instruments. Financial instruments
that potentially subject the Company to concentrations of risk consist principally of cash, cash equivalents, marketable investments, and accounts
receivable. The Company’s cash and cash equivalents are primarily invested in deposits and money market accounts with three major financial institutions
in the U.S. In addition, the Company has operating cash balances in banks in each of the international locations in which it operates. Deposits in these
banks may exceed the federally insured limits or any other insurance provided on such deposits, if any. Management believes that these financial
institutions are financially sound and, accordingly, believes that minimal credit risk exists. To date, the Company has not experienced any losses on its
deposits of cash and cash equivalents.
The Company invests in debt instruments, including bonds of the U.S. Government, its agencies, and its municipalities. The Company has also invested in
other high grade investments such as commercial paper and corporate debt securities. The Company has established guidelines relative to credit ratings,
diversification and maturities that seek to maintain safety and liquidity. By policy, the Company restricts its exposure to any single issuer by imposing
concentration limits. To minimize the exposure due to adverse shifts in interest rates, the Company maintains investments at an average maturity of
generally less than twelve months.
Accounts receivable are recorded net of an allowance for credit losses and are typically unsecured and are derived from revenue earned from worldwide
customers. The Company controls credit risk through credit approvals, credit limits, and monitoring procedures. The Company performs credit
evaluations of its customers and maintains an allowance for potential credit losses. As of December 31, 2020, and 2019, no customer represented more
than 10% of the Company’s net accounts receivable. During the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019, and 2018, domestic revenue accounted for 41%,
58% and 62%, respectively, of total revenue, while international revenue accounted for 59%, 42% and 38%, respectively, of total revenue. No single
customer represented more than 10% of total revenue for any of the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.
Supplier concentration
The Company relies on third parties for the supply of components of its products, as well as third-party logistics providers. In instances where these
parties fail to perform their obligations, the Company may be unable to find alternative suppliers or satisfactorily deliver its products to its customers. The
Company relies on one supplier for its Secret and Secret PRO products and one supplier for its skincare products.
77
Table of Contents
Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value, cost being determined on a standard cost basis which approximates actual cost on a
first-in, first-out basis. Net realizable value is the estimated selling prices in the ordinary course of the Company’s business, less reasonably predictable
costs of completion, disposal, and transportation. The cost basis of the Company’s inventory is reduced for any products that are considered excessive or
obsolete based upon assumptions about future demand and market conditions.
The Company includes demonstration units within inventories. Demonstration units are carried at cost and amortized over an estimated economic life of
two years. Amortization expense related to demonstration units is recorded in products cost of revenue or in the respective operating expense line based
on which function and purpose for which the demonstration units are being used. Proceeds from the sale of demonstration units are recorded as revenue
and all costs incurred to refurbish the systems prior to sale are charged to product cost of revenue.
During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company wrote-off $0.8 million of inventory on hand related to its Juliet platform due to declining sales.
Sales related to Juliet have been declining due to the COVID-19 pandemic and the FDA letter issued on July 30, 2018 expressing concerns regarding
“vaginal rejuvenation” procedures using energy-based devices. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, demonstration inventories, net of accumulated
depreciation, included in finished goods inventory was $2.2 million and $4.1 million, respectively.
Property and Equipment
Property and equipment are stated at cost, net of accumulated depreciation. Depreciation expense recognized is on a straight-line basis over the estimated
useful lives of the assets, generally as follows:
Leasehold improvements
Equipment leasing
Office equipment and furniture
Machinery and equipment
Useful Lives
Lesser of useful life or term of lease
4.5
3
3
Upon sale or retirement of property and equipment, the costs and related accumulated depreciation and amortization are removed from the balance sheet
and the resulting gain or loss is reflected in operating expenses. Maintenance and repairs are charged to operations as incurred.
Depreciation expense related to property and equipment for 2020, 2019 and 2018, was $1.4 million, $1.5 million, and $1.2 million, respectively.
Amortization expense for vehicles leased under capital leases is included in depreciation expense. Amortization expense related to equipment leasing
accounted for as sales type is included in cost of revenue and was immaterial as of December 31, 2020.
Capitalized Cloud Computing Set-up Cost
The Company capitalizes certain set-up costs for the Company’s cloud computing arrangements. The capitalized implementation costs are then
amortized over the term of the cloud computing arrangement inclusive of expected contract renewals, which are generally three to five years. The
Company periodically assesses the capitalized asset for impairment and, when required, will record an associated impairment loss. During the year
ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized in general and administrative expense an impairment loss of $0.8 million for capitalized cloud
computing costs related to a cloud-based enterprise resource planning software.
Goodwill and Intangible Assets
Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortized but are tested for impairment at least annually during the fourth quarter of
the Company’s fiscal year, or if circumstances indicate their value may no longer be recoverable. Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price
over the fair value of net identifiable assets and liabilities.
The Company continues to operate in one segment, which is considered to be the sole reporting unit and, therefore, goodwill was tested for impairment
at the enterprise level. As of December 31, 2020, there has been no impairment of goodwill. All acquired intangible assets have been fully amortized as
of December 31, 2020.
Warranty Obligations
The Company offers post-warranty services to its customers through extended service contracts that cover replacement parts and labor for a term of
one, two, or three years. For sales to distributors, the Company generally provides a 14 to 16 month warranty for parts only, with labor being provided
to the end customer by the distributor.
The Company also offers services on a time-and-materials basis for detachable hand piece replacements, parts, and labor.
Leases
Effective January 1, 2019, the Company adopted ASC 842, which established a right-of-use ("ROU") model requiring lessees to record a right-of-use
asset ("ROU asset") and lease obligations on the balance sheet for all leases with terms longer than 12 months. The Company determines if an
arrangement is a lease at inception. Where an arrangement is a lease the Company determines if it is an operating lease or a finance lease. At lease
commencement, the Company records a lease liability and corresponding ROU asset. Lease liabilities represent the present value of the Company’s future
lease payments over the expected lease term which includes options to extend or terminate the lease when it is reasonably certain those options will be
exercised. The present value of the Company’s lease liability is determined using its incremental collateralized borrowing rate at lease inception. ROU
assets represent its right to control the use of the leased asset during the lease and are recognized in an amount equal to the lease liability for leases with
an initial term greater than 12 months. Over the lease term (operating leases only), the Company uses the effective interest rate method to account for the
lease liability as lease payments are made and the ROU asset is amortized to consolidated statement of operations in a manner that results in straight-line
expense recognition. The Company does not apply lease recognition requirements for short-term leases. Instead, the Company recognizes payments
related to these arrangements in the consolidated statement of operations as lease costs on a straight-line basis over the lease term.
78
Table of Contents
Accounting for Leases as a Lessor
During the second quarter of 2020, the Company began leasing equipment to customers through a membership program where the customer pays a fixed
monthly fee over the lease term. Along with the leased equipment, the membership program provides customers with a warranty service and a fixed
amount of consumables per month for the term of the lease. The Company has made an accounting policy election to account for qualifying lease
components and associated non-lease components as a single component; accordingly, a lease component and an associated warranty service non-lease
component are combined and accounted for as an operating lease. The consumables do not qualify for the practical expedient and are accounted for as a
separate non-lease component in accordance with Topic 606 on Revenue from Contracts with Customers. The Company allocates the membership
program contract consideration to each component proportionately on a relative standalone selling price basis.
The lease agreements are typically for three years; however, the customer has the ability to terminate the lease after twelve months with no penalty. As
such, the Company has determined the initial term of the lease to be twelve-months, after which the lease converts to a month-to-month lease for up to an
additional two years. Rental charges are a fixed monthly fee, paid at the beginning of each month, over the term of the lease. Except when modified to
include a purchase option as discussed below, all leases entered into under the membership program during the year were classified as operating leases.
The initial direct costs related to the Company’s operating leases for equipment rentals include the related commissions paid to employees upon the
origination of a lease agreement. These costs are included in Other current assets and prepaid expenses on the consolidated balance sheets and are
amortized over the lease term of twelve-months. The amount of initial direct costs and the related amortization recognized during the year ended
December 31, 2020 was immaterial.
During the fourth quarter of 2020, the Company modified certain membership agreements under the program to grant the lessee the exclusive right and
option to purchase the leased system from the Company, at any time during the period of 12 months from signing the amended agreement. The option will
expire if it remained unexercised by the customer within that time frame. Upon the expiration of the option, the agreement will revert back to the original
membership agreement, with no purchase option. For contracts signed under the amended membership agreement, and that met the Company’s credit
approval policy, the Company classified the lease agreements as sales-type leases due to the purchase option. Under the sales-type lease, both the
consumables and warranty services are accounted for as a separate non-lease component in accordance with Topic 606 on Revenue from Contracts with
Customers.
At the commencement of these sales-type leases, the Company recognizes revenue up-front, and amounts due from the customer under the lease contract
are recognized as lease receivables on the consolidated balance sheets. Interest income is recognized as net revenue over the term of the lease based on the
effective interest method. The Company has elected not to include sales and other taxes collected from the lessee as part of lease revenue.
For these sales-type leases, the Company derecognized the underlying assets under the lease and recorded the net investment in the lease. As the
Company determined at the commencement of the sales-type lease that it is reasonably certain the customer will exercise its purchase option, the
Company does not expect to derive any additional value from the underlying assets and thus recognizes no unguaranteed residual assets.
In determining the proper classification and treatment of the equipment leases, the Company used significant judgment in forming the following
assumptions and estimates: lease term, implicit rate, fair value of equipment at option exercise date, useful life, residual value of the leased equipment,
and the likelihood that lessees will exercise the purchase option.
See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements for more information regarding leasing arrangements.
Cost of Revenue
Cost of revenue consists primarily of material, finished and semi-finished products purchased from third-party manufacturers, labor, stock-based
compensation expenses, overhead involved in the Company's internal manufacturing processes, service contracts, technology license amortization and
royalties, costs associated with equipment leasing, costs associated with product warranties and any inventory write-downs.
The Company's system sales include a control console, universal graphic user interface, control system software, high voltage electronics and a
combination of applications (referred to as “hand pieces”). Hand pieces are programmed to have a limited number of uses to ensure the safety of the
device to patients. The Company sells refurbished hand pieces, or "refills," of its Titan and truSculpt 3D products and provides for the cost of
refurbishment of these hand pieces as part of cost of revenue. When customers purchase a replacement hand piece or are provided a replacement hand
piece under a warranty or service contract, the Company ships the customer a previously refurbished unit. Upon the receipt of the expended hand piece
from the customer, the Company capitalizes the expended hand piece as inventory at the estimated fair value. Cost of service revenue includes the costs
incurred to refurbish hand pieces.
Research and Development Expenditures
Research and development costs are expensed as incurred and include costs related to research, design, development, testing of products, salaries, benefits
and other headcount related costs, facilities, material, third party contractors, regulatory affairs, clinical and development costs.
Advertising Costs
Advertising costs are included as part of sales and marketing expense and are expensed as incurred. Advertising expenses for 2020, 2019 and 2018 were
$1.2 million, $2.8 million and $2.8 million, respectively.
79
Table of Contents
Stock-based Compensation
The Company accounts for share-based employee compensation plans using the fair value recognition and measurement provisions under U.S. GAAP.
The Company’s share-based compensation cost is measured at the grant date, based on the fair value of the award, and is recognized as expense on a
straight- line basis over the requisite service period.
Expected Term: The expected term represents the weighted-average period that the stock options are expected to be outstanding prior to being exercised.
The Company determines expected term based on historical exercise patterns and its expectation of the time it will take for employees to exercise options
still outstanding.
Expected Volatility: For the underlying stock price volatility of the Company’s stock, the Company estimates volatility solely based on the Company’s
historical volatility of its stock price.
Forfeitures: The amount of stock-based compensation recognized during a period is based on the value of the portion of the awards that are ultimately
expected to vest. Under ASC 718 (Stock Based Compensation), the Company has made an accounting policy to estimate forfeitures at the time awards are
granted and revises, if necessary, in subsequent periods if actual forfeitures differ from those estimates.
Risk-Free Interest Rate: The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant for the expected term of the stock
option.
c
The fair value of stock options ("options") on the grant date using the closing price of the Company's common shares on the grant date is estimated using
the Black-Scholes option-pricing model using the single-option approach. The Black-Scholes option pricing model requires the use of highly subjective
and complex assumptions, including the option's expected term and the price volatility of the underlying stock, to determine the fair value of award. The
Company recognizes the expense associated with options using a single award approach over the requisite service period. The Company accounts for all
stock options awarded to non-employees at the fair value of the award issued on the day of the grant.
The fair value of restricted stock units (“RSUs”) granted are measured on the grant date. The quantity of the RSUs units granted is calculated by dividing
a fixed award amount determined by the Board on the grant date by the average closing price of the Company’s common stock over the 50-day period
ending on the day of the grant.
The fair value of Performance Stock Units (“PSUs”) that have operational measurement goals are measured on the grant date using the closing price of
the Company’s common shares on the grant date. The quantity of the PSUs units granted is calculated by dividing a fixed award amount determined by
the Board on the grant date by the average closing price of the Company’s common stock over the 50-day period ending on the day of the grant.
See Note 6 - "Stockholders’ Equity, Stock Plans and Stock-Based Compensation Expense" for a detailed discussion of the Company’s stock plans and
share-based compensation expense.
Income Taxes
The Company is subject to income taxes in the United States and several foreign jurisdictions. Significant judgment is required in determining the
Company’s provision (benefit) for income taxes and income tax assets and liabilities, including evaluating uncertainties in the application of accounting
principles and complex tax laws.
The Company records a provision (benefit) for income taxes for the anticipated tax consequences of the reported results of operations using the asset and
liability method. Under this method, the Company recognizes deferred income tax assets and liabilities for the expected future tax consequences of
temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities, as well as for loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax
assets and liabilities are measured using the tax rates that are expected to apply to taxable income for the years in which those tax assets and liabilities are
expected to be realized or settled. The Company recognizes the deferred income tax effects of a change in tax rates in the period of enactment. The
Company records a valuation allowance to reduce the Company’s deferred tax assets to the net amount that the Company believes is more likely than not
to be realized.
The Company recognizes tax benefits from uncertain tax positions if the Company believes that it is more likely than not that the tax position will be
sustained upon examination by the taxing authorities based on the technical merits of the position. Although the Company believes it has adequately
reserved for the Company’s uncertain tax positions (including net interest and penalties), the Company can provide no assurance that the final tax
outcome of these matters will not be different. The Company makes adjustments to these reserves in accordance with income tax accounting guidance
when facts and circumstances change, such as the closing of a tax audit. To the extent that the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the
amounts recorded, such differences may impact the provision (benefit) for income taxes in the period in which such determination is made. The Company
records interest and penalties related to the Company’s uncertain tax positions in the Company’s provision (benefit) for income taxes.
The Company’s effective tax rates have differed from the statutory rate primarily due to changes in the valuation allowance, foreign operations, research
and development tax credits, state taxes, and certain benefits realized related to stock option activity. The Company’s current effective tax rate does not
assume U.S. taxes on undistributed profits of foreign subsidiaries. These earnings could become subject to incremental foreign withholding or U.S.
federal and state taxes, should they either be deemed or actually remitted to the U.S. The Company’s future effective tax rates could be adversely affected
by earnings being lower in countries where the Company has lower statutory rates and being higher in countries where the Company has higher statutory
rates, or by changes in tax laws, accounting principles, interpretations thereof, net operating loss carryback, research and development tax credits, and due
to changes in the valuation allowance of its U.S. deferred tax assets. In addition, the Company is subject to the examination of the Company’s income tax
returns by the Internal Revenue Service and other tax authorities. The Company regularly assesses the likelihood of adverse outcomes resulting from
these examinations to determine the adequacy of the Company’s provision for income taxes.
80
Table of Contents
Undistributed earnings of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries at December 31, 2020 are considered to be indefinitely reinvested and, accordingly, no
provision for state income taxes has been provided thereon. Due to the Transition Tax and Global Intangible Low-Tax Income (“GILTI”) regimes as
enacted by the 2017 Tax Act, those foreign earnings will not be subject to federal income taxes when actually distributed in the form of a dividend or
otherwise. The Company, however, could still be subject to state income taxes and withholding taxes payable to various foreign countries. The amounts of
taxes which the Company could be subject to are not material to the accompanying financial statements.
On March 27, 2020, the U.S. federal government enacted the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (“CARES Act”). The CARES Act
changed several of the existing U.S. corporate income tax laws by, among other things, increasing the amount of deductible interest, allowing companies
to carry back certain Net Operating Losses (“NOLs”) and increasing the amount of NOLs that corporations can use to offset income. The CARES Act did
not have a material impact on the Company's income tax provision, deferred tax assets and liabilities, and related taxes payable. The Company is currently
assessing the future implications of these provisions within the CARES Act on the Company's consolidated financial statements but does not expect the
impact to be material.
Computation of Net Income (Loss) per Share
Basic net income (loss) per share is computed by dividing net income (loss) by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding. Diluted net
income per share is computed by dividing net income by the weighted average number of common shares and the dilutive effect of potential future
issuances of common stock from outstanding stock options, RSUs, PSUs and employee stock purchase plan contributions for the period outstanding
determined by applying the treasury stock method. Also, the issuance of the Convertible Senior Notes on March 9, 2021 will have a dilutive effect on the
diluted net income per share. In accordance with ASC 718, the assumed proceeds under the treasury stock method include the average unrecognized
compensation expense of in-the-money stock options, RSUs and PSUs. This results in the assumed buyback of additional shares, thereby reducing the
dilutive impact of equity awards.
Diluted earnings per share is the same as basic earnings per share for the periods in which the Company had a net loss because the inclusion of
outstanding common stock equivalents would be anti-dilutive.
Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Comprehensive income (loss) includes all changes in stockholders’ equity except those resulting from investments or contributions by stockholders. For
the periods presented, the accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) consisted solely of the unrealized gains or losses on the Company's available
for- sale investments, net of tax.
Foreign Currency
The financial statements of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries are translated in accordance with ASC 830, Foreign Currency Matters. The U.S. Dollar is
the functional currency of the Company’s subsidiaries and the Company’s reporting currency. Monetary assets and liabilities are re-measured into U.S.
Dollars at the applicable period end exchange rate. Sales and operating expenses are re-measured at average exchange rates in effect during each period.
Gains or losses resulting from foreign currency transactions are included in net income (loss) and are insignificant for each of the three years ended
December 31, 2020. The effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents was insignificant for each of the three years ended December 31,
2020.
Segments
The Company operates in one segment and reports segment information in accordance with ASC 280, Segment Reporting. Management uses one
measurement of profitability and does not segregate its business for internal reporting. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, 98.0% and 89.3% of long-
lived assets were in the United States, respectively. Revenue is attributed to a geographic region based on the location of the end customer. See Note 10 –
"Segment Information and Revenue by Geography and Products" for details relating to revenue by geography.
NOTE 2-INVESTMENT SECURITIES
The following tables summarize cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities (in thousands):
Cash and cash equivalents:
Cash
Cash equivalents:
Money market funds
Total cash and cash equivalents
Marketable securities:
U.S. government notes
Commercial paper
Total marketable securities
December 31,
2020
2019
$
47,047 $
—
47,047
—
—
—
Total cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities
$
47,047 $
81
20,005
6,311
26,316
4,114
3,491
7,605
33,921
Table of Contents
The following tables summarize the components, and the unrealized gains and losses position, related to the Company’s cash, cash equivalents and
marketable investments as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands):
December 31, 2020
Cash and cash equivalents
Total cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities
December 31, 2019
Cash and cash equivalents
Marketable investments
U.S. government notes
Commercial paper
Total marketable securities
Total cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities
Amortized
Cost
$
$
47,047 $
47,047 $
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Market
Value
— $
— $
— $
47,047
— $
47,047
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Market
Value
$
26,316 $
— $
— $
26,316
4,114
3,491
7,605
33,921 $
$
—
—
—
— $
—
—
—
— $
4,114
3,491
7,605
33,921
As of December 31, 2019, there were no gross unrealized gains and losses. The Company had no marketable securities as of December 31, 2020.
Fair Value Measurements
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had no financial assets measured and recognized at fair value. As of December 31, 2019, financial assets
measured and recognized at fair value on a recurring basis and classified under the appropriate level of the fair value hierarchy as described above were as
follows (in thousands):
December 31, 2019
Cash equivalents:
Money market funds
Short term marketable investments:
Available-for-sale securities
Total assets at fair value
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
$
$
6,311 $
— $
4,114
10,425 $
3,491
3,491 $
— $
—
— $
6,311
7,605
13,916
Money market funds are highly liquid investments and are actively traded. The pricing information on these investment instruments is readily available
and can be independently validated as of the measurement date. This approach results in the classification of these securities as Level 1 of the fair value
hierarchy.
Corporate debt, U.S. government-backed securities and commercial paper are measured at fair value using Level 2 inputs. The Company reviews trading
activity and pricing for these investments as of each measurement date. When sufficient quoted pricing for identical securities is not available, the
Company uses market pricing and other observable market inputs for similar securities obtained from various third-party data providers. These inputs
represent quoted prices for similar assets in active markets or these inputs have been derived from observable market data. This approach results in the
classification of these securities as Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. The Company had no Level 1 or Level 2 investments as of December 31, 2020. The
Company recognizes transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy as of the end of the reporting period.
NOTE 3—BALANCE SHEET DETAIL
Inventories
Valuation adjustments for excess and obsolete inventory, reflected as a reduction of inventory at December 31, 2020 and 2019, were $3.9 million and $2.5
million, respectively. Inventories, net of these adjustments, consist of the following (in thousands):
Raw materials
Work in process
Finished goods
Total
December 31,
2020
2019
$
$
14,874 $
1,030
12,604
28,508 $
17,935
2,016
13,970
33,921
82
Table of Contents
Property and Equipment, net
Property and equipment, net, consists of the following (in thousands):
Leasehold improvements
Equipment leasing
Office equipment and furniture
Machinery and equipment
Less: Accumulated depreciation
Property and equipment, net
December 31,
2020
2019
$
$
1,051 $
186
3,407
7,683
12,327
(10,028)
2,299 $
867
—
3,110
7,805
11,782
(8,965)
2,817
Included in machinery and equipment are financed vehicles used by the Company’s sales employees. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the gross
capitalized value of the leased vehicles was $1.6 million and $2.0 million, respectively, and the related accumulated depreciation was $1.2 million and
$1.1 million, respectively. Included in Property and equipment as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 is construction in progress of $0.4 million that is yet to
be depreciated.
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets
Goodwill and other intangible assets comprise a patent sublicense acquired from Palomar in 2006, intangible assets and goodwill related to the acquisition
of Iridex’s aesthetic business unit, and customer relationships in the Benelux countries acquired from a former distributor in 2013. Goodwill was $1,339
as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 and there were no changes to Goodwill during the years then ended. Intangible assets were fully amortized as of
December 31, 2020 and 2019 and there were no additions during the years then ended. As such, the Company did not incur any amortization expense for
intangible assets during the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018. There were no impairments or additions to goodwill during the years ended
December 31, 2020 or 2019.
Accrued Liabilities
Accrued liabilities consist of the following (in thousands):
Accrued payroll and related expenses
Sales and marketing accruals
Warranty liability
Accrued sales tax
Other accrued liabilities
Total
Product Remediation Liability
December 31,
2020
2019
12,197 $
2,352
2,908
5,343
8,279
31,079 $
14,341
2,527
4,401
3,922
5,116
30,307
$
$
During the fourth quarter of 2018, the Company recognized a liability for a product remediation plan related to one of its legacy systems. This was related
to a voluntary action initiated by the Company to replace a component in one of the Company’s legacy products. The remediation plan consists primarily
of replacement of a component in the system. The accrued liability consists of the estimated cost of materials and labor to replace the component in all
units that were under the Company's standard warranty or were covered under the existing extended warranty contracts. The Company recorded a liability
of approximately $5.0 million in 2018.
As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, approximately $0.4 million and $0.5 million, respectively, of the total product remediation liability
balance was accrued as a component of the Company’s product warranty liability and included in accrued liabilities, and $1.2 million and $2.0 million,
respectively, was separately recorded as extended warranty liabilities. In the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company settled $0.6 million related to
extended warranty liability and recorded $0.2 million of the reversal of excess reserve during the fourth quarter of 2020 and $0.1 million in product
remediation warranty, respectively.
83
Table of Contents
NOTE 4— WARRANTY AND EXTENDED SERVICES CONTRACT
The Company has a direct field service organization in North America (including Canada). Internationally, the Company provides direct service support
in Australia, Belgium, France, Germany, Hong Kong, Japan, and Switzerland, as well as through third-party service providers in Spain and the United
Kingdom. In several other countries, where the Company does not have a direct presence, the Company provides service through a network of
distributors and third-party service providers.
After the original warranty period, maintenance and support are offered on an extended service contract basis or on a time and materials basis. The
Company provides for the estimated cost to repair or replace products under standard warranty at the time of sale. Costs in connection with extended
service contracts are recognized at the time when costs are incurred. The following table provides the changes in the product standard warranty accrual
for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands):
December 31,
2020
2019 (1)
Balance at beginning of year
Add: Accruals for warranties issued during the period
Less: Settlements made during the period
Balance at end of year
4,666
7,629
(7,894)
4,401
(1) Presentation of the 2019 warranty liability rollforward table has been changed for consistency. The $4.6 million as of the beginning of 2019
excluded one-time extended service contracts costs of $3.2 million to replace components in one of the Company’s legacy products.
4,401 $
4,475
(5,968)
2,908 $
$
$
The settlements presented in the table exclude costs related to extended service contracts cost, which were $0.6 million and $1.1 million for the
years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, to replace a component in one of the Company's legacy products.
NOTE 5— DEFERRED REVENUE
The Company records deferred revenue when revenue is to be recognized subsequent to invoicing. For extended service contracts, the Company
generally invoices customers at the beginning of the extended service contract term. The Company’s extended service contracts typically have one, two-
or three-year terms. Deferred revenue also includes payments for training and extended marketing support service. Approximately 84% of the
Company’s deferred revenue balance of $11.2 million as of December 31, 2020 will be recognized over the next 12 months.
The following table provides changes in the deferred contract revenue balance for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands):
Balance at beginning of year
Add: Payments received
Less: Revenue
Less: Revenue included in the beginning balance and recognized as revenue in the current year
Balance at end of year
December 31,
2020
2019
$
$
14,222 $
14,131
(6,337)
(10,779)
11,237 $
12,566
17,127
(6,020)
(9,451)
14,222
Costs for extended service contracts were $8.2 million, $9.3 million and $7.8 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and
2018.
NOTE 6—STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY, STOCK PLANS AND STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION EXPENSE
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had one class of issued common stock with a par value of $0.001. Authorized capital stock consists of
55,000,000 shares comprised of two classes: (i) 50,000,000 shares of Common Stock, of which 17,679,232 shares are issued and outstanding as of
December 31, 2020, and (ii) 5,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.001 per share (“Preferred Stock”), of which no shares are issued and
outstanding.
Issuances of Common Stock
On April 21, 2020, the Company issued and sold an aggregate of 2,742,750 shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.001 per share at a
price to the public of $10.50 per share. The shares include the full exercise of the underwriter’s option to purchase an additional 357,750 shares of
common stock. The Company received net proceeds from the offering of approximately $26.5 million, after deducting underwriting discounts,
commissions and offering expenses of $2.3 million.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had the following stock-based employee compensation plans:
2004 Equity Incentive Plan
In 1998, the Company adopted the 1998 Stock Plan, or 1998 Plan, under which 4,650,000 shares of the Company’s common stock were reserved for
issuance to employees, directors and consultants.
On January 12, 2004, the Board of Directors (“the Board”) adopted the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan. A total of 1,750,000 shares of common stock were
originally reserved for issuance pursuant to the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan. In addition, the shares reserved for issuance under the 2004 Equity Incentive
Plan included shares reserved but un-issued under the 1998 Plan and shares returned to the 1998 Plan as the result of termination of options or the
repurchase of shares. In 2012 the stockholders approved a “fungible share” provision whereby each full-value award issued under the 2004 Equity
Incentive Plan results in a requirement to subtract 2.12 shares from the shares reserved under the Plan.
84
Table of Contents
2019 Equity Incentive Plan
At the Company’s Annual Meeting of Stockholders on June 14, 2019, the Company’s stockholders approved the 2019 Equity Incentive Plan, which is an
amendment and restatement of the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan. The 2004 Equity Incentive Plan was amended to: (i) increase the number of shares
available for future grant by 700,000 (in addition to the 9,701,192 shares provided under the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan; (ii) extend the term of the 2004
Equity Incentive Plan to the date of the Annual Meeting of the Company’s stockholders in 2029; (iii) amend the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan to eliminate
the requirement for awards granted on or after June 14, 2019 that any shares subject to awards with an exercise price less than fair market value on the
date of such grant will be counted against the Plan as 2.12 shares for each full value share awarded in accordance with the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan;
(iv) amend the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan to remove the requirement that any shares subject to awards with an exercise price less than fair market value
on the date of such grant will be counted against the Plan as 2.12 shares for each full value share awarded; (v) amend the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan to
remove certain provisions relating to the “performance based compensation” exception under Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
amended; (vi) include a minimum one-year vesting period with respect to awards granted under the 2004 Equity Incentive Plan.
On June 11, 2019, the Board also approved amended and restated the Company’s Stock Ownership Guidelines adopted on July 28, 2017 in their entirety,
to require all officers (as defined by Rule 16a-1(f) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) to hold at least 50% of any shares received
pursuant to stock options, stock appreciation rights, vested restricted stock awards (“RSAs”), restricted stock units (“RSUs”), performance shares or
performance units (net of taxes) for a minimum of one year following vesting and delivery.
On June 11, 2019, the Board also adopted a clawback policy to permit recovery of certain compensation paid to Named Executive Officers (as defined in
Item 402 of Regulation S-K) of the Company if the Compensation Committee of the Board determines that a Named Executive Officer (i) has violated
law, the Company’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, or any significant ethics or compliance policies, and (ii) such conduct results in material
financial or reputational harm, or results in a need for a restatement of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. The Amended and Restated
Plan provides for the grant of incentive stock options, non-statutory stock options, RSAs, RSUs, stock appreciation rights, performance units,
performance shares, and other stock or cash awards.
In June 2020, stockholders approved an amendment and restatement of the 2019 Equity Incentive Plan (the “Prior Plan”) as the Amended and Restated
2019 Equity Incentive Plan (the “Restated Plan”) and approved an additional 600,000 shares, available for future grants. The Restated Plan provides for
the grant of incentive stock options, non-statutory stock options, RSAs, RSUs, stock appreciation rights, performance stock units, performance shares,
and other stock or cash awards.
In accordance with the 2019 Restated Plan and 2004 Equity Incentive Plans, prior to 2012, the Company’s non-employee directors were granted $60,000
of grant date fair value, fully vested, stock awards annually on the date of the Company’s Annual Meeting of stockholders. The quantity of units granted
is determined by dividing the award amount by the 50-day moving average stock price ending on the day of the award. Following Board of Directors
action on October 31, 2017, the Company’s nonemployee directors receive $60,000 of RSUs granted annually that cliff-vest on the one-year anniversary
of the grant date. In the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Company issued 35,735, 42,236 and 13,392 RSUs, respectively, to its non-
employee directors.
In the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Company’s Board of Directors granted 650,964, 517,402 and 210,532 RSUs, respectively, to
its executive officers, directors and certain members of the Company’s management. 25% of the RSUs granted to the employees vest on each of the first
four anniversaries of the vest date subject to the recipients’ continued service. The Company measured the fair market values of the underlying stock on
the dates of grant and recognizes the stock-based compensation expense over the vesting period. On the vesting date, the Company issues fully paid up
common stock, net of stock withheld to settle the recipient’s minimum statutory tax liability.
In the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 the Company’s Board of Directors granted its executive officers and certain senior management
employees 98,580, 387,172, and 47,824 of PSUs, respectively. The PSUs vest over 12 or 24 months subject to the recipient’s continued service and the
achievement of pre-established performance goals. The PSUs granted in 2020 vest subject to the recipients continued service and the achievement of
certain performance goals for the Company’s 2020 fiscal year established by the Board and relating to the achievement of specific operational and
regulatory milestones. During the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, 219,549 shares, 23,053 shares 97,418 shares of the PSUs vested,
respectively.
During the quarter ended September 30, 2019 the Company's Board awarded its new CEO, David H. Mowry, 67,897 shares, which are scheduled to vest
over 4 years from 2019 through 2022 (the 2019 tranche is 15% of the award, or 10,185 PSUs; the 2020 tranche is 25% of the award, or 16,974 PSUs; the
2021 tranche is 30% of the award, or 20,369 PSUs; and the 2022 tranche is 30% of the award, or 20,369 PSUs). These PSUs are subject to certain
performance-based criteria related to achieving financial metrics in the Board approved annual budgets for the years 2019 through 2022. As of
December 31, 2020, the Company concluded that the 2019 and 2020 tranches met the criteria for measurement and recognition. The 8,657 shares of the
2019 tranche vested during the year ended December 31, 2020. None of the shares for the 2020 tranche vested. The 2021 and 2022 tranches do not meet
the criteria for measurement and recognition as of December 31, 2020 and will meet the criteria for measurement and commencement of recognition
when the Company’s Board of Directors establishes the financial metrics for each fiscal year.
On August 2, 2020, the Board awarded its new CFO, Rohan Seth, an option grant for 60,000 shares, which vests over 5 years, and a PSU award covering
a target of 22,423 shares, which vests over 2.5 years and is subject to performance-based criteria relating to the achievement of certain goals with 40%
based on achievement of Finance department goals and 60% based on the Company’s achievement of financial performance goals. The maximum
number of Shares that may vest under the award is 150% of the target number of shares of Common Stock subject to the award.
On April 1, 2020, the Company issued RSUs to settle bonuses owed to management under the 2019 Management Bonus Program. In the past, the
Company has paid these bonuses with cash on hand. However, due to the economic conditions resulting from COVID-19, fully vested shares were
issued in lieu of cash. The Company issued 209,981 shares related to this bonus payment to management and recognized $2.6 million in stock-based
compensation expense. The Company also recorded an equivalent reduction in bonus expense as a result of the settlement of the bonus in shares.
85
Table of Contents
On January 12, 2004, the Board of Directors adopted the 2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. Under the 2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, or 2004
ESPP, eligible employees are permitted to purchase common stock at a discount through payroll deductions. The 2004 ESPP offering and purchase
periods are for approximately six months. The 2004 ESPP has an evergreen provision based on which shares of common stock eligible for purchase are
increased on the first day of each fiscal year by an amount equal to the lesser of:
● 600,000 shares;
● 2.0% of the outstanding shares of common stock on such date; or an amount as determined by the Board of Directors.
The Company’s Board of Directors did not increase the shares available for future grant on January 1, 2021, 2020 and 2019. The price of the common
stock purchased is the lower of 85% of the fair market value of the common stock at the beginning or end of a six-month offering period. In the years
ended December 31, 2020, 2019, and 2018, under the 2004 ESPP, the Company issued 56,751, 82,810, and 64,511 shares, respectively. At December 31,
2020, 704,954 shares remained available for future issuance.
Option and Award Activity
Activity under the 2004 Plan and 2019 Equity Incentive Plan is summarized as follows:
Options Outstanding
Balances as of December 31, 2017
Options granted
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Balances as of December 31, 2018
Additional shares reserved(2)
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Balances as of December 31, 2019
Additional shares reserved(2)
Options granted
Options exercised
Options cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Stock awards granted
Stock awards cancelled (expired or forfeited)
Balances as of December 31, 2020
Exercisable as of December 31, 2020
Vested and expected to vest, net of
estimated forfeitures, as of December 31,
2020
Shares
Available
For Grant
Number of
Shares
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price
1,494,866
(21,010)
—
81,322
(562,070)
148,197
1,141,305
700,000
—
51,208
(1,538,128)
407,320
761,705
600,000
(71,088)
—
76,553
(804,949)
522,949
1,085,170
839,919 $
21,010 $
(271,902) $
(81,322) $
—
—
507,705 $
(160,798) $
(51,208) $
—
—
295,699 $
71,088 $
(73,227) $
(76,553) $
—
—
217,007 $
132,641 $
16.46
50.65
9.99
21.55
—
—
20.52
10.03
24.61
—
—
25.52
14.85
12.91
36.65
—
—
22.35
24.60
212,025 $
22.31
Weighted-
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life
(in years)
3.99
Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
(in millions ) (1)
24.4
$
3.52
$
2.00
3.19
$
3.04
3.75
2.84
3.63
$
$
$
1.47
1.47
1,451
(1) Based on the closing stock price of $24.11 of the Company’s stock on December 31, 2020, $35.81 on December 31, 2019, $17.02 on December 31,
2018 and $45.35 on December 31, 2017.
(2) Approved by the board of directors and stockholders in 2019 and 2020.
The aggregate intrinsic value in the table above represents the total pre-tax intrinsic value (the aggregate difference between the Company’s closing
stock price on the last trading day of the fiscal year and the exercise price, multiplied by the number of in-the-money options) that would have been
received by the option holders had all option holders exercised their options on December 31, 2020. The aggregate intrinsic amount changes based on
the fair market value of the Company’s common stock. Total intrinsic value of options exercised in 2020, 2019 and 2018 was $0.4 million, $1.0 million,
and $8.3 million, respectively. The options outstanding and exercisable at December 31, 2020 were in the following exercise price ranges:
$15.32
$18.55
$9.65
$10.80
$10.79
$14.04
Exercise Prices
-
-
$14.01
-
$18.93
$19.55
$25.70
$39.30
$47.40
$53.90
-
$9.65
$53.9
Number Outstanding
Contractual Life
(in years)
Number
Exercisable
22,319
34,459
60,000
8,396
11,088
10,000
11,000
45,000
7,745
7,000
217,007
1.08
2.23
4.59
2.64
9.83
3.32
3.59
3.83
3.96
4.20
3.75
22,319
34,459
—
8,271
—
9,375
9,730
37,292
6,132
5,063
132,641
86
Table of Contents
Stock Awards (RSU and PSU) Activity Table
Information with respect to RSUs and PSUs activity is as follows (in thousands):
Number of
Shares
Weighted-
Average
Grant-
Date Fair
Value
Aggregate
Fair Value(1)
(in thousands)
Outstanding at December 31, 2017
Granted
Vested (3)
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2018
Granted
Vested (3)
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2019
Granted
Vested (3)
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2020
510,587 $
265,124 $
(231,515) $
(69,905) $
474,291 $
963,814 $
(172,281) $
(161,022) $
1,104,802 $
667,694 $
(684,491) $
(308,248) $
779,757 $
24.88
44.57
21.10 $
20.01
38.44
18.68
33.66 $
37.91
22.10
20.66
17.82 $
23.24
23.96
Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
(2)
(in thousands)
23,155
$
9,483(4)
$
8,072
6,169(5)
$
37,442
12,036(6)
$
18,800
(1) Represents the value of the Company’s stock on the date that the restricted stock units and performance stock units vest.
(2) Based on the closing stock price of the Company’s stock of $24.11 on December 31, 2020, $35.81 on December 31, 2019, $17.02 on December 31,
2018, and $45.35 on December 31, 2017.
(3) The number of restricted stock units vested includes shares that the Company withheld on behalf of the employees to satisfy the statutory tax
withholding requirements.
(4) On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $4.9 million.
(5) On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $5.9 million.
(6) On the grant date, the fair value for these vested awards was $12.2 million.
Stock-Based Compensation
Stock-based compensation expense for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 was as follows (in thousands):
Stock options
RSUs
PSUs
ESPP
Total stock-based compensation expense
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
$
$
370 $
8,849
666
224
10,109 $
622 $
4,786
3,948
476
9,832 $
838
4,648
1,105
566
7,157
As of December 31, 2020, the unrecognized compensation cost, net of expected forfeitures, was $0.7 million for stock options, which will be recognized
over an estimated weighted-average remaining amortization period of 3.9 years. The unrecognized compensation cost, net of expected forfeitures, for
stock awards, including performance-based awards, was $12.3 million, which will be recognized over an estimated weighted-average remaining
amortization period of 2.3 years. For the ESPP, the unrecognized compensation cost, net of expected forfeitures, was $0.1 million, which will be
recognized over an estimated weighted-average amortization period 0.33 years.
The Company issues new shares of common stock upon the exercise of stock options, vesting of RSUs and PSUs, and the issuance of ESPP shares. The
amount of cash received through exercise of options and shares purchased through ESPP, net of taxes withheld and paid, in 2020, 2019 and 2018 was
$1.6 million, $3.9 million and $1.3 million.
Total stock-based compensation expense recognized during the year ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 was recorded in the Consolidated
Statement of Operations as follows (in thousands):
Cost of revenue
Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative
Total stock-based compensation expense
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
1,665 $
3,385
1,669
3,390
10,109 $
1,572 $
4,510
1,536
2,214
9,832 $
743
2,105
824
3,485
7,157
$
$
87
Table of Contents
Valuation Assumptions and Fair Value of Stock Options and ESPP Grants
The Company uses the Black-Scholes option pricing model to estimate the fair value of options granted under its equity incentive plans and rights to
acquire stock granted under its employee stock purchase plan. The weighted average estimated fair values of the employee stock options and rights
granted under the employee stock purchase plan and the weighted average assumptions used to calculate the grant date fair values, are as follows:
Expected term (in years) (1)
Risk-free interest rate (2)
Volatility(3)
Dividend yield(4)
Weighted average
estimated fair value at
grant date
2020
Stock Options
2019
2018
Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP)
2019
2018
2020
4.84
0.15%
63%
—%
3.65
1.64%
54%
—%
3.70
2.60%
44%
—%
0.50
0.11%
76%
—%
0.50
2.49%
70%
—%
0.50
2.34%
61%
—%
$
7.63
$
14.83
$
18.00
$
6.13
$
9.60
$
9.60
(1) The expected term represents the period during which the Company’s stock-based awards are expected to be outstanding. The estimated term is
based on historical experience of similar awards, giving consideration to the contractual terms of the awards, vesting requirements and
expectation of future employee behavior, including post-vesting terminations. The expected term of groups of employees that have similar
historical exercise patterns has been considered separately for valuation purposes.
(2) The risk-free interest rate is based on U.S. Treasury debt securities with maturities close to the expected term of the option or ESPP participation
right as of the date of grant.
(3) Estimated volatility is based on historical volatility. The Company estimates volatility based on the Company’s historical volatility of its stock
price.
(4) The Company has not paid dividends since its inception.
The Company periodically estimates forfeiture rates based on its historical experience for separate groups of employees and adjusts the stock-based
compensation expense accordingly. The forfeiture rates used in 2020 ranged from 0% to 20.8%.
Stock Awards Withholdings
For Stock Awards granted to employees, the number of shares issued on the date the Stock Awards vest is net of the tax withholding requirements paid
on behalf of the employees. In 2020, 2019, and 2018, the Company withheld 193,573, 42,695 and 77,049 shares of common stock, respectively, to
satisfy its employees’ tax obligations of $3.4 million, $0.8 million and $3.1 million, respectively. The Company paid this amount in cash to the
appropriate taxing authorities. Although shares withheld are not issued, they are treated as common stock repurchases for accounting and disclosure
purposes, as they reduce the number of shares that would have been issued upon vesting.
88
Table of Contents
NOTE 7—INCOME TAXES
The Company files income tax returns in the U.S. federal and various state and local jurisdictions and foreign jurisdictions. The Company’s income (loss)
before provision for income taxes consisted of the following (in thousands):
U.S.
Foreign
Loss before income taxes
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
$
$
(25,793) $
2,386
(23,407) $
(13,037) $
774
(12,263) $
(14,177)
662
(13,515)
The components of the provision (benefit) for income taxes are as follows (in thousands):
Current:
Federal
State
Foreign
Total Current
Deferred:
Federal
State
Foreign
Total Deferred
Tax provision
The Company’s net deferred tax assets consist of the following (in thousands):
Net operating loss carryforwards
Stock-based compensation
Other accruals and reserves
Credits
Accrued warranty
Depreciation and amortization
Other
Operating Lease Liability
Deferred tax asset before valuation allowance
Valuation allowance
Deferred tax asset after valuation allowance
Deferred contract acquisition costs
Goodwill
Right of Use Asset
Net deferred tax asset
89
$
$
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
— $
(53)
747
694
2
1
(227)
(224)
470 $
$
$
— $
101
(76)
25
2
1
57
60
85 $
(15)
123
303
411
15,674
1,230
(60)
16,844
17,255
December 31,
2020
2019
18,270 $
869
3,670
12,653
976
2,191
979
4,311
43,919
(38,321)
5,598
(803)
(110)
(4,042)
643 $
14,507
1,111
2,202
11,887
924
2,354
897
3,949
37,831
(32,350)
5,481
(1,076)
(97)
(3,885)
423
Table of Contents
The differences between the U.S. federal statutory income tax rates to the Company’s effective tax rate are as follows:
U.S. federal statutory income tax rate
State tax rate
Meals and entertainment
Permanent differences
Stock-based compensation
SAB 118 Change in Estimate
Foreign rate differential
Other
General business credit
Valuation allowance
Change in prior year reserves
Deferred true-up
Effective tax rate
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
21.00%
2.77
(0.65)
(2.87)
(1.07)
—
(1.05)
0.15
2.74
(25.51)
0.40
2.08
(2.01)%
21.00%
2.82
(2.83)
(2.58)
3.78
—
(0.34)
(0.33)
8.14
(38.60)
2.53
5.71
(0.70)%
21.00%
(4.95)
(2.66)
—
13.66
(2.43)
0.11
(1.21)
4.31
(155.49)
—
—
(127.66)%
As of December 31, 2020, the Company recorded a valuation allowance of $38.3 million for the portion of the deferred tax asset that it does not expect to
be realized. The valuation allowance on the Company’s net deferred taxes increased by $6.0 million and $4.5 million during the years ended December 31,
2020 and 2019, respectively. The changes in valuation allowance are primarily due to additional U.S. deferred tax assets and liabilities incurred in the
respective year. The Company has $0.6 million of net deferred tax assets in foreign jurisdictions, which management believes are more-likely-than-not to
be realized given the expectation of future earnings in these jurisdictions. The Company continues to monitor the realizability of the U.S. deferred tax
assets taking into account multiple factors, including the results of operations and magnitude of excess tax deductions for stock-based compensation. The
Company intends to continue maintaining a full valuation allowance on its U.S. deferred tax assets until there is sufficient evidence to support the reversal
of all or some portion of these allowances. Release of all, or a portion, of the valuation allowance would result in the recognition of certain deferred tax
assets and a decrease to income tax expense for the period the release is recorded.
At December 31, 2020, the Company had approximately $76.6 million and $36.6 million of federal and state net operating loss carryforwards, respectively,
available to offset future taxable income. The federal and state net operating loss carryforwards, if not utilized will generally begin to expire in
2029 through 2039. Approximately $34.9 million of total federal net operating loss carryforwards were generated post December 31, 2017 and have no
expiration. At December 31, 2020, the Company had research and development tax credits available to offset federal, California and Massachusetts tax
liabilities in the amount of $6.3 million, $7.8 million and $0.2 million, respectively. Federal credits will begin to expire in 2024, California state tax credits
have no expiration, and Massachusetts tax credits begin to expire in 2021.
On March 27, 2020, the U.S. federal government enacted the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (“CARES Act”). The CARES Act
changed several of the existing U.S. corporate income tax laws by, among other things, increasing the amount of deductible interest, allowing companies to
carry back certain Net Operating Losses (“NOLs”) and increasing the amount of NOLs that corporations can use to offset income. Further, in December
2020, the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021 was signed into law. It clarified that gross income does not include any amount that would otherwise arise
from the forgiveness of a PPP loan. The CARES Act did not have a material impact on the Company's income tax provision, deferred tax assets and
liabilities, and related taxes payable.
Federal and state laws can impose substantial restrictions on the utilization of net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards in the event of an “ownership
change,” as defined in Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code. The Company has determined that no significant limitation would be placed on the
utilization of the Company’s net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards due to prior ownership changes.
No deferred tax liabilities have been recorded relating to the earnings of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries since all such earnings are intended to be
indefinitely reinvested. The amount of the unrecognized deferred tax liability associated with these earnings is immaterial.
Uncertain Tax Positions
The Company establishes reserves for uncertain tax positions based on the largest amount that is more-likely-than-not to be sustained. An uncertain income
tax position will not be recognized if it has less than a 50% likelihood of being sustained. The Company performs a two-step approach to recognizing and
measuring uncertain tax positions. The first step is to evaluate the tax position for recognition by determining if the weight of available evidence indicates
that it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained on audit, including resolution of related appeals or litigation processes, if any. The second
step is to measure the tax benefit as the largest amount that is more than 50% likely of being realized upon settlement.
Although the Company believes it has adequately reserved for its uncertain tax positions, no assurance can be given that the final tax outcome of these
matters will not be different. The Company adjusts these reserves in light of changing facts and circumstances, such as the closing of a tax audit or the
refinement of an estimate. To the extent that the final tax outcome of these matters is different than the amounts recorded, such differences will impact the
provision for income taxes in the period in which such determination is made. The provision for income taxes includes the impact of reserve provisions and
changes to reserves that are considered appropriate, as well as the related net interest and penalties.
The Company files U.S., state, and foreign income tax returns in jurisdictions with varying statutes of limitations. The 2005 through 2020 tax years
generally remain subject to examination by U.S. federal and California state tax authorities due to the Company’s net operating loss and credit
carryforwards. For significant foreign jurisdictions, the 2015 through 2020 tax years generally remain subject to examination by their respective tax
authorities.
90
Table of Contents
The following table summarizes the activity related to the Company’s gross unrecognized tax benefits, excluding related interest and penalties, in
December 31, 2018 to December 31, 2020 (in thousands):
Balance at beginning of year
Decreases related to prior year tax positions
Increases related to prior year tax positions
Increases related to current year tax positions
Balance at end of year
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
1,426 $
(32)
—
470
1,864 $
1,563 $
(291)
25
129
1,426 $
1,519
(70)
—
114
1,563
$
$
It is the Company’s policy to recognize interest and penalties related to income tax matters in income tax expense. The amount of interest and penalties
recognized in income tax expense was immaterial for the years ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019. As of December 31, 2020, the Company
had no accrued interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions.
NOTE 8—NET LOSS PER SHARE
Basic net loss per share is computed by dividing the net loss by the weighted-average number of shares outstanding during the period, without
consideration for potential dilutive shares of common stock, such as in-the-money equity awards (stock options, RSUs, PSUs and employee stock purchase
plan contributions). Shares of common stock subject to repurchase are excluded from the weighted-average shares. Since the Company was in a loss
position for all periods presented, basic net loss per share is the same as diluted net loss per share since the effects of potentially dilutive securities are
antidilutive.
The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted net loss and the weighted average number of shares used in computing basic and diluted
net loss per share (in thousands, except per share data):
Numerator:
Net loss (in thousands)
Denominator:
Weighted average shares of common stock outstanding used in computing net loss
per share, basic and diluted
Net loss per share:
Net loss per share, basic and diluted
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
$
(23,877) $
(12,348) $
(30,770)
16,691
14,096
$
(1.43) $
(0.88) $
13,771
(2.23)
On March 9, 2021, the Company issued and sold $125 million aggregate principal amount of 2.25% Convertible Senior Notes. Such issuance will have the
impact on the number of potential common shares outstanding in the future periods. See Note 13 – "Subsequent Events" for detailed discussion.
The following numbers of shares outstanding, prior to the application of the treasury stock method, were excluded from the computation of diluted net loss
per common share for the period presented because including them would have had an anti-dilutive effect (in thousands):
Options to purchase common stock
Restricted stock units
Employee stock purchase plan shares
Performance stock units
Total
NOTE 9—DEFINED CONTRIBUTION PLAN
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
244
724
87
68
1,123
417
559
111
178
1,265
664
432
133
43
1,272
In the U.S., the Company has an employee savings plan (“401(k) Plan”) that qualifies as a deferred salary arrangement under Section 401(k) of the Internal
Revenue Code. Eligible employees may make voluntary contributions to the 401(k) Plan up to 100% of their annual compensation, subject to statutory
annual limitations. In 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Company made discretionary contributions under the 401(k) Plan of $0.2 million, $0.4 million and $0.4
million, respectively.
For the Company’s Japanese subsidiary, a discretionary employee retirement plan has been established. In addition, for some of the Company’s other
foreign subsidiaries, the Company deposits funds with insurance companies, third-party trustees, or into government-managed accounts consistent with the
requirements of local laws. The Company has fully funded or accrued for its obligations as of December 31, 2020, and the related expense for each of the
three years then ended was not significant.
NOTE 10—SEGMENT INFORMATION AND REVENUE BY GEOGRAPHY AND PRODUCTS
Segment reporting is based on the “management approach,” following the method that management organizes the company’s reportable segments for
which separate financial information is made available to, and evaluated regularly by, the chief operating decision maker in allocating resources and in
assessing performance. The Company’s chief operating decision makers ("CODM") are its Chief Executive Officer ("CEO") and Chief Financial Officer
(“CFO”), who make decisions on allocating resources and in assessing performance. The CEO and CFO review the Company's consolidated results as one
operating segment. In making operating decisions, the CODM primarily considers consolidated financial information, accompanied by disaggregated
information about revenues by geography and product. All of the Company’s principal operations and decision-making functions are located in the U.S.
The Company’s CODM view its operations, manages its business, and uses one measurement of profitability for the one operating segment - which sells
aesthetic medical equipment and services, and distributes skincare products, to qualified medical practitioners. Substantially all of the Company’s long-
lived assets are located in the U.S.
91
Table of Contents
The following table presents a summary of revenue by geography for the year ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 (in thousands):
Revenue mix by geography:
United States
Japan
Asia, excluding Japan
Europe
Rest of the world
Total Consolidated revenue
Revenue mix by product category:
Systems
Consumables
Skincare
Total product revenue
Service
Total Consolidated revenue
NOTE 11– COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
LEASES
2020
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2018
$
$
$
$
61,202 $
43,265
11,900
9,503
21,813
147,683 $
90,765 $
9,287
25,061
125,113
22,570
147,683 $
106,243 $
24,142
16,110
10,596
24,621
181,712 $
140,478 $
9,648
8,512
158,638
23,074
181,712 $
101,862
17,819
15,467
8,875
18,697
162,720
132,595
4,162
5,778
142,535
20,185
162,720
The Company is a party to certain operating and finance leases for vehicles, office space and storages facilities. The Company’s material operating leases
consist of office space, as well as storage facilities and finance leases consist of automobiles. The Company’s leases generally have remaining terms of 1 to
10 years, some of which include options to renew the leases for up to 5 years. The Company leases space for operations in the United States, Japan,
Belgium, France, and Spain. In addition to the above facility leases, the Company also routinely leases automobiles for certain sales and field service
employees under finance leases.
In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02, "Leases," (also known as ASC Topic 842) which requires, among other items, lease accounting to
recognize most leases as assets and liabilities on the balance sheet. Qualitative and quantitative disclosures are enhanced to better present the amount,
timing and uncertainty of cash flows arising from leases. In July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-11, "Targeted Improvements," which gives the option to
apply the transition provisions of ASU 2016-02 at its adoption date instead of at the earliest comparative period presented in its financial statements. In
addition, ASU 2018 2018-11 provides a practical expedient that permits lessors to not separate non-lease components from the associated lease component
if certain conditions are met. Also in July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-10, "Codification Improvements to ASC Topic 842, Leases," which clarifies
certain aspects of ASU 2016-02.
The Company adopted ASU 2016-02, as of January 1, 2019, using the modified retrospective method, to all leases existing at the date of initial application.
The comparative period information has not been restated and continues to be reported under the accounting standards in effect for the period presented.
The new standard provides a number of optional practical expedients in transition. The Company elected the package of practical expedients permitted
under the transition guidance within the new standard, which allowed the Company to carry forward the Company’s historical conclusions about lease
identification, lease classification and initial direct costs. The Company also elected the practical expedient related to land easements, allowing the
Company to carry forward the Company’s accounting treatment for land easements on existing agreements. The Company did not elect the practical
expedient to use hindsight in determining the lease term.
The adoption of the new standard resulted in the recording of additional lease assets and lease liabilities of $10.2 million and $10.1 million, respectively, as
of January 1, 2019, based on the present value of the remaining minimum rental payments under current leasing standards for existing operating leases. The
difference between the additional lease assets and lease liabilities resulted from rent-free periods which were previously recorded as deferred rent. The
Company’s accounting for finance leases remained substantially unchanged. The standard had no material impact on the Company’s consolidated net
earnings, results of operations, comprehensive loss, statements of changes in equity, and cash flows.
92
Table of Contents
Effect of Adoption of the New Lease Standard (ASC Topic 842) on Consolidated Financial Statements
The following table summarizes the effects of adopting Topic 842 on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet as of January 1, 2019 (in thousands):
Operating lease right-of-use assets
Operating lease liabilities
Other long-term liabilities*
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion
*Deferred rent included in other long-term liabilities
As reported under
Topic 842
Adjustments
Balances under
Prior GAAP
$
10,049 $
(2,430)
—
(7,759)
(10,049) $
2,430
140
7,759
—
—
140
—
The Company determines if a contract contains a lease at inception. Operating lease assets and liabilities are recognized at the lease commencement date.
Operating lease liabilities represent the present value of lease payments not yet paid. Operating lease assets represent the right to use an underlying asset
and are based upon the operating lease liabilities adjusted for prepayments or accrued lease payments, initial direct costs, lease incentives, and impairment
of operating lease assets. To determine the present value of lease payments not yet paid, the Company estimates the incremental secured borrowing rates
corresponding to the maturities of the leases. The Company based the rate estimates on prevailing financial market conditions, credit analysis, and
management judgment.
The Company recognizes expense for these leases on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Additionally, tenant incentives used to fund leasehold
improvements are recognized when earned and reduce the Company’s right-of-use asset related to the lease. These are amortized through the right-of-use
asset as reductions of expense over the lease term.
Below is supplemental balance sheet information related to leases (in thousands):
Assets
Right-of-use assets
Finance lease
Total leased assets
Classification
Operating lease right-of-use assets
Property and equipment, net(1)
(1) Finance lease assets included in Property and equipment, net (in thousands):
Liabilities
Operating lease liabilities
Operating lease liabilities, current
Operating lease liabilities , non-current
Total operating lease liabilities
Classification
Operating lease liabilities
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion
Finance lease liabilities
Finance lease liabilities, current
Finance lease liabilities, non-current
Total finance lease liabilities
Classification
Accrued liabilities
Other long-term liabilities
Lease costs during the twelve months ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 (in thousands):
Finance lease cost
Finance lease cost
Operating lease cost
Amortization expense
Interest for finance lease
Operating lease expense
93
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020
17,076 $
467
17,543 $
7,702
1,008
8,710
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020
2,260 $
15,950
18,210 $
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020
370 $
241
611 $
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020
431 $
63 $
3,275 $
2,800
5,112
7,912
541
578
1,119
704
88
2,892
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
Table of Contents
Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities during the twelve months ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 were as
follows (in thousands):
Operating cash flow
Financing cash flow
Operating cash flow
Maturities of lease liabilities
Finance lease
Finance lease
Operating lease
Maturities of operating lease liabilities were as follows as of December 31, 2020 (in thousands):
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
Thereafter
Total lease payments
Less: imputed interest
Present value of lease liabilities
Vehicle Leases
Year Ended December 31,
2019
2020
$
$
$
63 $
537 $
2,139 $
88
649
2,820
Amount
3,062
3,112
3,207
2,884
2,875
6,308
21,448
(3,238)
18,210
$
$
As of December 31, 2020, the Company was committed to minimum lease payments for vehicles leased under long-term non-cancelable finance leases as
follows (in thousands):
2021
2022
2023
Total lease payments
Less: imputed interest
Present value of lease liabilities
94
Amount
374
249
12
635
(24)
611
$
$
Table of Contents
Weighted-average remaining lease term and discount rate, as of December 31, 2020, were as follows:
Lease Term and Discount Rate
Weighted-average remaining lease term (years)
Operating leases
Finance leases
Weighted-average discount rate
Operating leases
Finance leases
Lessor Information related to the Company’s system leasing
6.7
2.2
4.7%
5.6%
The Company also enters into leasing transactions, in which the Company is the lessor, offered through the Company's membership program. The
Company's leases for equipment rentals were all accounted for as operating leases during the second and third quarter of 2020.
During the fourth quarter ended December 31, 2020, certain of the membership program agreements were amended, granting the customers the exclusive
right and option to purchase the leased system from the Company, at any time during the period of 12 months from signing the amended agreement. For
contracts signed under the amended membership agreement, the Company classified and accounted for the arrangements as sales-type leases as of
December 31, 2020, as the Company determined it is reasonably certain that the customer will exercise the purchase option
For the sales-type leases, the net investment of the Company’s lease receivable is measured at the commencement date and is included in the consolidated
balance sheets as a component of Other current assets and prepaid expenses. The following table, which reflects management’s assumption that lessees will
exercise the purchase option, summarizes the amount of sales-type lease income included in product revenue in the accompanying consolidated statements
of operations for the year ended December 31, 2020 (in thousands):
Year Ended December 31,
2020
790
Gross future lease payments from Customers
683
Less: Present value of lease receipts and purchase option price(1)
107
Difference between undiscounted cash flows and discounted cash flows
(1) Present value of lease receipts and purchase option price was included in Product revenue in the Company's Consolidated Statement of Operations in the
year ended December 31, 2020.
$
$
The revenue related to non-lease components, which comprise service contracts and consumables, are deferred and recognized either over time or at the
point of delivery. The non-lease component revenue amount as of December 31, 2020 was immaterial.
Equipment lease revenue for operating lease agreements is recognized over the life of the lease. The following table summarizes the amount of operating
lease income included in product revenue in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations for the year ended December 31, 2020 (in
thousands):
Operating lease income from equipment rentals
Purchase Commitments
Year Ended December 31,
2020
$
367
The Company maintains certain open inventory purchase commitments with its suppliers to ensure a smooth and continuous supply for key components.
The Company’s liability in these purchase commitments is generally restricted to an agreed-upon period. These periods can vary among different suppliers.
Although open purchase orders are considered enforceable and legally binding, the terms generally allow the Company the option to cancel, reschedule,
and adjust their requirements based on the Company's business needs prior to the delivery of goods or performance of services.
Indemnifications
In the normal course of the Company’s business, the Company enters into agreements that contain a variety of representations, warranties, and
indemnification obligations. For example, the Company has entered into indemnification agreements with each of its directors and executive officers and
certain key employees. The Company’s exposure under its various indemnification obligations is unknown and not reasonably estimable as they involve
future claims that may be made against the Company. As such, the Company has not accrued any amounts for such obligations.
Contingencies
The Company is named from time to time as a party to other legal proceedings, product liability, commercial disputes, employee disputes, and contractual
lawsuits in the normal course of business. A liability and related charge are recorded to earnings in the Company’s consolidated financial statements for
legal contingencies when the loss is considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated. The assessment is re-evaluated each accounting
period and is based on all available information, including discussion with outside legal counsel. If a reasonable estimate of a known or probable loss
cannot be made, but a range of probable losses can be estimated, the low-end of the range of losses is recognized if no amount within the range is a better
estimate than any other. If a material loss is reasonably possible, but not probable and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is
disclosed in the notes to the consolidated financial statements. The Company expenses legal fees as incurred.
95
Table of Contents
In November 2019, the Company’s former Executive Vice President and CFO Sandra A. Gardiner announced her resignation from the Company. On
November 7, 2019, Ms. Gardiner filed an arbitration demand against the Company in connection with the terms of her employment and resignation. The
Company settled this matter with Ms. Gardiner during the second quarter of 2020 with a cash payment of $0.4 million and issuance of 15,408 shares of
common stock.
As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company had accrued $0.4 million and Nil, respectively related to various pending commercial and product
liability lawsuits. The Company does not believe that a material loss in excess of accrued amounts is reasonably possible.
NOTE 12—DEBT
Loan and Security Agreement
On May 30, 2018, the Company and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (“Wells Fargo”) entered into a Loan and Security Agreement (the “Wells Fargo Revolving
Line of Credit”) in the original principal amount of $25 million.
On July 9, 2020, the Company terminated its undrawn revolving line of credit with Wells Fargo and subsequently entered into a Loan and Security
Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank for a four-year secured revolving loan facility (“SVB Revolving Line of Credit”) in an aggregate principal amount of
up to $30.0 million. The SVB Revolving Line of Credit matures on July 9, 2024.
Covenants
In order to draw on the full amount of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit, the Company must satisfy certain liquidity ratios. If the Company is unable to
meet these liquidity ratios, then availability under the revolving line is calculated as 80% of the Company’s qualifying accounts receivable. The proceeds of
the revolving loans may be used for general corporate purposes. The Company’s obligations under the Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley
Bank are secured by substantially all of the assets of the Company. Interest on principal amount outstanding under the revolving line shall accrue at a
floating per annum rate equal to the greater of either 1.75% above the Prime Rate or five percent (5.0%). The Company paid a non-refundable revolving
line commitment fee of $0.3 million, on the effective date of the Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank of July 9, 2020, and the Company
is required to pay an anniversary fee of $0.3 million on each twelve month anniversary of the effective date of the Loan and Security Agreement.
The Loan and Security Agreement with Silicon Valley Bank contains customary affirmative covenants, such as financial statement reporting requirements
and delivery of borrowing base certificates, as well as customary covenants that restrict the Company’s ability to, among other things, incur additional
indebtedness, sell certain assets, guarantee obligations of third parties, declare dividends or make certain distributions, and undergo a merger or
consolidation or certain other transactions. The Loan and Security Agreement also contains certain financial condition covenants, including maintaining a
minimum revenue of $90.0 million, determined in accordance with GAAP on a trailing twelve-month basis. This minimum revenue requirement is
performed quarterly and subject to renegotiation at the beginning of each fiscal year.
As of December 31, 2020, the Company had not drawn on the SVB Revolving Line of Credit and the Company is in compliance with all financial
covenants of the SVB Revolving Line of Credit.
The Paycheck Protection Program (PPP) Loan
On April 22, 2020, the Company received loan proceeds of $7.1 million pursuant to the Paycheck Protection Program (the “PPP”) under the Coronavirus
Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (the “CARES Act”). The loan, which is in the form of a promissory note dated April 21, 2020, between the
Company and Silicon Valley Bank as the lender, matures on April 21, 2022 and bears interest at a fixed rate of 1.00% per annum, payable monthly
commencing September 2021. There is no prepayment penalty. Under the terms of the PPP, all or a portion of the principal may be forgiven if the loan
proceeds are used for qualifying expenses as described in the CARES Act, such as payroll costs, benefits, rent, and utilities. No assurance is provided that
the Company will obtain forgiveness of the loan in whole or in part. With respect to any portion of the loan that is not forgiven, the loan will be subject to
customary provisions for a loan of this type, including customary events of default relating to, among other things, payment defaults and breaches of the
provisions of the loan.
The application for these funds required the Company to, in good faith, certify that the current economic uncertainty made the loan request necessary to
support the ongoing operations of the Company. Subsequently released guidance instructs all applicants and recipients to take into account their current
business activity and the Company's ability to access other sources of liquidity sufficient to support ongoing operations in a manner that is not significantly
detrimental to their business. On April 28, 2020, in press conference remarks, the Secretary of the U.S. Department of the Treasury stated that the SBA
intends to perform a review of PPP loans over $2.0 million. The required certification made by the Company is subject to interpretation. If, despite the
good-faith belief that given the Company’s circumstances the Company satisfied all eligible requirements for the PPP loan, it is later determined the
Company was ineligible to apply for and receive the PPP loan, the Company may be required to repay the PPP loan in its entirety and the Company could
be subject to additional penalties. The company is in the process of applying for forgiveness of the PPP Loan, as of December 31, 2020. However, the
Company can provide no assurance that the loan will be forgiven.
The PPP loan will be derecognized upon repayment of the loan in accordance with its terms and/or upon confirmation of forgiveness from the SBA.
96
Table of Contents
NOTE 13—SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
The Company evaluates events or transactions that occur after the balance sheet date through to the date which the financial statements are issued, for
potential recognition or disclosure in its consolidated financial statements in accordance with Subsequent Events.
On March 9, 2021, the Company offered $125 million aggregate principal amount of 2.25% convertible senior notes due 2026 (the “notes”) in a private
placement to qualified institutional buyers pursuant to Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”). Cutera also
granted the initial purchasers of the notes an option to purchase up to an additional $13.25 million aggregate principal amount of the notes on the same
terms and conditions. The Initial Purchasers exercised their option in full on March 5, 2021, bringing the total aggregate principal amount of the Notes
to $138.25 million.
The Company entered into capped call transactions, in connection with the offering, with one or more of the initial purchasers and/or their respective
affiliates and/or other financial institutions (the “option counterparties”). The capped call transactions are expected generally to reduce potential dilution
to Cutera’s common stock upon any conversion of notes, with such reduction subject to a cap. If the initial purchasers exercise their option to purchase
additional notes, the Company expects to enter into additional capped call transactions with the option counterparties.
The net proceeds from the offering, before deducting purchasers’ discounts and offering expenses were approximately $134.1 million. The Company
used $16.1 million of the net proceeds to pay the cost of the capped call transactions described above and the remainder of the net proceeds for general
corporate purposes, which may include working capital, capital expenditures and potential acquisitions and strategic transactions.
In connection with the offering, the Company entered into Amendment No. 1 to Loan and Security Agreement on March 4, 2021, which amends the
Company’s Loan and Security Agreement, dated as of July 9, 2020 between the Company, as borrower, and Silicon Valley Bank. The Amendment
amends the Loan and Security Agreement to (i) permit the Company to issue the Notes and perform its obligations in connection therewith, and (ii)
permit the Capped Call transactions.
The Company has become aware that InMode Ltd. has filed a complaint with the United States International Trade Commission alleging that Ilooda, Co.,
Ltd’s Secret RF fractional radiofrequency microneedling system, distributed in the United States by the Company, infringes U.S. Patent No. 10,799,285
("285 patent"). The complaint has not been served on the Company. The Company intends to vigorously defend against this lawsuit and, based on a
preliminary investigation, believes that the Company has strong defenses and that this patent is likely invalid in view of prior art. Based on the current
information available to the Company, it believes that any possible loss will not be material. If, following a successful third-party action for infringement,
the Company cannot obtain a license for the Company’s products, it may have to stop selling the applicable products.
SUPPLEMENTARY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
$
Quarter ended:
Net revenue
Cost of revenue
Gross profit
Operating expenses:
Sales and marketing
Research and development
General and administrative
Total operating expenses
Income (loss) from operations
Interest and other income
(expense), net
Income (loss) before income
taxes
Income tax provision (benefit)
$
Net income (loss)
Net income (loss) per share-
basic
Net income (loss) per share-
$
Dec. 31,
2020
Sept. 30,
2020
June 30,
2020
March 31,
2020
Dec. 31,
2019
Sept. 30,
2019
June 30,
2019
March 31,
2019
49,943 $
21,877
28,066
39,132 $
17,386
21,746
26,369 $
14,745
11,624
32,239 $
17,903
14,336
51,795 $
23,005
28,790
46,117 $
19,884
26,233
47,774 $
21,943
25,831
14,656
4,029
7,938
26,623
1,443
12,286
3,432
7,239
22,957
(1,211)
11,035
2,991
8,529
22,555
(10,931)
14,789
3,870
7,806
26,465
(12,129)
20,323
4,463
5,933
30,719
(1,929)
17,691
3,643
7,308
28,642
(2,409)
16,992
3,273
5,267
25,532
299
36,026
18,717
17,309
16,104
3,706
5,525
25,335
(8,026)
7
(382)
3
(207)
(20)
(146)
46
(79)
1,450
(738)
2,188 $
(1,593)
664
(2,257) $
(10,928)
466
(11,394) $
(12,336)
78
(12,414) $
(1,949)
139
(2,088) $
(2,555)
73
(2,628) $
345
(243)
588 $
(8,105)
115
(8,220)
0.12 $
(0.13) $
(0.67) $
(0.86) $
(0.15) $
(0.19) $
0.04 $
(0.59)
diluted
Weighted average number of
shares used in per share
calculations:
Basic
Diluted
$
0.12 $
(0.13) $
(0.67) $
(0.86) $
(0.15) $
(0.19) $
0.04 $
(0.59
17,653
17,840
17,603
17,603
17,055
17,055
14,433
14,433
14,261
14,261
14,182
14,182
14,086
14,356
14,017
14,017
97
Table of Contents
SCHEDULE II CUTERA, INC.
VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
(in thousands)
For the Years Ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
Deferred tax assets valuation allowance
Year ended December 31, 2020
Year ended December 31, 2019
Year ended December 31, 2018
Allowance for credit losses, accounts receivable
Year ended December 31, 2020
Year ended December 31, 2019
Year ended December 31, 2018
Balance at
Beginning
of Year
Additions
Deductions
Balance
at End of
Year
32,350 $
27,865 $
7,242 $
7,986 $
7,396 $
22,770 $
2,015 $
2,911 $
2,147 $
38,321
32,350
27,865
Balance at
Beginning
of Year
Additions
Deductions
Balance
at End of
Year
1,354 $
1,257 $
9 $
2,144 $
1,361 $
1,880 $
1,900 $
1,264 $
632 $
1,598
1,354
1,257
$
$
$
$
$
$
98
Table of Contents
ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
None.
ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Conclusion Regarding the Effectiveness of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
The Company maintains disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended) that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the Company’s Exchange Act reports is recorded, processed, summarized
and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms and that such information is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s
management, including the Company’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer, as appropriate, to allow for timely decisions regarding
required disclosure.
As required by SEC Rule 13a-15(b), the Company carried out an evaluation, under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s
management, including the Company’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the
Company’s disclosure controls and procedures as of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Based on the foregoing, the
Company’s Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”) concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were
effective at the reasonable assurance level.
Attached as exhibits to this Annual Report are certifications of the Company’s CEO and CFO, which are required in accordance with Rule 13a-14 of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (Exchange Act). This Controls and Procedures section includes the information concerning the controls
evaluation referred to in the certifications, and it should be read in conjunction with the certifications for a more complete understanding of the topics
presented.
Inherent Limitations Over Internal Controls
The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those
policies and procedures that:
● pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the Company’s
assets;
● provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with
GAAP, and that the Company’s receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of the Company’s
management and directors; and
● provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company’s assets
that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Management, including the Company’s CEO and CFO, does not expect that the Company’s internal controls will prevent or detect all errors and all fraud.
A control system, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system
are met. Further, the design of a control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered
relative to their costs. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of internal controls can provide absolute assurance that all
control issues and instances of fraud, if any, have been detected. Also, any evaluation of the effectiveness of controls in future periods are subject to the risk
that those internal controls may become inadequate because of changes in business conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or
procedures may deteriorate.
Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-
15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of the Company’s financial reporting and the
preparation of Consolidated Financial Statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. GAAP.
Management, including Company’s CEO and CFO, assessed the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020.
Management based its assessment on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations
of the Treadway Commission (2013 framework). Management’s assessment included evaluation of elements such as the design and operating effectiveness
of key financial reporting controls, process documentation, accounting policies, and the Company's overall control environment.
Based on this assessment, management has concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of the end of the fiscal
year to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of Consolidated Financial Statements for external
reporting purposes in accordance with U.S. GAAP.
The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, has been audited by an independent registered public
accounting firm, as stated in their attestation report, which is included in their annual report under “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data”
of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
99
Table of Contents
Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
There were no changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the quarter ended December 31, 2020 that have materially
affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal control over financial reporting.
ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION
None
PART III
Certain information required by Part III is omitted from this report on Form 10-K and is incorporated herein by reference to the Company’s definitive
Proxy Statement for the Company’s next Annual Meeting of Stockholders (the “Proxy Statement”), which the Company intends to file pursuant to
Regulation 14A of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, within 120 days after December 31, 2020.
ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Company’s Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by
reference: “Proposal No. 1 – Election of Class I Directors”, “Board and Committee Information”, “Executive Officers” and “Additional Information –
Stockholder Proposals to be Presented at Next Annual Meeting.”
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
The information required by this item set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Executive Compensation.”
ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER
MATTERS
The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.”
ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions
The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, all of which is incorporated herein by reference:
“Certain Relationships and Related-Party Transactions.”
ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES
The information required by this item is set forth under the following captions in the Proxy Statement, which is incorporated by reference herein by
reference: “Proposal No. 2, Ratification of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.”
100
Table of Contents
PART IV
ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
(a) The following documents are filed in Part II of the Annual Report on the Original 10-K:
1. Financial Statements: Financial Statements: See "Index to Consolidated Financial Statements" within the Consolidated Financial Statements.
2. Financial Statement Schedules: Financial Statement Schedules; not applicable or the required information is otherwise included in the Consolidated
Financial Statements and accompanying notes.
3. Exhibits: The exhibits listed in the accompanying index to exhibits are filed, furnished, or incorporated by reference as part of this Form 10-K. The
following is a list of such Exhibits:
Exhibit No.
Description
Exhibit Index
3.1
3.2
4.1
4.2
10.1*
10.2*
10.3*
10.4
10.5
10.6
10.7*
10.8*
10.9
10.10*
10.11*
10.12*
10.13*
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 3.5 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form
10-Q filed on November 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)
Bylaws of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 3.4 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 8, 2015 and incorporated
herein by reference)
Specimen Common Stock certificate of the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on
March 25, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference)
Description of the Registrant’s Securities (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2020
and incorporated herein by reference)
Form of Indemnification Agreement for directors and executive officers (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on
Form 8-K filed on February 21, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)
1998 Stock Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s registration statement on Form S-1 filed on January 15, 2004 and incorporated
herein by reference)
2004 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2007 and
incorporated herein by reference)
Brisbane Technology Park Lease dated August 5, 2003 by and between the Registrant and Gal-Brisbane, L.P. for office space located at
3240 Bayshore Boulevard, Brisbane, California (filed as Exhibit 10.6 to the Company’s registration statement on Form S-1 filed on
January 15, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference)
Settlement Agreement between the Registrant and Palomar Medical Technologies, Inc. dated June 2, 2006 (filed as Exhibit 99.1 to the
Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 6, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference)
Non-Exclusive Patent License between the Registrant and Palomar Medical Technologies, Inc. dated June 2, 2006 (filed as Exhibit 99.2
to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 6, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference)
Form of Performance Unit Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on
November 14, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference)
2019 Equity Incentive Plan (filed as Appendix A to the Company’s definitive proxy statement on Form 14A filed on April 30, 2019
and incorporated herein by reference)
First Amendment to Brisbane Technology Park Lease dated August 11, 2010 by and between the Company and BMR-Bayshore
Boulevard LLC, as successor-in-interest to Gal-Brisbane, L.P., the original landlord, for office space located at 3240 Bayshore
Boulevard (filed as Exhibit 10.19 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 1, 2010 and incorporated herein
by reference)
Change of Control and Severance Agreement between Kevin P. Connors and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)
Change of Control and Severance Agreement between Ronald J. Santilli and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.21 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)
Form of Performance Stock Unit Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.22 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on
August 1, 2016 and incorporated herein by reference)
Change of Control and Severance Agreement between James Reinstein and the Registrant (filed as Exhibit 10.23 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 11, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)
101
Table of Contents
10.14
10.15
10.16
Lease Termination Agreement dated July 6, 2017 by and between the Registrant and SI 28, LLC (filed as Exhibit 10.26 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)
Second Amendment to Lease dated July 6, 2017 by and between the Company and BMR-Bayshore Boulevard LP (filed as Exhibit 10.27 to
the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)
Transition Agreement dated July 12, 2017 by and between the Company and Ronald J. Santilli (filed as Exhibit 10.28 to the Company’s
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)
10.17*
Chief Financial Officer Consulting Agreement dated July 12, 2017 by and between the Company and Sandra A. Gardiner (filed as Exhibit
10.29 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 7, 2017 and incorporated herein by reference)
10.18
10.19
10.20
10.21
10.22*
10.23*
10.24*
Loan and Security Agreement dated May 30, 2018 by and between the Company and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the
Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 5, 2018 and incorporated herein by reference).
Separation Agreement dated January 4, 2019 by and between the Company and James Reinstein (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K on January 9, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference).
First Amendment and Wavier to the Loan and Security Agreement dated November 2, 2018 by and between the Company and Wells Fargo
Bank, N.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2020 and incorporated herein by
reference)
Second Amendment and Waiver to the Loan and Security Agreement dated March 11, 2019 by and between the Company and Wells Fargo
Bank N.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 16, 2020 and incorporated herein by
reference)
Employment Offer Letter dated June 22, 2019 by and between Cutera, Inc. and David Mowry (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 9, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)
Change of Control and Severance Agreement dated July 8, 2019 by and between Cutera, Inc. and David Mowry (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to
the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 9, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)
Consulting Agreement between Cutera, Inc. and FLG Partners, effective November 11, 2019 (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s
Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 18, 2019 and incorporated herein by reference)
Exhibit No. Description
23.1+
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
24.1
Power of Attorney
31.3+
Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
31.4+
Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
32.1+
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906
of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
101.INS
Inline XBRL Instance Document
101.SCH Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document
101.CAL Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document
101.DEF
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Document
101.LAB Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document
101.PRE
Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document
104
Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as Inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101)
* Management contract or compensatory plan
+ Filed herewith
102
Table of Contents
ITEM 16. FORM 10-K SUMMARY
None
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized, in the city of Brisbane, State of California, on the 23rd day of March, 2021.
SIGNATURES
CUTERA, INC.
By:
/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer
Power of Attorney
KNOW ALL MEN AND WOMEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints David H.
Mowry, and Rohan Seth, and each of them, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution for
him or her and in his or her name, place, and stead, in any and all capacities to sign any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and to
file the same, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto
said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be
done therewith, as fully to all intents and purposes as they might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and
agents, and any of them or their substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the
registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
Signature
Title
Date
/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
/s/ ROHAN SETH
Rohan Seth
/s/ J. DANIEL PLANTS
J. Daniel Plants
/s/ GREGORY A. BARRETT
Gregory A. Barrett
/s/ JOSEPH E. WHITTERS
Joseph E. Whitters
/s/ TIM O’SHEA
Tim O’Shea
/s/ KATHERINE S. ZANOTTI
Katherine S. Zanotti
Chief Executive Officer and Director (Principal Executive Officer)
March 23, 2021
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)
March 23, 2021
Chairman of the Board of Directors
March 23, 2021
Director
Director
Director
Director
103
March 23,2021
March 23, 2021
March 23, 2021
March 23, 2021
CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
Exhibit 23.1
Cutera, Inc.
Brisbane, California
We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements on Form S-3 (No. 333-237552) and Form S-8 (No. 333-114149, 333-
123495, 333-132583, 333-141376, 333-149703, 333-158160, 333-187502, 333-206864, and 333-221542) of Cutera, Inc. of our reports dated March 23,
2021, relating to the consolidated financial statements and schedule, and the effectiveness of Cutera, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting, which
appear in this Form 10-K.
/s/ BDO USA, LLP
San Francisco, California
March 23, 2021
9
CERTIFICATION OF CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 15 U.S.C. SECTION 7241, AS
ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
Exhibit 31.3
I, David H. Mowry, certify that:
1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc.:
2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the
statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
report;
3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the
financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-
15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under the Company’s
supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to the Company by
others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared;
(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under the Company’s
supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external
purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report the Company’s conclusions about the
effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal
quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the
registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on the Company’s most recent evaluation of internal control over financial
reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely
to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over
financial reporting.
Date: March 23, 2021
/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)
CERTIFICATION OF CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 15 U.S.C. SECTION 7241, AS
ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
Exhibit 31.4
I, Rohan Seth, certify that:
1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc.:
2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the
statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this
report;
3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the
financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-
15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under the Company’s
supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to the Company by
others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this annual report is being prepared;
(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under the Company’s
supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external
purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report the Company’s conclusions about the
effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal
quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the
registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on the Company’s most recent evaluation of internal control over financial
reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely
to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over
financial reporting.
Date: March 23, 2021
/s/ ROHAN SETH
Rohan Seth
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and
Accounting Officer)
CERTIFICATION OF
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER AND CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
Exhibit 32.1
In connection with the annual report on Form 10-K of Cutera, Inc. a Delaware corporation, for the period ended December 31, 2020, as filed with
the Securities and Exchange Commission, each of the undersigned officers of Cutera, Inc. certifies pursuant to section 1350 of chapter 63 of title 18 of the
United States Code, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that to his respective knowledge:
(1)
(2)
the annual report of Cutera, Inc. on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2020, fully complies with the requirements of
Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and
the information contained in the annual report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of
operations of Cutera, Inc. for the periods presented therein.
Date: March 23, 2021
Date: March 23, 2021
/s/ DAVID H. MOWRY
David H. Mowry
Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)
/s/ ROHAN SETH
Rohan Seth
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting
Officer)